DSPIC30F3013AT-20ESO-ES [MICROCHIP]
16-BIT, FLASH, 40 MHz, RISC MICROCONTROLLER, PDSO28, 0.300 INCH, PLASTIC, MS-013, SOIC-28;型号: | DSPIC30F3013AT-20ESO-ES |
厂家: | MICROCHIP |
描述: | 16-BIT, FLASH, 40 MHz, RISC MICROCONTROLLER, PDSO28, 0.300 INCH, PLASTIC, MS-013, SOIC-28 光电二极管 |
文件: | 总205页 (文件大小:2924K) |
中文: | 中文翻译 | 下载: | 下载PDF数据表文档文件 |
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Data Sheet
High-Performance, 16-Bit
Digital Signal Controllers
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E
Note the following details of the code protection feature on Microchip devices:
•
Microchip products meet the specification contained in their particular Microchip Data Sheet.
•
Microchip believes that its family of products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the market today, when used in the
intended manner and under normal conditions.
•
There are dishonest and possibly illegal methods used to breach the code protection feature. All of these methods, to our
knowledge, require using the Microchip products in a manner outside the operating specifications contained in Microchip’s Data
Sheets. Most likely, the person doing so is engaged in theft of intellectual property.
•
•
Microchip is willing to work with the customer who is concerned about the integrity of their code.
Neither Microchip nor any other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of their code. Code protection does not
mean that we are guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.”
Code protection is constantly evolving. We at Microchip are committed to continuously improving the code protection features of our
products. Attempts to break Microchip’s code protection feature may be a violation of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. If such acts
allow unauthorized access to your software or other copyrighted work, you may have a right to sue for relief under that Act.
Information contained in this publication regarding device
applications and the like is provided only for your convenience
and may be superseded by updates. It is your responsibility to
ensure that your application meets with your specifications.
MICROCHIP MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR
WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND WHETHER EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, WRITTEN OR ORAL, STATUTORY OR
OTHERWISE, RELATED TO THE INFORMATION,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ITS CONDITION,
QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, MERCHANTABILITY OR
FITNESS FOR PURPOSE. Microchip disclaims all liability
arising from this information and its use. Use of Microchip
devices in life support and/or safety applications is entirely at
the buyer’s risk, and the buyer agrees to defend, indemnify and
hold harmless Microchip from any and all damages, claims,
suits, or expenses resulting from such use. No licenses are
conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under any Microchip
intellectual property rights.
Trademarks
d
r
i
I
d
I
r
c
i
r
h
T
8
d
DS70139E-page ii
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013 High-Performance
Digital Signal Controllers
• 16-bit Compare/PWM output functions
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
• 3-wire SPI modules (supports four Frame modes)
• I2C™ module supports Multi-Master/Slave mode
and 7-bit/10-bit addressing
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
• Up to two addressable UART modules with FIFO
buffers
Analog Features:
High-Performance Modified RISC CPU:
• 12-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) with:
- 200 ksps conversion rate
• Modified Harvard architecture
• C compiler optimized instruction set architecture
• Flexible addressing modes
- Up to 10 input channels
- Conversion available during Sleep and Idle
• Programmable Low-Voltage Detection (PLVD)
• Programmable Brown-out Reset
• 83 base instructions
• 24-bit wide instructions, 16-bit wide data path
• Up to 24 Kbytes on-chip Flash program space
• Up to 2 Kbytes of on-chip data RAM
• Up to 1 Kbytes of nonvolatile data EEPROM
• 16 x 16-bit working register array
• Up to 30 MIPS operation:
Special Microcontroller Features:
• Enhanced Flash program memory:
- 10,000 erase/write cycle (min.) for
industrial temperature range, 100K (typical)
- DC to 40 MHz external clock input
• Data EEPROM memory:
- 4 MHz - 10 MHz oscillator input with
PLL active (4x, 8x, 16x)
- 100,000 erase/write cycle (min.) for
industrial temperature range, 1M (typical)
• Up to 21 interrupt sources:
- 8 user-selectable priority levels
- 3 external interrupt sources
- 4 processor trap sources
• Self-reprogrammable under software control
• Power-on Reset (POR), Power-up Timer (PWRT)
and Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
• Flexible Watchdog Timer (WDT) with on-chip low-
power RC oscillator for reliable operation
DSP Features:
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor operation:
• Dual data fetch
- Detects clock failure and switches to on-chip
low-power RC oscillator
• Modulo and Bit-Reversed modes
• Programmable code protection
• Two 40-bit wide accumulators with optional
saturation logic
• In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™)
• Selectable Power Management modes:
- Sleep, Idle and Alternate Clock modes
• 17-bit x 17-bit single-cycle hardware fractional/
integer multiplier
• All DSP instructions are single cycle
- Multiply-Accumulate (MAC) operation
• single-cycle ±16 shift
CMOS Technology:
• Low-power, high-speed Flash technology
• Wide operating voltage range (2.5V to 5.5V)
• Industrial and Extended temperature ranges
• Low-power consumption
Peripheral Features:
• High-current sink/source I/O pins: 25 mA/25 mA
• Three 16-bit timers/counters; optionally pair up
16-bit timers into 32-bit timer modules
• 16-bit Capture input functions
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 1
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013 Sensor Family
Program Memory
Output
Comp/Std
PWM
SRAM EEPROM Timer Input
A/D 12-bit
200 Ksps
Device
Pins
Bytes
Bytes
16-bit Cap
Bytes Instructions
dsPIC30F2011
dsPIC30F3012
dsPIC30F2012
dsPIC30F3013
18
18
28
28
12K
24K
12K
24K
4K
8K
4K
8K
1024
2048
1024
2048
–
3
3
3
3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
8 ch
8 ch
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1024
–
10 ch
10 ch
1024
Pin Diagrams
18-Pin PDIP and SOIC
MCLR
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
AVDD
AVSS
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
AN6/SCK1/INT0/OCFA/RB6
EMUD2/AN7/OC2/IC2/INT2/RB7
VDD
VSS
PGC/EMUC/AN5/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/CN7/RB5
PGD/EMUD/AN4/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/CN6/RB4
EMUC2/OC1/IC1/INT1/RD0
OSC1/CLKI
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
28-Pin PDIP and SOIC
MCLR
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
AVDD
AVSS
AN6/OCFA/RB6
EMUD2/AN7/RB7
AN8/OC1/RB8
AN9/OC2/RB9
CN17/RF4
AN4/CN6/RB4
AN5/CN7/RB5
VSS
CN18/RF5
OSC1/CLKI
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
VDD
VDD
VSS
9
20
19
18
17
16
15
10
11
12
13
14
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
PGD/EMUD/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
SCK1/INT0/RF6
EMUC2/IC1/INT1/RD8
IC2/INT2/RD9
28-Pin SPDIP and SOIC
MCLR
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
AVDD
AVSS
AN6/OCFA/RB6
EMUD2/AN7/RB7
AN8/OC1/RB8
AN9/OC2/RB9
U2RX/CN17/RF4
U2TX/CN18/RF5
VDD
AN4/CN6/RB4
AN5/CN7/RB5
VSS
OSC1/CLKI
9
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
VSS
10
11
12
13
14
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
VDD
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
PGD/EMUD/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
SCK1/INT0/RF6
EMUC2/IC1/INT1/RD8
IC2/INT2/RD9
Note: For descriptions of individual pins, see Section 1.0 “Device Overview”.
DS70139E-page 2
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Pin Diagrams
28-Pin QFN
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
NC
20 NC
19 NC
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
21
AN3/CN5/RB3
NC
NC
VSS
dsPIC30F2011
NC
VDD
VSS
18
17
16
15
OSC1/CLKI
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
PGC/EMUC/AN5/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/CN7/RB5
Note: For descriptions of individual pins, see Section 1.0 “Device Overview”.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 3
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Pin Diagrams
28-Pin QFN
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
AN4/CN6/RB4
AN5/CN7/RB5
VSS
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
21
AN8/OC1/RB8
20 AN9/OC2/RB9
19 CN17/RF4
18
17 VDD
16
15
dsPIC30F2012
CN18/RF5
OSC1/CLKI
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
VSS
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
Note: For descriptions of individual pins, see Section 1.0 “Device Overview”.
DS70139E-page 4
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Pin Diagram
44-Pin QFN
44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
OSC1/CLKI
VSS
PGC/EMUC/AN5/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/CN7/RB5
VSS
NC
VDD
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
VSS
NC
NC
NC
NC
dsPIC30F3012
AN3/CN5/RB3
NC
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
10
11
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
Note: For descriptions of individual pins, see Section 1.0 “Device Overview”.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 5
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Pin Diagrams
44-Pin QFN
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
OSC1/CLKI
VSS
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
1
2
3
33
32
31
30
VSS
NC
VDD
4
VSS
5
29 NC
NC
NC
6
7
8
9
10
11
28
27
26
25
24
23
NC
dsPIC30F3013
AN5/CN7/RB5
AN4/CN6/RB4
AN3/CN5/RB3
NC
U2TX/CN18/RF5
NC
U2RX/CN17/RF4
AN9/OC2/RB9
AN8/OC1/RB8
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
Note: For descriptions of individual pins, see Section 1.0 “Device Overview”.
DS70139E-page 6
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Table of Contents
1.0 Device Overview .......................................................................................................................................................................... 9
2.0 CPU Architecture Overview........................................................................................................................................................ 17
3.0 Memory Organization................................................................................................................................................................. 27
4.0 Address Generator Units............................................................................................................................................................ 41
5.0 Flash Program Memory.............................................................................................................................................................. 47
6.0 Data EEPROM Memory ............................................................................................................................................................. 53
7.0 I/O Ports ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 57
8.0 Interrupts .................................................................................................................................................................................... 63
9.0 Timer1 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................... 71
10.0 Timer2/3 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................ 75
11.0 Input Capture Module................................................................................................................................................................. 81
12.0 Output Compare Module............................................................................................................................................................ 85
13.0 SPI Module................................................................................................................................................................................. 89
14.0 I2C Module................................................................................................................................................................................. 93
15.0 Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART) Module .............................................................................................. 101
16.0 12-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module .................................................................................................................... 109
17.0 System Integration ................................................................................................................................................................... 119
18.0 Instruction Set Summary.......................................................................................................................................................... 133
19.0 Development Support............................................................................................................................................................... 141
20.0 Electrical Characteristics.......................................................................................................................................................... 145
21.0 Packaging Information.............................................................................................................................................................. 183
Index .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 193
The Microchip Web Site..................................................................................................................................................................... 199
Customer Change Notification Service .............................................................................................................................................. 199
Customer Support.............................................................................................................................................................................. 199
Reader Response.............................................................................................................................................................................. 200
Product Identification System ............................................................................................................................................................ 201
TO OUR VALUED CUSTOMERS
It is our intention to provide our valued customers with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip
products. To this end, we will continue to improve our publications to better suit your needs. Our publications will be refined and
enhanced as new volumes and updates are introduced.
If you have any questions or comments regarding this publication, please contact the Marketing Communications Department via
E-mail at docerrors@microchip.com or fax the Reader Response Form in the back of this data sheet to (480) 792-4150. We
welcome your feedback.
Most Current Data Sheet
To obtain the most up-to-date version of this data sheet, please register at our Worldwide Web site at:
http://www.microchip.com
You can determine the version of a data sheet by examining its literature number found on the bottom outside corner of any page.
The last character of the literature number is the version number, (e.g., DS30000A is version A of document DS30000).
Errata
An errata sheet, describing minor operational differences from the data sheet and recommended workarounds, may exist for current
devices. As device/documentation issues become known to us, we will publish an errata sheet. The errata will specify the revision
of silicon and revision of document to which it applies.
To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please check with one of the following:
•
•
Microchip’s Worldwide Web site; http://www.microchip.com
Your local Microchip sales office (see last page)
When contacting a sales office, please specify which device, revision of silicon and data sheet (include literature number) you are
using.
Customer Notification System
Register on our web site at www.microchip.com to receive the most current information on all of our products.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 7
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 8
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
This data sheet contains information specific to the
dsPIC30F2011, dsPIC30F2012, dsPIC30F3012 and
1.0
DEVICE OVERVIEW
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual“ (DS70157).
dsPIC30F3013 Digital Signal Controllers (DSC). These
devices contain extensive Digital Signal Processor
(DSP) functionality within a high-performance 16-bit
microcontroller (MCU) architecture.
The following block diagrams depict the architecture for
these devices:
• Figure 1-1 illustrates the dsPIC30F2011
• Figure 1-2 illustrates the dsPIC30F2012
• Figure 1-3 illustrates the dsPIC30F3012
• Figure 1-4 illustrates the dsPIC30F3013
Following the block diagrams, Table 1-1 relates the I/O
functions to pinout information.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 9
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 1-1:
dsPIC30F2011 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Y Data Bus
X Data Bus
16 16
16
16
Data Latch
Data Latch
Interrupt
Controller
PSV & Table
Data Access
Control Block
X Data
RAM
(512 bytes)
Address
Latch
Y Data
RAM
(512 bytes)
Address
Latch
8
16
24
24
16
24
16
16
16
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
PGD/EMUD/AN4/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/CN6/RB4
PGC/EMUC/AN5/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/CN7/RB5
AN6/SCK1/INT0/OCFA/RB6
X RAGU
X WAGU
Y AGU
PCH PCL
PCU
Program Counter
Loop
Control
Logic
Stack
Control
Logic
Address Latch
Program Memory
(12 Kbytes)
EMUD2/AN7/OC2/IC2/INT2/RB7
Data Latch
Effective Address
PORTB
16
ROM Latch
16
24
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
IR
16
16
16 x 16
W Reg Array
Decode
PORTC
Instruction
Decode &
Control
16 16
DSP
Engine
Divide
Unit
Power-up
Timer
EMUC2/OC1/IC1/INT1/RD0
Timing
Generation
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
OSC1/CLKI
ALU<16>
16
POR/BOR
Reset
16
PORTD
Watchdog
Timer
MCLR
Low-Voltage
Detect
VDD, VSS
AVDD, AVSS
Input
Capture
Module
Output
Compare
Module
I2C™
12-bit ADC
Timers
SPI1
UART1
DS70139E-page 10
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 1-2:
dsPIC30F2012 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Y Data Bus
X Data Bus
16
16
16
16
Data Latch
Data Latch
Interrupt
Controller
PSV & Table
Data Access
Control Block
X Data
RAM
(512 bytes)
Address
Latch
Y Data
RAM
(512 bytes)
Address
Latch
8
16
24
24
16
24
16
16
16
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
X RAGU
X WAGU
Y AGU
PCH PCL
PCU
Program Counter
AN3/CN5/RB3
AN4/CN6/RB4
AN5/CN7/RB5
AN6/OCFA/RB6
EMUD2/AN7/RB7
AN8/OC1/RB8
AN9/OC2/RB9
Stack
Control
Logic
Loop
Control
Logic
Address Latch
Program Memory
(12 Kbytes)
Data Latch
Effective Address
16
PORTB
ROM Latch
16
24
IR
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
16
16
16 x 16
W Reg Array
PORTC
Decode
Instruction
Decode &
Control
16 16
DSP
Engine
Divide
Unit
Power-up
Timer
EMUC2/IC1/INT1/RD8
IC2/INT2/RD9
Timing
Generation
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
OSC1/CLKI
ALU<16>
16
POR/BOR
Reset
PORTD
16
Watchdog
Timer
MCLR
Low-Voltage
Detect
VDD, VSS
AVDD, AVSS
Input
Capture
Module
Output
Compare
Module
I2C™
12-bit ADC
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
PGD/EMUD/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
CN17/RF4
CN18/RF5
SCK1/INT0/RF6
Timers
SPI1
UART1
PORTF
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 11
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 1-3:
dsPIC30F3012 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Y Data Bus
X Data Bus
16 16
16
16
Data Latch
Data Latch
Interrupt
Controller
PSV & Table
Data Access
Control Block
X Data
RAM
(1 Kbytes)
Address
Latch
Y Data
RAM
(1 Kbytes)
Address
Latch
8
16
24
24
16
24
16
16
16
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
PGD/EMUD/AN4/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/CN6/RB4
PGC/EMUC/AN5/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/CN7/RB5
AN6/SCK1/INT0/OCFA/RB6
X RAGU
X WAGU
Y AGU
PCH PCL
PCU
Program Counter
Stack
Control
Logic
Loop
Control
Logic
Address Latch
Program Memory
(24 Kbytes)
EMUD2/AN7/OC2/IC2/INT2/RB7
Data EEPROM
(1 Kbytes)
Effective Address
PORTB
16
Data Latch
ROM Latch
16
24
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
IR
16
16
16 x 16
W Reg Array
Decode
PORTC
Instruction
Decode &
Control
16 16
DSP
Engine
Divide
Unit
Power-up
Timer
EMUC2/OC1/IC1/INT1/RD0
Timing
Generation
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
OSC1/CLKI
ALU<16>
16
POR/BOR
Reset
16
PORTD
Watchdog
Timer
MCLR
Low-Voltage
Detect
VDD, VSS
AVDD, AVSS
Input
Capture
Module
Output
Compare
Module
I2C™
12-bit ADC
Timers
SPI1
UART1
DS70139E-page 12
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 1-4:
dsPIC30F3013 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Y Data Bus
X Data Bus
16
16
16
16
Data Latch
Data Latch
Interrupt
Controller
PSV & Table
Data Access
Control Block
X Data
RAM
(1 Kbytes)
Address
Latch
Y Data
RAM
(1 Kbytes)
Address
Latch
8
16
24
24
16
24
16
16
16
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
X RAGU
X WAGU
Y AGU
PCH PCL
PCU
Address Latch
Program Counter
AN3/CN5/RB3
AN4/CN6/RB4
AN5/CN7/RB5
AN6/OCFA/RB6
EMUD2/AN7/RB7
AN8/OC1/RB8
AN9/OC2/RB9
Stack
Control
Logic
Loop
Control
Logic
Program Memory
(24 Kbytes)
Data EEPROM
(1 Kbytes)
Data Latch
Effective Address
16
PORTB
ROM Latch
16
24
IR
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
16
16
16 x 16
W Reg Array
PORTC
Decode
Instruction
Decode &
Control
16 16
DSP
Engine
Divide
Unit
Power-up
Timer
EMUC2/IC1/INT1/RD8
IC2/INT2/RD9
Timing
Generation
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
OSC1/CLKI
ALU<16>
16
POR/BOR
Reset
PORTD
16
Watchdog
Timer
MCLR
Low-Voltage
Detect
VDD, VSS
AVDD, AVSS
Input
Capture
Module
Output
Compare
Module
I2C™
12-bit ADC
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
PGD/EMUD/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
U2RX/CN17/RF4
U2TX/CN18/RF5
SCK1/INT0/RF6
UART1,
UART2
SPI1
Timers
PORTF
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 13
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Table 1-1 provides a brief description of device I/O
pinouts and the functions that may be multiplexed to a
port pin. Multiple functions may exist on one port pin.
When multiplexing occurs, the peripheral module’s
functional requirements may force an override of the
data direction of the port pin.
TABLE 1-1:
PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Pin Name
Description
AN0 - AN9
AVDD
I
Analog
Analog input channels.
P
P
I
P
P
Positive supply for analog module.
Ground reference for analog module.
AVSS
CLKI
ST/CMOS
External clock source input. Always associated with OSC1 pin
function.
CLKO
O
—
Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in
Crystal Oscillator mode. Optionally functions as CLKO in RC
and EC modes. Always associated with OSC2 pin function.
CN0 - CN7
I
ST
Input change notification inputs.
Can be software programmed for internal weak pull-ups on all
inputs.
EMUD
EMUC
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ICD Primary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Primary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
ICD Secondary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Secondary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
ICD Tertiary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Tertiary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
ICD Quaternary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Quaternary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
EMUD1
EMUC1
EMUD2
EMUC2
EMUD3
EMUC3
IC1 - IC2
I
ST
Capture inputs 1 through 2.
INT0
INT1
INT2
I
I
I
ST
ST
ST
External interrupt 0.
External interrupt 1.
External interrupt 2.
LVDIN
MCLR
I
Analog
ST
Low-Voltage Detect Reference Voltage Input pin.
I/P
Master Clear (Reset) input or programming voltage input. This
pin is an active-low Reset to the device.
OC1-OC2
OCFA
O
I
—
ST
Compare outputs 1 through 2.
Compare Fault A input.
OSC1
I
ST/CMOS
Oscillator crystal input. ST buffer when configured in RC mode;
CMOS otherwise.
OSC2
I/O
—
Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in
Crystal Oscillator mode. Optionally functions as CLKO in RC
and EC modes.
PGD
PGC
I/O
I
ST
ST
In-Circuit Serial Programming™ data input/output pin.
In-Circuit Serial Programming clock input pin.
RB0 - RB9
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
ST
ST
PORTB is a bidirectional I/O port.
PORTC is a bidirectional I/O port.
PORTD is a bidirectional I/O port.
PORTF is a bidirectional I/O port.
RC13 - RC15
RD0, RD8 - RD9
RF2 - RF5
SCK1
SDI1
SDO1
SS1
I/O
ST
ST
—
Synchronous serial clock input/output for SPI1.
SPI1 Data In.
SPI1 Data Out.
I
O
I
ST
SPI1 Slave Synchronization.
Legend: CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
Analog = Analog input
ST
I
=
=
Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Input
O
P
=
=
Output
Power
DS70139E-page 14
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 1-1:
PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Pin Name
Description
2
SCL
SDA
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
Synchronous serial clock input/output for I C™.
2
Synchronous serial data input/output for I C.
SOSCO
SOSCI
O
I
—
32 kHz low-power oscillator crystal output.
32 kHz low-power oscillator crystal input. ST buffer when
configured in RC mode; CMOS otherwise.
ST/CMOS
T1CK
T2CK
I
I
ST
ST
Timer1 external clock input.
Timer2 external clock input.
U1RX
U1TX
U1ARX
U1ATX
U2RX
U2TX
I
O
I
O
I
ST
—
ST
—
ST
—
UART1 Receive.
UART1 Transmit.
UART1 Alternate Receive.
UART1 Alternate Transmit.
UART2 Receive.
O
UART2 Transmit.
VDD
P
P
I
—
Positive supply for logic and I/O pins.
Ground reference for logic and I/O pins.
Analog Voltage Reference (High) input.
Analog Voltage Reference (Low) input.
Analog = Analog input
VSS
—
VREF+
VREF-
Analog
Analog
I
Legend: CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST
I
=
=
Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Input
O
P
=
=
Output
Power
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 15
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 16
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Two ways to access data in program memory are:
2.0
CPU ARCHITECTURE
OVERVIEW
• The upper 32 Kbytes of data space memory can
be mapped into the lower half (user space) of
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
program space at any 16K program word bound-
ary, defined by the 8-bit Program Space Visibility
Page (PSVPAG) register. Thus any instruction
can access program space as if it were data
space, with a limitation that the access requires
an additional cycle. Only the lower 16 bits of each
instruction word can be accessed using this
method.
This section is an overview of the CPU architecture of
the dsPIC30F. The core has a 24-bit instruction word.
The Program Counter (PC) is 23 bits wide with the
Least Significant bit (LSb) always clear (see
Section 3.1 “Program Address Space”). The Most
Significant bit (MSb) is ignored during normal program
execution, except for certain specialized instructions.
Thus, the PC can address up to 4M instruction words
of user program space. An instruction prefetch mecha-
nism helps maintain throughput. Program loop con-
structs, free from loop count management overhead,
are supported using the DO and REPEATinstructions,
both of which are interruptible at any point.
• Linear indirect access of 32K word pages within
program space is also possible using any working
register, via table read and write instructions.
Table read and write instructions can be used to
access all 24 bits of an instruction word.
Overhead-free circular buffers (Modulo Addressing)
are supported in both X and Y address spaces. This is
primarily intended to remove the loop overhead for
DSP algorithms.
The X AGU also supports Bit-Reversed Addressing on
destination effective addresses to greatly simplify input
or output data reordering for radix-2 FFT algorithms.
Refer to Section 4.0 “Address Generator Units” for
details on Modulo and Bit-Reversed Addressing.
2.1
Core Overview
The working register array consists of 16 x 16-bit regis-
ters, each of which can act as data, address or offset
registers. One working register (W15) operates as a
Software Stack Pointer for interrupts and calls.
The core supports Inherent (no operand), Relative,
Literal, Memory Direct, Register Direct, Register
Indirect, Register Offset and Literal Offset Addressing
modes. Instructions are associated with pre-defined
addressing modes, depending upon their functional
requirements.
The data space is 64 Kbytes (32K words) and is split
into two blocks, referred to as X and Y data memory.
Each block has its own independent Address Genera-
tion Unit (AGU). Most instructions operate solely
through the X memory, AGU, which provides the
appearance of a single unified data space. The
Multiply-Accumulate (MAC) class of dual source DSP
instructions operate through both the X and Y AGUs,
splitting the data address space into two parts (see
Section 3.2 “Data Address Space”). The X and Y
data space boundary is device specific and cannot be
altered by the user. Each data word consists of 2 bytes
and most instructions can address data either as words
or bytes.
For most instructions, the core is capable of executing
a data (or program data) memory read, a working reg-
ister (data) read, a data memory write and a program
(instruction) memory read per instruction cycle. As a
result, 3 operand instructions are supported, allowing
C = A+B operations to be executed in a single cycle.
A DSP engine has been included to significantly
enhance the core arithmetic capability and throughput.
It features a high-speed 17-bit by 17-bit multiplier, a
40-bit ALU, two 40-bit saturating accumulators and a
40-bit bidirectional barrel shifter. Data in the accumula-
tor or any working register can be shifted up to 15 bits
right, or 16 bits left in a single cycle. The DSP instruc-
tions operate seamlessly with all other instructions and
have been designed for optimal real-time performance.
The MAC class of instructions can concurrently fetch
two data operands from memory while multiplying two
W registers. To enable this concurrent fetching of data
operands, the data space has been split for these
instructions and linear is for all others. This has been
achieved in a transparent and flexible manner, by ded-
icating certain working registers to each address space
for the MAC class of instructions.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 17
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
The core does not support a multi-stage instruction
pipeline. However, a single-stage instruction prefetch
mechanism is used, which accesses and partially
decodes instructions a cycle ahead of execution, in
order to maximize available execution time. Most
instructions execute in a single cycle with certain
exceptions.
2.2.1
SOFTWARE STACK POINTER/
FRAME POINTER
The dsPIC® DSC devices contain a software stack.
W15 is the dedicated Software Stack Pointer (SP),
which is automatically modified by exception process-
ing and subroutine calls and returns. However, W15
can be referenced by any instruction in the same man-
ner as all other W registers. This simplifies the reading,
writing and manipulation of the Stack Pointer (e.g., cre-
ating stack frames).
The core features a vectored exception processing
structure for traps and interrupts, with 62 independent
vectors. The exceptions consist of up to 8 traps (of
which 4 are reserved) and 54 interrupts. Each interrupt
is prioritized based on a user-assigned priority between
1 and 7 (1 being the lowest priority and 7 being the
highest), in conjunction with a predetermined ‘natural
order’. Traps have fixed priorities ranging from 8 to 15.
Note:
In order to protect against misaligned
stack accesses, W15<0> is always clear.
W15 is initialized to 0x0800 during a Reset. The user
may reprogram the SP during initialization to any
location within data space.
2.2
Programmer’s Model
W14 has been dedicated as a Stack Frame Pointer, as
defined by the LNK and ULNK instructions. However,
W14 can be referenced by any instruction in the same
manner as all other W registers.
The programmer’s model is shown in Figure 2-1 and
consists of 16 x 16-bit working registers (W0 through
W15), 2 x 40-bit accumulators (ACCA and ACCB),
STATUS register (SR), Data Table Page register
(TBLPAG), Program Space Visibility Page register
(PSVPAG), DO and REPEAT registers (DOSTART,
DOEND, DCOUNT and RCOUNT) and Program
Counter (PC). The working registers can act as data,
address or offset registers. All registers are memory
mapped. W0 acts as the W register for file register
addressing.
2.2.2
STATUS REGISTER
The dsPIC DSC core has a 16-bit STATUS register
(SR), the LSB of which is referred to as the SR Low
byte (SRL) and the MSB as the SR High byte (SRH).
See Figure 2-1 for SR layout.
SRL contains all the MCU ALU operation Status flags
(including the Z bit), as well as the CPU Interrupt Prior-
ity Level Status bits, IPL<2:0>, and the Repeat Active
Status bit, RA. During exception processing, SRL is
concatenated with the MSB of the PC to form a com-
plete word value which is then stacked.
Some of these registers have a shadow register asso-
ciated with each of them, as shown in Figure 2-1. The
shadow register is used as a temporary holding register
and can transfer its contents to or from its host register
upon the occurrence of an event. None of the shadow
registers are accessible directly. The following rules
apply for transfer of registers into and out of shadows.
The upper byte of the STATUS register contains the
DSP Adder/Subtracter Status bits, the DO Loop Active
bit (DA) and the Digit Carry (DC) Status bit.
• PUSH.Sand POP.S
W0, W1, W2, W3, SR (DC, N, OV, Z and C bits
only) are transferred.
2.2.3
PROGRAM COUNTER
The program counter is 23 bits wide; bit 0 is always
clear. Therefore, the PC can address up to 4M
instruction words.
• DOinstruction
DOSTART, DOEND, DCOUNT shadows are
pushed on loop start and popped on loop end.
When a byte operation is performed on a working reg-
ister, only the Least Significant Byte (LSB) of the target
register is affected. However, a benefit of memory
mapped working registers is that both the Least and
Most Significant Bytes (MSB) can be manipulated
through byte-wide data memory space accesses.
DS70139E-page 18
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 2-1:
PROGRAMMER’S MODEL
D15
D0
W0/WREG
W1
PUSH.SShadow
DOShadow
W2
W3
Legend
W4
DSP Operand
Registers
W5
W6
W7
Working Registers
W8
W9
DSP Address
Registers
W10
W11
W12/DSP Offset
W13/DSP Write-Back
W14/Frame Pointer
W15/Stack Pointer
SPLIM
Stack Pointer Limit Register
AD0
AD15
AD39
ACCA
AD31
DSP
Accumulators
ACCB
PC22
PC0
0
Program Counter
0
7
TBLPAG
Data Table Page Address
7
0
PSVPAG
Program Space Visibility Page Address
15
0
0
RCOUNT
REPEATLoop Counter
DOLoop Counter
15
DCOUNT
22
0
DOSTART
DOEND
DOLoop Start Address
DOLoop End Address
22
15
0
Core Configuration Register
CORCON
OA OB
SA SB OAB SAB DA DC
SRH
IPL0 RA
N
OV
Z
C
IPL2 IPL1
STATUS register
SRL
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 19
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
The divide instructions must be executed within a
REPEAT loop. Any other form of execution (e.g., a
series of discrete divide instructions) will not function
correctly because the instruction flow depends on
RCOUNT. The divide instruction does not automatically
set up the RCOUNT value and it must, therefore, be
explicitly and correctly specified in the REPEATinstruc-
tion, as shown in Table 2-1 (REPEATexecutes the tar-
get instruction {operand value+1} times). The REPEAT
loop count must be setup for 18 iterations of the DIV/
DIVF instruction. Thus, a complete divide operation
requires 19 cycles.
2.3
Divide Support
The dsPIC DSC devices feature a 16/16-bit signed
fractional divide operation, as well as 32/16-bit and 16/
16-bit signed and unsigned integer divide operations, in
the form of single instruction iterative divides. The fol-
lowing instructions and data sizes are supported:
1. DIVF- 16/16 signed fractional divide
2. DIV.sd- 32/16 signed divide
3. DIV.ud- 32/16 unsigned divide
4. DIV.s- 16/16 signed divide
5. DIV.u- 16/16 unsigned divide
Note:
The divide flow is interruptible. However,
the user needs to save the context as
appropriate.
The 16/16 divides are similar to the 32/16 (same number
of iterations), but the dividend is either zero-extended or
sign-extended during the first iteration.
TABLE 2-1:
Instruction
DIVIDE INSTRUCTIONS
Function
DIVF
Signed fractional divide: Wm/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
Signed divide: (Wm+1:Wm)/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
Signed divide: Wm/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
Unsigned divide: (Wm+1:Wm)/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
Unsigned divide: Wm/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
DIV.sd
DIV.s
DIV.ud
DIV.u
DS70139E-page 20
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
The DSP engine has various options selected through
various bits in the CPU Core Configuration register
(CORCON), as listed below:
2.4
DSP Engine
The DSP engine consists of a high-speed 17-bit x
17-bit multiplier, a barrel shifter and a 40-bit adder/
subtracter (with two target accumulators, round and
saturation logic).
1. Fractional or integer DSP multiply (IF).
2. Signed or unsigned DSP multiply (US).
3. Conventional or convergent rounding (RND).
4. Automatic saturation on/off for ACCA (SATA).
5. Automatic saturation on/off for ACCB (SATB).
The DSP engine also has the capability to perform
inherent
which require no additional data. These instructions are
accumulator-to-accumulator
operations,
ADD, SUBand NEG.
6. Automatic saturation on/off for writes to data
memory (SATDW).
The dsPIC30F is a single-cycle instruction flow archi-
tecture, therefore, concurrent operation of the DSP
engine with MCU instruction flow is not possible.
However, some MCU ALU and DSP engine resources
may be used concurrently by the same instruction (e.g.,
ED, EDAC). See Table 2-2.
7. Accumulator Saturation mode selection
(ACCSAT).
Note:
For CORCON layout, see Table 3-3.
A block diagram of the DSP engine is shown in
Figure 2-2.
TABLE 2-2:
DSP INSTRUCTION SUMMARY
Algebraic Operation
Instruction
ACC WB?
CLR
ED
A = 0
Yes
No
A = (x – y)2
A = A + (x – y)2
A = A + (x * y)
A = A + x2
EDAC
MAC
No
Yes
No
MAC
MOVSAC
MPY
No change in A
A = x * y
Yes
No
MPY.N
MSC
A = – x * y
No
A = A – x * y
Yes
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 21
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 2-2:
DSP ENGINE BLOCK DIAGRAM
S
a
40
16
40-bit Accumulator A
40-bit Accumulator B
40
t
Round
Logic
u
r
a
t
Carry/Borrow Out
Saturate
e
Adder
Carry/Borrow In
Negate
40
40
40
Barrel
Shifter
16
40
Sign-Extend
32
16
Zero Backfill
32
33
17-bit
Multiplier/Scaler
16
16
To/From W Array
DS70139E-page 22
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
2.4.1
MULTIPLIER
2.4.2.1
Adder/Subtracter, Overflow and
Saturation
The 17 x 17-bit multiplier is capable of signed or
unsigned operation and can multiplex its output using a
scaler to support either 1.31 fractional (Q31) or 32-bit
integer results. Unsigned operands are zero-extended
into the 17th bit of the multiplier input value. Signed
operands are sign-extended into the 17th bit of the mul-
tiplier input value. The output of the 17 x 17-bit multi-
plier/scaler is a 33-bit value which is sign-extended to
40 bits. Integer data is inherently represented as a
signed two’s complement value, where the MSB is
defined as a sign bit. Generally speaking, the range of
an N-bit two’s complement integer is -2N-1 to 2N-1 – 1.
For a 16-bit integer, the data range is -32768 (0x8000)
to 32767 (0x7FFF) including ‘0’. For a 32-bit integer,
the data range is -2,147,483,648 (0x8000 0000) to
2,147,483,645 (0x7FFF FFFF).
The adder/subtracter is a 40-bit adder with an optional
zero input into one side and either true or complement
data into the other input. In the case of addition, the
carry/borrow input is active high and the other input is
true data (not complemented), whereas in the case of
subtraction, the carry/borrow input is active low and the
other input is complemented. The adder/subtracter
generates overflow Status bits SA/SB and OA/OB,
which are latched and reflected in the STATUS register:
• Overflow from bit 39: this is a catastrophic
overflow in which the sign of the accumulator is
destroyed.
• Overflow into guard bits 32 through 39: this is a
recoverable overflow. This bit is set whenever all
the guard bits are not identical to each other.
When the multiplier is configured for fractional multipli-
cation, the data is represented as a two’s complement
fraction, where the MSB is defined as a sign bit and the
radix point is implied to lie just after the sign bit (QX for-
mat). The range of an N-bit two’s complement fraction
with this implied radix point is -1.0 to (1 – 21-N). For a
16-bit fraction, the Q15 data range is -1.0 (0x8000) to
0.999969482 (0x7FFF) including ‘0’ and has a preci-
sion of 3.01518x10-5. In Fractional mode, the 16x16
multiply operation generates a 1.31 product, which has
The adder has an additional saturation block which
controls accumulator data saturation if selected. It uses
the result of the adder, the overflow Status bits
described above, and the SATA/B (CORCON<7:6>)
and ACCSAT (CORCON<4>) mode control bits to
determine when and to what value to saturate.
Six STATUS register bits have been provided to
support saturation and overflow. They are:
1. OA:
a precision of 4.65661 x 10-10
.
ACCA overflowed into guard bits
The same multiplier is used to support the MCU multi-
ply instructions, which include integer 16-bit signed,
unsigned and mixed sign multiplies.
2. OB:
ACCB overflowed into guard bits
3. SA:
The MUL instruction can be directed to use byte or
word-sized operands. Byte operands direct a 16-bit
result. Word operands direct a 32-bit result to the spec-
ified register(s) in the W array.
ACCA saturated (bit 31 overflow and saturation)
or
ACCA overflowed into guard bits and saturated
(bit 39 overflow and saturation)
4. SB:
2.4.2
DATA ACCUMULATORS AND
ADDER/SUBTRACTER
ACCB saturated (bit 31 overflow and saturation)
or
ACCB overflowed into guard bits and saturated
(bit 39 overflow and saturation)
The data accumulator consists of a 40-bit adder/
subtracter with automatic sign extension logic. It can
select one of two accumulators (A or B) as its pre-
accumulation source and post-accumulation destina-
tion. For the ADDand LACinstructions, the data to be
accumulated or loaded can be optionally scaled via the
barrel shifter prior to accumulation.
5. OAB:
Logical OR of OA and OB
6. SAB:
Logical OR of SA and SB
The OA and OB bits are modified each time data
passes through the adder/subtracter. When set, they
indicate that the most recent operation has overflowed
into the accumulator guard bits (bits 32 through 39).
The OA and OB bits can also optionally generate an
arithmetic warning trap when set and the correspond-
ing overflow trap flag enable bit (OVATE, OVBTE) in
the INTCON1 register (refer to Section 8.0 “Inter-
rupts”) is set. This allows the user to take immediate
action, for example, to correct system gain.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 23
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
The SA and SB bits are modified each time data
passes through the adder/subtracter but can only be
cleared by the user. When set, they indicate that the
accumulator has overflowed its maximum range (bit 31
for 32-bit saturation or bit 39 for 40-bit saturation) and
will be saturated if saturation is enabled. When satura-
tion is not enabled, SA and SB default to bit 39 overflow
and thus indicate that a catastrophic overflow has
occurred. If the COVTE bit in the INTCON1 register is
set, SA and SB bits generate an arithmetic warning trap
when saturation is disabled.
2.4.2.2
Accumulator ‘Write-Back’
The MAC class of instructions (with the exception of
MPY, MPY.N, ED and EDAC) can optionally write a
rounded version of the high word (bits 31 through 16)
of the accumulator that is not targeted by the instruction
into data space memory. The write is performed across
the X bus into combined X and Y address space. The
following addressing modes are supported:
1. W13, Register Direct:
The rounded contents of the non-target
accumulator are written into W13 as a 1.15
fraction.
The overflow and saturation Status bits can optionally
be viewed in the STATUS register (SR) as the logical
OR of OA and OB (in bit OAB) and the logical OR of SA
and SB (in bit SAB). This allows programmers to check
one bit in the STATUS register to determine if either
accumulator has overflowed, or one bit to determine if
either accumulator has saturated. This would be useful
for complex number arithmetic which typically uses
both the accumulators.
2. [W13]+=2, Register Indirect with Post-Increment:
The rounded contents of the non-target accumu-
lator are written into the address pointed to by
W13 as
incremented by 2 (for a word write).
a
1.15 fraction. W13 is then
2.4.2.3
Round Logic
The round logic is a combinational block which per-
forms a conventional (biased) or convergent (unbi-
ased) round function during an accumulator write
(store). The Round mode is determined by the state of
the RND bit in the CORCON register. It generates a 16-
bit, 1.15 data value, which is passed to the data space
write saturation logic. If rounding is not indicated by the
instruction, a truncated 1.15 data value is stored and
the least significant word (lsw) is simply discarded.
The device supports three saturation and overflow
modes:
1. Bit 39 Overflow and Saturation:
When bit 39 overflow and saturation occurs, the
saturation logic loads the maximally positive 9.31
(0x7FFFFFFFFF) or maximally negative 9.31
value (0x8000000000) into the target accumula-
tor. The SA or SB bit is set and remains set until
cleared by the user. This is referred to as ‘super
saturation’ and provides protection against erro-
neous data or unexpected algorithm problems
(e.g., gain calculations).
Conventional rounding takes bit 15 of the accumulator,
zero-extends it and adds it to the ACCxH word (bits 16
through 31 of the accumulator). If the ACCxL word
(bits 0 through 15 of the accumulator) is between
0x8000 and 0xFFFF (0x8000 included), ACCxH is
incremented. If ACCxL is between 0x0000 and 0x7FFF,
ACCxH is left unchanged. A consequence of this algo-
rithm is that over a succession of random rounding
operations, the value tends to be biased slightly
positive.
2. Bit 31 Overflow and Saturation:
When bit 31 overflow and saturation occurs, the
saturation logic then loads the maximally posi-
tive 1.31 value (0x007FFFFFFF) or maximally
negative 1.31 value (0x0080000000) into the
target accumulator. The SA or SB bit is set and
remains set until cleared by the user. When this
Saturation mode is in effect, the guard bits are
not used, so the OA, OB or OAB bits are never
set.
Convergent (or unbiased) rounding operates in the
same manner as conventional rounding, except when
ACCxL equals 0x8000. If this is the case, the LSb
(bit 16 of the accumulator) of ACCxH is examined. If it
is ‘1’, ACCxH is incremented. If it is ‘0’, ACCxH is not
modified. Assuming that bit 16 is effectively random in
nature, this scheme will remove any rounding bias that
may accumulate.
3. Bit 39 Catastrophic Overflow:
The bit 39 overflow Status bit from the adder is
used to set the SA or SB bit which remains set
until cleared by the user. No saturation operation
is performed and the accumulator is allowed to
overflow (destroying its sign). If the COVTE bit in
the INTCON1 register is set, a catastrophic
overflow can initiate a trap exception.
The SAC and SAC.R instructions store either a trun-
cated (SAC) or rounded (SAC.R) version of the contents
of the target accumulator to data memory via the X bus
(subject to data saturation, see Section 2.4.2.4 “Data
Space Write Saturation”). Note that for the MACclass
of instructions, the accumulator write-back operation
functions in the same manner, addressing combined
MCU (X and Y) data space though the X bus. For this
class of instructions, the data is always subject to
rounding.
DS70139E-page 24
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
2.4.2.4
Data Space Write Saturation
2.4.3
BARREL SHIFTER
In addition to adder/subtracter saturation, writes to data
space may also be saturated but without affecting the
contents of the source accumulator. The data space
write saturation logic block accepts a 16-bit, 1.15 frac-
tional value from the round logic block as its input,
together with overflow status from the original source
(accumulator) and the 16-bit round adder. These are
combined and used to select the appropriate 1.15
fractional value as output to write to data space
memory.
The barrel shifter is capable of performing up to 16-bit
arithmetic or logic right shifts, or up to 16-bit left shifts
in a single cycle. The source can be either of the two
DSP accumulators, or the X bus (to support multi-bit
shifts of register or memory data).
The shifter requires a signed binary value to determine
both the magnitude (number of bits) and direction of the
shift operation. A positive value shifts the operand right.
A negative value shifts the operand left. A value of ‘0’
does not modify the operand.
If the SATDW bit in the CORCON register is set, data
(after rounding or truncation) is tested for overflow and
adjusted accordingly. For input data greater than
0x007FFF, data written to memory is forced to the max-
imum positive 1.15 value, 0x7FFF. For input data less
than 0xFF8000, data written to memory is forced to the
maximum negative 1.15 value, 0x8000. The MSb of the
source (bit 39) is used to determine the sign of the
operand being tested.
The barrel shifter is 40 bits wide, thereby obtaining a
40-bit result for DSP shift operations and a 16-bit result
for MCU shift operations. Data from the X bus is pre-
sented to the barrel shifter between bit positions 16 to
31 for right shifts, and bit positions 0 to 16 for left shifts.
If the SATDW bit in the CORCON register is not set, the
input data is always passed through unmodified under
all conditions.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 25
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 26
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Program memory is addressable by a 24-bit value from
3.0
MEMORY ORGANIZATION
either the 23-bit PC, table instruction Effective Address
(EA), or data space EA, when program space is
mapped into data space as defined by Table 3-1. Note
that the program space address is incremented by two
between successive program words in order to provide
compatibility with data space addressing.
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual “ (DS70157).
User program space access is restricted to the lower
4M instruction word address range (0x000000 to
0x7FFFFE) for all accesses other than TBLRD/TBLWT,
which uses TBLPAG<7> to determine user or configu-
ration space access. In Table 3-1, Program Space
Address Construction, bit 23 allows access to the
Device ID, the User ID and the Configuration bits.
Otherwise, bit 23 is always clear.
3.1
Program Address Space
The program address space is 4M instruction words.
The program space memory map for the dsPI30F2011/
2012 is shown in Figure 3-1. The program space
memory map for the dsPI30F3012/3013 is shown in
Figure 3-2.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 27
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 3-1:
dsPIC30F2011/2012
PROGRAM SPACE
MEMORY MAP
FIGURE 3-2:
dsPIC30F3012/3013
PROGRAM SPACE
MEMORY MAP
Reset - GOTOInstruction
Reset - Target Address
Reset - GOTOInstruction
Reset - Target Address
000000
000002
000004
000000
000002
000004
Interrupt Vector Table
Interrupt Vector Table
Vector Tables
Vector Tables
00007E
000080
000084
00007E
000080
Reserved
Reserved
Alternate Vector Table
Alternate Vector Table
000084
0000FE
000100
0000FE
000100
User Flash
User Flash
Program Memory
Program Memory
(4K instructions)
(8K instructions)
001FFE
002000
003FFE
004000
Reserved
(Read ‘0’s)
Reserved
7FFBFE
7FFC00
(Read ‘0’s)
Data EEPROM
(1 Kbyte)
7FFFFE
800000
7FFFFE
800000
Reserved
Reserved
8005BE
8005C0
8005BE
8005C0
UNITID (32 instr.)
Reserved
UNITID (32 instr.)
Reserved
8005FE
800600
8005FE
800600
F7FFFE
F7FFFE
Device Configuration
Registers
Device Configuration
Registers
F80000
F8000E
F80010
F80000
F8000E
F80010
Reserved
DEVID (2)
Reserved
DEVID (2)
FEFFFE
FF0000
FFFFFE
FEFFFE
FF0000
FFFFFE
DS70139E-page 28
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 3-1:
PROGRAM SPACE ADDRESS CONSTRUCTION
Program Space Address
Access
Space
Access Type
<23>
<22:16>
<15>
<14:1>
<0>
Instruction Access
User
User
(TBLPAG<7> = 0)
0
PC<22:1>
0
TBLRD/TBLWT
TBLPAG<7:0>
TBLPAG<7:0>
PSVPAG<7:0>
Data EA<15:0>
Data EA<15:0>
TBLRD/TBLWT
Configuration
(TBLPAG<7> = 1)
Program Space Visibility User
0
Data EA<14:0>
FIGURE 3-3:
DATA ACCESS FROM PROGRAM SPACE ADDRESS GENERATION
23 bits
Using
Program
Counter
Program Counter
0
0
0
Select
1
EA
Using
Program
Space
PSVPAG Reg
8 bits
Visibility
15 bits
EA
Using
1/0
TBLPAG Reg
8 bits
Table
Instruction
16 bits
User/
Configuration
Space
Select
Byte
Select
24-bit EA
Note:
Program space visibility cannot be used to access bits <23:16> of a word in program memory.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 29
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
A set of table instructions are provided to move byte or
word-sized data to and from program space. See Fig-
ure 3-4 and Figure 3-5.
3.1.1
DATA ACCESS FROM PROGRAM
MEMORY USING TABLE
INSTRUCTIONS
1. TBLRDL:Table Read Low
Word: Read the LS Word of the program address;
P<15:0> maps to D<15:0>.
This architecture fetches 24-bit wide program memory.
Consequently, instructions are always aligned.
However, as the architecture is modified Harvard, data
can also be present in program space.
Byte: Read one of the LSB of the program
address;
There are two methods by which program space can
be accessed: via special table instructions, or through
the remapping of a 16K word program space page into
the upper half of data space (see Section 3.1.2 “Data
Access from Program Memory Using Program
Space Visibility”). The TBLRDLand TBLWTLinstruc-
tions offer a direct method of reading or writing the lsw
of any address within program space, without going
through data space. The TBLRDHand TBLWTHinstruc-
tions are the only method whereby the upper 8 bits of a
program space word can be accessed as data.
P<7:0> maps to the destination byte when byte
select = 0;
P<15:8> maps to the destination byte when byte
select = 1.
2. TBLWTL:Table Write Low (refer to Section 5.0
“Flash Program Memory” for details on Flash
Programming)
3. TBLRDH:Table Read High
Word: Read the MS Word of the program address;
P<23:16> maps to D<7:0>; D<15:8> will always
be = 0.
The PC is incremented by two for each successive
24-bit program word. This allows program memory
addresses to directly map to data space addresses.
Program memory can thus be regarded as two 16-bit
word wide address spaces, residing side by side, each
with the same address range. TBLRDL and TBLWTL
access the space which contains the lsw, and TBLRDH
and TBLWTH access the space which contains the
MSB.
Byte: Read one of the MSB of the program
address;
P<23:16> maps to the destination byte when
byte select = 0;
The destination byte will always be = 0 when
byte select = 1.
4. TBLWTH:Table Write High (refer to Section 5.0
“Flash Program Memory” for details on Flash
Programming)
Figure 3-3 shows how the EA is created for table oper-
ations and data space accesses (PSV = 1). Here,
P<23:0> refers to a program space word, whereas
D<15:0> refers to a data space word.
FIGURE 3-4:
PROGRAM DATA TABLE ACCESS (lsw)
PC Address
23
8
16
0
0x000000
0x000002
0x000004
0x000006
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
TBLRDL.B (Wn<0> = 0)
TBLRDL.W
Program Memory
‘Phantom’ Byte
(read as ‘0’)
TBLRDL.B (Wn<0> = 1)
DS70139E-page 30
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 3-5:
PROGRAM DATA TABLE ACCESS (MSB)
TBLRDH.W
PC Address
23
8
0
16
0x000000
0x000002
0x000004
0x000006
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
TBLRDH.B (Wn<0> = 0)
Program Memory
‘Phantom’ Byte
(read as ‘0’)
TBLRDH.B (Wn<0> = 1)
Note that by incrementing the PC by 2 for each
program memory word, the LS 15 bits of data space
addresses directly map to the LS 15 bits in the corre-
sponding program space addresses. The remaining
bits are provided by the Program Space Visibility Page
register, PSVPAG<7:0>, as shown in Figure 3-6.
3.1.2
DATA ACCESS FROM PROGRAM
MEMORY USING PROGRAM
SPACE VISIBILITY
The upper 32 Kbytes of data space may optionally be
mapped into any 16K word program space page. This
provides transparent access of stored constant data
from X data space without the need to use special
instructions (i.e., TBLRDL/H, TBLWTL/Hinstructions).
Note:
PSV access is temporarily disabled during
table reads/writes.
Program space access through the data space occurs
if the MSb of the data space EA is set and program
space visibility is enabled by setting the PSV bit in the
Core Control register (CORCON). The functions of
CORCON are discussed in Section 2.4 “DSP
Engine”.
For instructions that use PSV which are executed
outside a REPEATloop:
• The following instructions require one instruction
cycle in addition to the specified execution time:
- MACclass of instructions with data operand
prefetch
Data accesses to this area add an additional cycle to
the instruction being executed, since two program
memory fetches are required.
- MOVinstructions
- MOV.Dinstructions
• All other instructions require two instruction cycles
in addition to the specified execution time of the
instruction.
Note that the upper half of addressable data space is
always part of the X data space. Therefore, when a
DSP operation uses program space mapping to access
this memory region, Y data space should typically con-
tain state (variable) data for DSP operations, whereas
X data space should typically contain coefficient
(constant) data.
For instructions that use PSV which are executed
inside a REPEATloop:
• The following instances require two instruction
cycles in addition to the specified execution time
of the instruction:
Although each data space address, 0x8000 and higher,
maps directly into a corresponding program memory
address (see Figure 3-6), only the lower 16 bits of the
24-bit program word are used to contain the data. The
upper 8 bits should be programmed to force an illegal
instruction to maintain machine robustness. Refer to
the “dsPIC30F/33F Programmer’s Reference Manual”
(DS70157) for details on instruction encoding.
- Execution in the first iteration
- Execution in the last iteration
- Execution prior to exiting the loop due to an
interrupt
- Execution upon re-entering the loop after an
interrupt is serviced
• Any other iteration of the REPEATloop allow the
instruction accessing data, using PSV, to execute
in a single cycle.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 31
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 3-6:
DATA SPACE WINDOW INTO PROGRAM SPACE OPERATION
Data Space
Program Space
0x0000
0x000000
PSVPAG(1)
15
15
EA<15> =
0
0x00
8
16
Data
Space
EA
0x8000
23
15
0
Address
EA<15> = 1
0x001200
0x001FFF
Concatenation
15
23
Upper Half of Data
Space is Mapped
into Program Space
0xFFFF
Data Read
BSET CORCON,#2 ; Set PSV bit
MOV
MOV
MOV
#0x0, W0
W0, PSVPAG
; Set PSVPAG register
0x9200, W0 ; Access program memory location
; using a data space access
Note 1: PSVPAG is an 8-bit register, containing bits <22:15> of the program space address.
DS70139E-page 32
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
When executing any instruction other than one of the
MACclass of instructions, the X block consists of the 64-
3.2
Data Address Space
The core has two data spaces. The data spaces can be
considered either separate (for some DSP instruc-
tions), or as one unified linear address range (for MCU
instructions). The data spaces are accessed using two
Address Generation Units (AGUs) and separate data
paths.
Kbyte data address space (including all Y addresses).
When executing one of the MAC class of instructions,
the X block consists of the 64-Kbyte data address
space, excluding the Y address block (for data reads
only). In other words, all other instructions regard the
entire data memory as one composite address space.
The MACclass instructions extract the Y address space
from data space and address it using EAs sourced from
W10 and W11. The remaining X data space is
addressed using W8 and W9. Both address spaces are
concurrently accessed only with the MAC class
instructions.
3.2.1
DATA SPACE MEMORY MAP
The data space memory is split into two blocks, X and
Y data space. A key element of this architecture is that
Y space is a subset of X space, and is fully contained
within X space. In order to provide an apparent Linear
Addressing space, X and Y spaces have contiguous
addresses.
The data space memory map for the dsPIC30F2011
and dsPIC30F2012 is shown in Figure 3-7. The data
space memory map for the dsPIC30F3012 and
dsPIC30F3013 is shown in Figure 3-8.
FIGURE 3-7:
dsPIC30F2011/2012 DATA SPACE MEMORY MAP
LSB
Address
MSB
Address
16 bits
MSB
LSB
0x0000
0x0001
2 Kbyte
SFR Space
SFR Space
0x07FE
0x0800
0x07FF
0x0801
8 Kbyte
Near
Data
X Data RAM (X)
Y Data RAM (Y)
0x09FF
0x0A01
0x09FE
0x0A00
1 Kbyte
SRAM Space
Space
0x0BFF
0x0C01
0x0BFE
0x0C00
0x1FFF
0x1FFE
0x8001
0x8000
X Data
Unimplemented (X)
Optionally
Mapped
into Program
Memory
0xFFFF
0xFFFE
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 33
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 3-8:
dsPIC30F3012/3013 DATA SPACE MEMORY MAP
LSB
Address
MSB
Address
16 bits
MSB
LSB
SFR Space
0x0000
0x0001
2 Kbyte
SFR Space
0x07FE
0x0800
0x07FF
0x0801
8 Kbyte
Near
Data
X Data RAM (X)
Y Data RAM (Y)
0x0BFF
0x0C01
0x0BFE
0x0C00
2 Kbyte
SRAM Space
Space
0x0FFF
0x1001
0x0FFE
0x1000
0x1FFF
0x1FFE
0x8001
0x8000
X Data
Unimplemented (X)
Optionally
Mapped
into Program
Memory
0xFFFF
0xFFFE
DS70139E-page 34
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 3-9:
DATA SPACE FOR MCU AND DSP (MACCLASS) INSTRUCTIONS EXAMPLE
SFR SPACE
SFR SPACE
UNUSED
Y SPACE
UNUSED
(Y SPACE)
UNUSED
Non-MACClass Ops (Read/Write)
MACClass Ops (Write)
MACClass Ops (Read)
Indirect EA using any W
Indirect EA using W8, W9 Indirect EA using W10, W11
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 35
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
3.2.2
DATA SPACES
3.2.3
DATA SPACE WIDTH
The X data space is used by all instructions and sup-
ports all addressing modes. There are separate read
and write data buses. The X read data bus is the return
data path for all instructions that view data space as
combined X and Y address space. It is also the X
address space data path for the dual operand read
instructions (MAC class). The X write data bus is the
only write path to data space for all instructions.
The core data width is 16 bits. All internal registers are
organized as 16-bit wide words. Data space memory is
organized in byte addressable, 16-bit wide blocks.
3.2.4
DATA ALIGNMENT
To help maintain backward compatibility with PIC®
MCU devices and improve data space memory usage
efficiency, the dsPIC30F instruction set supports both
word and byte operations. Data is aligned in data mem-
ory and registers as words, but all data space EAs
resolve to bytes. Data byte reads read the complete
word that contains the byte, using the LSb of any EA to
determine which byte to select. The selected byte is
placed onto the LSB of the X data path (no byte
accesses are possible from the Y data path as the MAC
class of instruction can only fetch words). That is, data
memory and registers are organized as two parallel
byte wide entities with shared (word) address decode
but separate write lines. Data byte writes only write to
the corresponding side of the array or register which
matches the byte address.
The X data space also supports Modulo Addressing for
all instructions, subject to Addressing mode restric-
tions. Bit-Reversed Addressing is only supported for
writes to X data space.
The Y data space is used in concert with the X data
space by the MAC class of instructions (CLR, ED,
EDAC, MAC, MOVSAC, MPY, MPY.N and MSC) to
provide two concurrent data read paths. No writes
occur across the Y bus. This class of instructions dedi-
cates two W register pointers, W10 and W11, to always
address Y data space, independent of X data space,
whereas W8 and W9 always address X data space.
Note that during accumulator write back, the data
address space is considered a combination of X and Y
data spaces, so the write occurs across the X bus.
Consequently, the write can be to any address in the
entire data space.
As a consequence of this byte accessibility, all Effective
Address calculations (including those generated by the
DSP operations which are restricted to word-sized
data) are internally scaled to step through word-aligned
memory. For example, the core would recognize that
Post-Modified Register Indirect Addressing mode
[Ws++] results in a value of Ws + 1 for byte operations
and Ws + 2 for word operations.
The Y data space can only be used for the data
prefetch operation associated with the MAC class of
instructions. It also supports Modulo Addressing for
automated circular buffers. Of course, all other instruc-
tions can access the Y data address space through the
X data path as part of the composite linear space.
All word accesses must be aligned to an even address.
Misaligned word data fetches are not supported so
care must be taken when mixing byte and word opera-
tions, or translating from 8-bit MCU code. Should a mis-
aligned read or write be attempted, an address error
trap is generated. If the error occurred on a read, the
instruction underway is completed, whereas if it
occurred on a write, the instruction is executed, but the
write does not occur. In either case, a trap is then exe-
cuted, allowing the system and/or user to examine the
machine state prior to execution of the address fault.
The boundary between the X and Y data spaces is
defined as shown in Figure 3-8 and is not user pro-
grammable. Should an EA point to data outside its own
assigned address space, or to a location outside phys-
ical memory, an all zero word/byte is returned. For
example, although Y address space is visible by all
non-MAC instructions using any addressing mode, an
attempt by a MAC instruction to fetch data from that
space using W8 or W9 (X space pointers) returns
0x0000.
FIGURE 3-10:
MSB
DATA ALIGNMENT
LSB
TABLE 3-2:
EFFECT OF INVALID
MEMORY ACCESSES
15
8 7
0
0000
0002
0004
0001
0003
0005
Byte 1
Byte 3
Byte 5
Byte 0
Byte 2
Byte 4
Attempted Operation
Data Returned
EA = an unimplemented address
0x0000
0x0000
W8 or W9 used to access Y data
space in a MACinstruction
W10 or W11 used to access X
0x0000
data space in a MACinstruction
All Effective Addresses are 16 bits wide and point to
bytes within the data space. Therefore, the data space
address range is 64 Kbytes or 32K words.
DS70139E-page 36
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
All byte loads into any W register are loaded into the
LSB. The MSB is not modified.
There is a Stack Pointer Limit register (SPLIM) associ-
ated with the Stack Pointer. SPLIM is uninitialized at
Reset. As is the case for the Stack Pointer, SPLIM<0>
is forced to ‘0’ because all stack operations must be
word aligned. Whenever an Effective Address (EA) is
generated using W15 as a source or destination
pointer, the address thus generated is compared with
the value in SPLIM. If the contents of the Stack Pointer
(W15) and the SPLIM register are equal, and a push
operation is performed, a stack error trap does not
occur. The stack error trap occurs on a subsequent
push operation. Thus, for example, if it is desirable to
cause a stack error trap when the stack grows beyond
address 0x2000 in RAM, initialize the SPLIM with the
value, 0x1FFE.
A Sign-Extend (SE) instruction is provided to allow
users to translate 8-bit signed data to 16-bit signed
values. Alternatively, for 16-bit unsigned data, users
can clear the MSB of any W register by executing a
Zero-Extend (ZE) instruction on the appropriate
address.
Although most instructions are capable of operating on
word or byte data sizes, it should be noted that some
instructions, including the DSP instructions, operate
only on words.
3.2.5
NEAR DATA SPACE
An 8-Kbyte ‘near’ data space is reserved in X address
memory space between 0x0000 and 0x1FFF, which is
directly addressable via a 13-bit absolute address field
within all memory direct instructions. The remaining X
address space and all of the Y address space is
addressable indirectly. Additionally, the whole of X data
space is addressable using MOV instructions, which
support memory direct addressing with a 16-bit
address field.
Similarly, a Stack Pointer underflow (stack error) trap is
generated when the Stack Pointer address is found to
be less than 0x0800, thus preventing the stack from
interfering with the Special Function Register (SFR)
space.
A write to the SPLIM register should not be immediately
followed by an indirect read operation using W15.
3.2.6
SOFTWARE STACK
The dsPIC DSC devices contain a software stack. W15
is used as the Stack Pointer.
The Stack Pointer always points to the first available
free word and grows from lower addresses towards
higher addresses. It pre-decrements for stack pops
and post-increments for stack pushes, as shown in
Figure 3-11. Note that for a PC push during any CALL
instruction, the MSB of the PC is zero-extended before
the push, ensuring that the MSB is always clear.
Note:
A PC push during exception processing
concatenates the SRL register to the MSB
of the PC prior to the push.
FIGURE 3-11:
CALLSTACK FRAME
0x0000
15
0
PC<15:0>
000000000
W15 (before CALL)
PC<22:16>
<Free Word>
W15 (after CALL)
POP : [--W15]
PUSH: [W15++]
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 37
TABLE 3-3:
CORE REGISTER MAP
Address
(Home)
SFR Name
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
W0
0000
0002
0004
0006
0008
000A
000C
000E
0010
0012
0014
0016
0018
001A
001C
001E
0020
0022
0024
0026
0028
002A
002C
002E
0030
0032
0034
0036
0038
003A
003C
003E
0040
0042
W0/WREG
W1
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 1000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu0
0000 0000 0uuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu0
0000 0000 0uuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
W1
W2
W2
W3
W3
W4
W4
W5
W5
W6
W6
W7
W7
W8
W8
W9
W9
W10
W10
W11
W12
W13
W14
W15
SPLIM
ACCAL
ACCAH
W11
W12
W13
W14
W15
SPLIM
ACCAL
ACCAH
ACCAU
ACCBL
ACCBH
ACCBU
PCL
Sign Extension (ACCA<39>)
Sign Extension (ACCB<39>)
ACCAU
ACCBL
ACCBH
ACCBU
PCL
—
PCH
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PCH
TBLPAG
PSVPAG
TBLPAG
PSVPAG
RCOUNT
DCOUNT
DOSTARTL
DOSTARTH
DOENDL
—
—
RCOUNT
DCOUNT
DOSTARTL
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DOSTARTH
DOENDL
0
DOENDH
SR
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DOENDH
N
OA
OB
SA
SB
OAB
SAB
DA
DC
IPL2
IPL1
IPL0
RA
OV
Z
C
Legend:
Note:
u= uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TABLE 3-3:
CORE REGISTER MAP (CONTINUED)
Address
(Home)
SFR Name
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
CORCON
MODCON
XMODSRT
XMODEND
YMODSRT
YMODEND
XBREV
0044
0046
0048
004A
004C
004E
0050
0052
—
—
—
—
US
—
EDT
DL2
DL1
DL0
SATA
SATB SATDW ACCSAT
YWM<3:0>
IPL3
PSV
RND
IF
0000 0000 0010 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu1
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu1
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
XMODEN YMODEN
BWM<3:0>
XWM<3:0>
XS<15:1>
XE<15:1>
YS<15:1>
YE<15:1>
0
1
0
1
BREN
XB<14:0>
DISICNT
—
—
DISICNT<13:0>
Legend:
Note:
u= uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 40
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
4.1.1
FILE REGISTER INSTRUCTIONS
4.0
ADDRESS GENERATOR UNITS
Most file register instructions use a 13-bit address field
(f) to directly address data present in the first 8192
bytes of data memory (near data space). Most file
register instructions employ a working register, W0,
which is denoted as WREG in these instructions. The
destination is typically either the same file register or
WREG (with the exception of the MUL instruction),
which writes the result to a register or register pair. The
MOV instruction allows additional flexibility and can
access the entire data space during file register
operation.
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual“ (DS70157).
The dsPIC DSC core contains two independent
address generator units: the X AGU and Y AGU. The Y
AGU supports word-sized data reads for the DSP MAC
class of instructions only. The dsPIC DSC AGUs sup-
port three types of data addressing:
4.1.2
MCU INSTRUCTIONS
• Linear Addressing
The three-operand MCU instructions are of the form:
Operand 3 = Operand 1 <function> Operand 2
• Modulo (Circular) Addressing
• Bit-Reversed Addressing
where Operand 1 is always a working register (i.e., the
addressing mode can only be register direct), which is
referred to as Wb. Operand 2 can be a W register,
fetched from data memory or a 5-bit literal. The result
location can be either a W register or an address
location. The following addressing modes are
supported by MCU instructions:
Linear and Modulo Data Addressing modes can be
applied to data space or program space. Bit-Reversed
Addressing is only applicable to data space addresses.
4.1
Instruction Addressing Modes
The addressing modes in Table 4-1 form the basis of
the addressing modes optimized to support the specific
features of individual instructions. The addressing
modes provided in the MAC class of instructions are
somewhat different from those in the other instruction
types.
• Register Direct
• Register Indirect
• Register Indirect Post-modified
• Register Indirect Pre-modified
• 5-bit or 10-bit Literal
Note:
Not all instructions support all the address-
ing modes given above. Individual
instructions may support different subsets
of these addressing modes.
TABLE 4-1:
FUNDAMENTAL ADDRESSING MODES SUPPORTED
Description
The address of the File register is specified explicitly.
Addressing Mode
File Register Direct
Register Direct
The contents of a register are accessed directly.
The contents of Wn forms the EA.
Register Indirect
Register Indirect Post-modified
The contents of Wn forms the EA. Wn is post-modified (incremented or
decremented) by a constant value.
Register Indirect Pre-modified
Wn is pre-modified (incremented or decremented) by a signed constant value
to form the EA.
Register Indirect with Register Offset The sum of Wn and Wb forms the EA.
Register Indirect with Literal Offset
The sum of Wn and a literal forms the EA.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 41
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
In summary, the following addressing modes are
supported by the MACclass of instructions:
4.1.3
MOVE AND ACCUMULATOR
INSTRUCTIONS
• Register Indirect
Move instructions and the DSP accumulator class of
instructions provide a greater degree of addressing
flexibility than other instructions. In addition to the
addressing modes supported by most MCU instruc-
tions, move and accumulator instructions also support
Register Indirect with Register Offset Addressing
mode, also referred to as Register Indexed mode.
• Register Indirect Post-modified by 2
• Register Indirect Post-modified by 4
• Register Indirect Post-modified by 6
• Register Indirect with Register Offset (Indexed)
4.1.5
OTHER INSTRUCTIONS
Note:
For the MOV instructions, the addressing
mode specified in the instruction can differ
for the source and destination EA.
However, the 4-bit Wb (register offset)
field is shared between both source and
destination (but typically only used by
one).
Besides the various addressing modes outlined above,
some instructions use literal constants of various sizes.
For example, BRA (branch) instructions use 16-bit
signed literals to specify the branch destination directly,
whereas the DISI instruction uses a 14-bit unsigned
literal field. In some instructions, such as ADD Acc, the
source of an operand or result is implied by the opcode
itself. Certain operations, such as NOP, do not have any
operands.
In summary, the following addressing modes are
supported by move and accumulator instructions:
• Register Direct
4.2
Modulo Addressing
• Register Indirect
• Register Indirect Post-modified
• Register Indirect Pre-modified
• Register Indirect with Register Offset (Indexed)
• Register Indirect with Literal Offset
• 8-bit Literal
Modulo Addressing is a method of providing an auto-
mated means to support circular data buffers using
hardware. The objective is to remove the need for soft-
ware to perform data address boundary checks when
executing tightly looped code, as is typical in many
DSP algorithms.
• 16-bit Literal
Modulo Addressing can operate in either data or pro-
gram space (since the data pointer mechanism is
essentially the same for both). One circular buffer can
be supported in each of the X (which also provides the
pointers into program space) and Y data spaces. Mod-
ulo Addressing can operate on any W register pointer.
However, it is not advisable to use W14 or W15 for Mod-
ulo Addressing since these two registers are used as
the Stack Frame Pointer and Stack Pointer, respec-
tively.
Note:
Not all instructions support all the address-
ing modes given above. Individual
instructions may support different subsets
of these addressing modes.
4.1.4
MACINSTRUCTIONS
The dual source operand DSP instructions (CLR, ED,
EDAC, MAC, MPY, MPY.N, MOVSACand MSC), also
referred to as MACinstructions, utilize a simplified set of
addressing modes to allow the user to effectively
manipulate the data pointers through register indirect
tables.
In general, any particular circular buffer can only be
configured to operate in one direction, as there are cer-
tain restrictions on the buffer Start address (for incre-
menting buffers), or end address (for decrementing
buffers) based upon the direction of the buffer.
The two source operand prefetch registers must belong
to the set {W8, W9, W10, W11}. For data reads, W8
and W9 are always directed to the X RAGU. W10 and
W11 are always directed to the Y AGU. The effective
addresses generated (before and after modification)
must, therefore, be valid addresses within X data space
for W8 and W9 and Y data space for W10 and W11.
The only exception to the usage restrictions is for buff-
ers that have a power-of-2 length. As these buffers sat-
isfy the Start and end address criteria, they can operate
in a Bidirectional mode (i.e., address boundary checks
are performed on both the lower and upper address
boundaries).
Note:
Register Indirect with Register Offset
addressing is only available for W9 (in X
space) and W11 (in Y space).
DS70139E-page 42
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
4.2.1
START AND END ADDRESS
4.2.2
W ADDRESS REGISTER
SELECTION
The Modulo Addressing scheme requires that a start-
ing and an ending address be specified and loaded
into the 16-bit Modulo Buffer Address registers:
XMODSRT, XMODEND, YMODSRT and YMODEND
(see Table 3-3).
The Modulo and Bit-Reversed Addressing Control reg-
ister, MODCON<15:0>, contains enable flags as well
as a W register field to specify the W address registers.
The XWM and YWM fields select which registers oper-
ate with Modulo Addressing. If XWM = 15, X RAGU
and X WAGU Modulo Addressing is disabled. Similarly,
if YWM = 15, Y AGU Modulo Addressing is disabled.
Note:
Y space Modulo Addressing EA calcula-
tions assume word-sized data (LSb of
every EA is always clear).
The X Address Space Pointer W register (XWM), to
which Modulo Addressing is to be applied, is stored in
MODCON<3:0> (see Table 3-3). Modulo Addressing is
enabled for X data space when XWM is set to any value
other than ‘15’ and the XMODEN bit is set at
MODCON<15>.
The length of a circular buffer is not directly specified. It
is determined by the difference between the corre-
sponding Start and end addresses. The maximum pos-
sible length of the circular buffer is 32K words
(64 Kbytes).
The Y Address Space Pointer W register (YWM), to
which Modulo Addressing is to be applied, is stored in
MODCON<7:4>. Modulo Addressing is enabled for Y
data space when YWM is set to any value other than
‘15’ and the YMODEN bit is set at MODCON<14>.
FIGURE 4-1:
MODULO ADDRESSING OPERATION EXAMPLE
Byte
Address
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
#0x1100,W0
W0,XMODSRT
#0x1163,W0
W0,MODEND
#0x8001,W0
W0,MODCON
;set modulo start address
;set modulo end address
;enable W1, X AGU for modulo
;W0 holds buffer fill value
;point W1 to buffer
0x1100
MOV
MOV
#0x0000,W0
#0x1110,W1
DO
AGAIN,#0x31 ;fill the 50 buffer locations
MOV
W0,[W1++]
;fill the next location
;increment the fill value
AGAIN: INC W0,W0
0x1163
Start Addr = 0x1100
End Addr = 0x1163
Length = 0x0032 words
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 43
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
If the length of a bit-reversed buffer is M = 2N bytes,
then the last ‘N’ bits of the data buffer Start address
must be zeros.
4.2.3
MODULO ADDRESSING
APPLICABILITY
Modulo Addressing can be applied to the Effective
Address (EA) calculation associated with any W regis-
ter. It is important to realize that the address bound-
aries check for addresses less than, or greater than the
upper (for incrementing buffers), and lower (for decre-
menting buffers) boundary addresses (not just equal
to). Address changes may, therefore, jump beyond
boundaries and still be adjusted correctly.
XB<14:0> is the bit-reversed address modifier or ‘pivot
point’ which is typically a constant. In the case of an
FFT computation, its value is equal to half of the FFT
data buffer size.
Note:
All bit-reversed EA calculations assume
word-sized data (LSb of every EA is
always clear). The XB value is scaled
accordingly to generate compatible (byte)
addresses.
Note:
The modulo corrected Effective Address is
written back to the register only when Pre-
Modify or Post-Modify Addressing mode is
used to compute the Effective Address.
When an address offset (e.g., [W7+W2]) is
used, Modulo address correction is per-
formed, but the contents of the register
remain unchanged.
When enabled, Bit-Reversed Addressing is only exe-
cuted for register indirect with pre-increment or post-
increment addressing and word-sized data writes. It
does not function for any other addressing mode or for
byte-sized data. Normal addresses are generated
instead. When Bit-Reversed Addressing is active, the
W address pointer is always added to the address
modifier (XB) and the offset associated with the Regis-
ter Indirect Addressing mode is ignored. In addition, as
word-sized data is a requirement, the LSb of the EA is
ignored (and always clear).
4.3
Bit-Reversed Addressing
Bit-Reversed Addressing is intended to simplify data
re-ordering for radix-2 FFT algorithms. It is supported
by the X AGU for data writes only.
Note:
Modulo Addressing and Bit-Reversed
Addressing should not be enabled
together. In the event that the user attempts
to do this, Bit-Reversed Addressing
assumes priority when active for the X
WAGU, and X WAGU Modulo Addressing
is disabled. However, Modulo Addressing
continues to function in the X RAGU.
The modifier, which may be a constant value or register
contents, is regarded as having its bit order reversed. The
address source and destination are kept in normal order.
Thus, the only operand requiring reversal is the modifier.
4.3.1
BIT-REVERSED ADDRESSING
IMPLEMENTATION
Bit-Reversed Addressing is enabled when:
If Bit-Reversed Addressing has already been enabled
by setting the BREN (XBREV<15>) bit, then a write to
the XBREV register should not be immediately followed
by an indirect read operation using the W register that
has been designated as the bit-reversed pointer.
1. BWM (W register selection) in the MODCON
register is any value other than ‘15’ (the stack
cannot be accessed using Bit-Reversed
Addressing) and
2. the BREN bit is set in the XBREV register and
3. the addressing mode used is Register Indirect
with Pre-Increment or Post-Increment.
DS70139E-page 44
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 4-2:
BIT-REVERSED ADDRESS EXAMPLE
Sequential Address
b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1
0
Bit Locations Swapped Left-to-Right
Around Center of Binary Value
b2 b3 b4
0
b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b1
Bit-Reversed Address
Pivot Point
XB = 0x0008 for a 16-word Bit-Reversed Buffer
TABLE 4-2:
BIT-REVERSED ADDRESS SEQUENCE (16-ENTRY)
Normal Address Bit-Reversed Address
A3
A2
A1
A0
Decimal
A3
A2
A1
A0
Decimal
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
8
2
4
3
12
2
4
5
10
6
6
7
14
1
8
9
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
5
13
3
11
7
15
TABLE 4-3:
BIT-REVERSED ADDRESS MODIFIER VALUES FOR XBREV REGISTER
Buffer Size (Words)
XB<14:0> Bit-Reversed Address Modifier Value
1024
512
256
128
64
32
16
8
0x0200
0x0100
0x0080
0x0040
0x0020
0x0010
0x0008
0x0004
0x0002
0x0001
4
2
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 45
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 46
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
5.2
Run-Time Self-Programming
(RTSP)
5.0
FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
RTSP is accomplished using TBLRD (table read) and
TBLWT(table write) instructions.
With RTSP, the user may erase program memory, 32
instructions (96 bytes) at a time and can write program
memory data, 32 instructions (96 bytes) at a time.
The dsPIC30F family of devices contains internal pro-
gram Flash memory for executing user code. There are
two methods by which the user can program this
memory:
5.3
Table Instruction Operation
Summary
The TBLRDLand the TBLWTLinstructions are used to
read or write to bits<15:0> of program memory.
TBLRDLand TBLWTLcan access program memory in
Word or Byte mode.
1. Run-Time Self-Programming (RTSP)
2. In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™)
The TBLRDHand TBLWTHinstructions are used to read
or write to bits<23:16> of program memory. TBLRDH
and TBLWTHcan access program memory in Word or
Byte mode.
5.1
In-Circuit Serial Programming
(ICSP)
dsPIC30F devices can be serially programmed while in
the end application circuit. This is simply done with two
lines for Programming Clock and Programming Data
(which are named PGC and PGD respectively), and
three other lines for Power (VDD), Ground (VSS) and
Master Clear (MCLR). This allows customers to manu-
facture boards with unprogrammed devices, and then
program the microcontroller just before shipping the
product. This also allows the most recent firmware or a
custom firmware to be programmed.
A 24-bit program memory address is formed using
bits<7:0> of the TBLPAG register and the Effective
Address (EA) from a W register specified in the table
instruction, as shown in Figure 5-1.
FIGURE 5-1:
ADDRESSING FOR TABLE AND NVM REGISTERS
24 bits
Using
Program
Counter
Program Counter
0
0
NVMADR Reg EA
Using
NVMADR
Addressing
1/0 NVMADRU Reg
8 bits
16 bits
Working Reg EA
Using
Table
Instruction
1/0
TBLPAG Reg
8 bits
16 bits
Byte
Select
User/Configuration
Space Select
24-bit EA
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 47
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
5.4
RTSP Operation
5.5
Control Registers
The dsPIC30F Flash program memory is organized
into rows and panels. Each row consists of 32 instruc-
tions or 96 bytes. Each panel consists of 128 rows or
4K x 24 instructions. RTSP allows the user to erase one
row (32 instructions) at a time and to program four
instructions at one time. RTSP may be used to program
multiple program memory panels, but the Table Pointer
must be changed at each panel boundary.
The four SFRs used to read and write the program
Flash memory are:
• NVMCON
• NVMADR
• NVMADRU
• NVMKEY
5.5.1
NVMCON REGISTER
Each panel of program memory contains write latches
that hold 32 instructions of programming data. Prior to
the actual programming operation, the write data must
be loaded into the panel write latches. The data to be
programmed into the panel is loaded in sequential
order into the write latches; instruction 0, instruction 1,
etc. The instruction words loaded must always be from
a 32 address boundary.
The NVMCON register controls which blocks are to be
erased, which memory type is to be programmed, and
start of the programming cycle.
5.5.2
NVMADR REGISTER
The NVMADR register is used to hold the lower two
bytes of the Effective Address. The NVMADR register
captures the EA<15:0> of the last table instruction that
has been executed and selects the row to write.
The basic sequence for RTSP programming is to set up
a Table Pointer, then do a series of TBLWTinstructions
to load the write latches. Programming is performed by
setting the special bits in the NVMCON register. 32
TBLWTL and four TBLWTH instructions are required to
load the 32 instructions. If multiple panel programming
is required, the Table Pointer needs to be changed and
the next set of multiple write latches written.
5.5.3
NVMADRU REGISTER
The NVMADRU register is used to hold the upper byte
of the Effective Address. The NVMADRU register cap-
tures the EA<23:16> of the last table instruction that
has been executed.
All of the table write operations are single-word writes
(2 instruction cycles), because only the table latches
are written. A programming cycle is required for
programming each row.
5.5.4
NVMKEY REGISTER
NVMKEY is a write-only register that is used for write
protection. To start a programming or an erase
sequence, the user must consecutively write 0x55 and
0xAA to the NVMKEY register. Refer to Section 5.6
“Programming Operations” for further details.
The Flash Program Memory is readable, writable and
erasable during normal operation over the entire VDD
range.
Note:
The user can also directly write to the
NVMADR and NVMADRU registers to
specify a program memory address for
erasing or programming.
DS70139E-page 48
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
4. Write 32 instruction words of data from data
5.6
Programming Operations
RAM “image” into the program Flash write
latches.
A complete programming sequence is necessary for
programming or erasing the internal Flash in RTSP
mode. A programming operation is nominally 2 msec in
duration and the processor stalls (waits) until the oper-
ation is finished. Setting the WR bit (NVMCON<15>)
starts the operation and the WR bit is automatically
cleared when the operation is finished.
5. Program 32 instruction words into program
Flash.
a) Setup NVMCON register for multi-word,
program Flash, program, and set WREN
bit.
b) Write ‘55’ to NVMKEY.
5.6.1
PROGRAMMING ALGORITHM FOR
PROGRAM FLASH
c) Write ‘AA’ to NVMKEY.
d) Set the WR bit. This begins program cycle.
e) CPU stalls for duration of the program cycle.
The user can erase or program one row of program
Flash memory at a time. The general process is:
f) The WR bit is cleared by the hardware
when program cycle ends.
1. Read one row of program Flash (32 instruction
words) and store into data RAM as a data
“image”.
6. Repeat steps 1 through 5 as needed to program
desired amount of program Flash memory.
2. Update the data image with the desired new
data.
5.6.2
ERASING A ROW OF PROGRAM
MEMORY
3. Erase program Flash row.
Example 5-1 shows a code sequence that can be used
to erase a row (32 instructions) of program memory.
a) Setup NVMCON register for multi-word,
program Flash, erase, and set WREN bit.
b) Write address of row to be erased into
NVMADRU/NVMDR.
c) Write ‘55’ to NVMKEY.
d) Write ‘AA’ to NVMKEY.
e) Set the WR bit. This begins erase cycle.
f) CPU stalls for the duration of the erase cycle.
g) The WR bit is cleared when erase cycle
ends.
EXAMPLE 5-1:
ERASING A ROW OF PROGRAM MEMORY
; Setup NVMCON for erase operation, multi word write
; program memory selected, and writes enabled
MOV
MOV
#0x4041,W0
W0 NVMCON
;
; Init NVMCON SFR
,
; Init pointer to row to be ERASED
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
DISI
#tblpage(PROG_ADDR),W0
;
W0 NVMADRU
; Initialize PM Page Boundary SFR
; Intialize in-page EA[15:0] pointer
; Initialize NVMADR SFR
; Block all interrupts with priority <7 for
; next 5 instructions
,
#tbloffset(PROG_ADDR),W0
W0, NVMADR
#5
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
BSET
NOP
NOP
#0x55,W0
W0 NVMKEY
; Write the 0x55 key
;
; Write the 0xAA key
; Start the erase sequence
; Insert two NOPs after the erase
; command is asserted
,
#0xAA,W1
W1 NVMKEY
,
NVMCON,#WR
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 49
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
5.6.3
LOADING WRITE LATCHES
5.6.4
INITIATING THE PROGRAMMING
SEQUENCE
Example 5-2 shows a sequence of instructions that
can be used to load the 96 bytes of write latches. 32
TBLWTL and 32 TBLWTH instructions are needed to
load the write latches selected by the Table Pointer.
For protection, the write initiate sequence for NVMKEY
must be used to allow any erase or program operation
to proceed. After the programming command has been
executed, the user must wait for the programming time
until programming is complete. The two instructions fol-
lowing the start of the programming sequence should
be NOPs as shown in Example 5-3.
EXAMPLE 5-2:
LOADING WRITE LATCHES
; Set up a pointer to the first program memory location to be written
; program memory selected, and writes enabled
MOV
MOV
MOV
#0x0000,W0
;
W0 TBLPAG
; Initialize PM Page Boundary SFR
; An example program memory address
,
#0x6000,W0
; Perform the TBLWT instructions to write the latches
; 0th_program_word
MOV
MOV
#LOW_WORD_0,W2
#HIGH_BYTE_0,W3
;
;
TBLWTL W2 [W0]
; Write PM low word into program latch
; Write PM high byte into program latch
,
TBLWTH W3 [W0++]
,
; 1st_program_word
MOV
MOV
#LOW_WORD_1,W2
#HIGH_BYTE_1,W3
;
;
TBLWTL W2 [W0]
; Write PM low word into program latch
; Write PM high byte into program latch
,
TBLWTH W3 [W0++]
,
;
2nd_program_word
MOV
MOV
#LOW_WORD_2,W2
#HIGH_BYTE_2,W3
;
;
TBLWTL W2 [W0]
; Write PM low word into program latch
; Write PM high byte into program latch
,
TBLWTH W3 [W0++]
,
•
•
•
; 31st_program_word
MOV
MOV
#LOW_WORD_31,W2
#HIGH_BYTE_31,W3
;
;
TBLWTL W2 [W0]
; Write PM low word into program latch
; Write PM high byte into program latch
,
TBLWTH W3 [W0++]
,
Note: In Example 5-2, the contents of the upper byte of W3 has no effect.
EXAMPLE 5-3:
INITIATING A PROGRAMMING SEQUENCE
DISI
#5
; Block all interrupts with priority <7 for
; next 5 instructions
;
; Write the 0x55 key
;
; Write the 0xAA key
; Start the erase sequence
; Insert two NOPs after the erase
; command is asserted
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
BSET
NOP
NOP
#0x55,W0
W0 NVMKEY
,
#0xAA,W1
W1 NVMKEY
,
NVMCON,#WR
DS70139E-page 50
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 5-1:
NVM REGISTER MAP
File Name
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
All RESETS
NVMCON
NVMADR
NVMADRU
NVMKEY
0760
0762
0764
0766
WR
WREN
WRERR
—
—
—
—
TWRI
—
PROGOP<6:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
NVMADR<15:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
NVMADR<23:16>
KEY<7:0>
Legend:
Note:
u= uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 52
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Control bit WR initiates write operations similar to pro-
6.0
DATA EEPROM MEMORY
gram Flash writes. This bit cannot be cleared, only set,
in software. They are cleared in hardware at the com-
pletion of the write operation. The inability to clear the
WR bit in software prevents the accidental or
premature termination of a write operation.
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual“ (DS70157).
The WREN bit, when set, allows a write operation. On
power-up, the WREN bit is clear. The WRERR bit is set
when a write operation is interrupted by a MCLR Reset
or a WDT Time-out Reset during normal operation. In
these situations, following Reset, the user can check
the WRERR bit and rewrite the location. The address
register NVMADR remains unchanged.
The data EEPROM memory is readable and writable
during normal operation over the entire VDD range. The
data EEPROM memory is directly mapped in the
program memory address space.
The four SFRs used to read and write the program
Flash memory are used to access data EEPROM
memory, as well. As described in Section 5.5 “Control
Registers”, these registers are:
Note:
Interrupt flag bit NVMIF in the IFS0 regis-
ter is set when write is complete. It must be
cleared in software.
• NVMCON
• NVMADR
• NVMADRU
• NVMKEY
6.1
Reading the Data EEPROM
A TBLRD instruction reads a word at the current pro-
gram word address. This example uses W0 as a
pointer to data EEPROM. The result is placed in
register W4 as shown in Example 6-1.
The EEPROM data memory allows read and write of
single words and 16-word blocks. When interfacing to
data memory, NVMADR, in conjunction with the
NVMADRU register, are used to address the
EEPROM location being accessed. TBLRDL and
TBLWTLinstructions are used to read and write data
EEPROM. The dsPIC30F devices have up to 8 Kbytes
(4K words) of data EEPROM with an address range
from 0x7FF000 to 0x7FFFFE.
EXAMPLE 6-1:
DATA EEPROM READ
MOV
MOV
MOV
#LOW_ADDR_WORD,W0 ; Init Pointer
#HIGH_ADDR_WORD,W1
W1 TBLPAG
,
TBLRDL [ W0 ], W4
; read data EEPROM
A word write operation should be preceded by an erase
of the corresponding memory location(s). The write typ-
ically requires 2 ms to complete, but the write time
varies with voltage and temperature.
A program or erase operation on the data EEPROM
does not stop the instruction flow. The user is respon-
sible for waiting for the appropriate duration of time
before initiating another data EEPROM write/erase
operation. Attempting to read the data EEPROM while
a programming or erase operation is in progress results
in unspecified data.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 53
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
6.2
Erasing Data EEPROM
6.2.1
ERASING A BLOCK OF DATA
EEPROM
In order to erase a block of data EEPROM, the
NVMADRU and NVMADR registers must initially point
to the block of memory to be erased. Configure
NVMCON for erasing a block of data EEPROM and
set the WR and WREN bits in the NVMCON register.
Setting the WR bit initiates the erase, as shown in
Example 6-2.
EXAMPLE 6-2:
DATA EEPROM BLOCK ERASE
; Select data EEPROM block, WR, WREN bits
MOV
MOV
#0x4045,W0
W0 NVMCON
; Initialize NVMCON SFR
,
; Start erase cycle by setting WR after writing key sequence
DISI
#5
; Block all interrupts with priority <7 for
; next 5 instructions
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
BSET
NOP
NOP
#0x55,W0
;
W0 NVMKEY
; Write the 0x55 key
;
; Write the 0xAA key
; Initiate erase sequence
,
#0xAA,W1
W1 NVMKEY
,
NVMCON,#WR
; Erase cycle will complete in 2mS. CPU is not stalled for the Data Erase Cycle
; User can poll WR bit, use NVMIF or Timer IRQ to determine erasure complete
6.2.2
ERASING A WORD OF DATA
EEPROM
The NVMADRU and NVMADR registers must point to
the block. Select WR a block of data Flash and set the
WR and WREN bits in the NVMCON register. Setting
the WR bit initiates the erase, as shown in Example 6-
3.
EXAMPLE 6-3:
DATA EEPROM WORD ERASE
; Select data EEPROM word, WR, WREN bits
MOV
MOV
#0x4044,W0
W0 NVMCON
,
; Start erase cycle by setting WR after writing key sequence
DISI
#5
; Block all interrupts with priority <7 for
; next 5 instructions
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
BSET
NOP
NOP
#0x55,W0
;
W0 NVMKEY
; Write the 0x55 key
;
; Write the 0xAA key
; Initiate erase sequence
,
#0xAA,W1
W1 NVMKEY
,
NVMCON,#WR
; Erase cycle will complete in 2mS. CPU is not stalled for the Data Erase Cycle
; User can poll WR bit, use NVMIF or Timer IRQ to determine erasure complete
DS70139E-page 54
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
The write does not initiate if the above sequence is not
6.3
Writing to the Data EEPROM
exactly followed (write 0x55 to NVMKEY, write 0xAA to
NVMCON, then set WR bit) for each word. It is strongly
recommended that interrupts be disabled during this
code segment.
To write an EEPROM data location, the following
sequence must be followed:
1. Erase data EEPROM word.
a) Select word, data EEPROM erase, and set
WREN bit in NVMCON register.
Additionally, the WREN bit in NVMCON must be set to
enable writes. This mechanism prevents accidental
writes to data EEPROM due to unexpected code exe-
cution. The WREN bit should be kept clear at all times
except when updating the EEPROM. The WREN bit is
not cleared by hardware.
b) Write address of word to be erased into
NVMADR.
c) Enable NVM interrupt (optional).
d) Write ‘55’ to NVMKEY.
After a write sequence has been initiated, clearing the
WREN bit does not affect the current write cycle. The
WR bit is inhibited from being set unless the WREN bit
is set. The WREN bit must be set on a previous instruc-
tion. Both WR and WREN cannot be set with the same
instruction.
e) Write ‘AA’ to NVMKEY.
f) Set the WR bit. This begins erase cycle.
g) Either poll NVMIF bit or wait for NVMIF
interrupt.
h) The WR bit is cleared when the erase cycle
ends.
At the completion of the write cycle, the WR bit is
cleared in hardware and the Nonvolatile Memory Write
Complete Interrupt Flag bit (NVMIF) is set. The user
may either enable this interrupt or poll this bit. NVMIF
must be cleared by software.
2. Write data word into data EEPROM write
latches.
3. Program 1 data word into data EEPROM.
a) Select word, data EEPROM program, and
set WREN bit in NVMCON register.
6.3.1
WRITING A WORD OF DATA
EEPROM
b) Enable NVM write done interrupt (optional).
c) Write ‘55’ to NVMKEY.
Once the user has erased the word to be programmed,
then a table write instruction is used to write one write
latch, as shown in Example 6-4.
d) Write ‘AA’ to NVMKEY.
e) Set the WR bit. This begins program cycle.
f) Either poll NVMIF bit or wait for NVM
interrupt.
6.3.2
WRITING A BLOCK OF DATA
EEPROM
g) The WR bit is cleared when the write cycle
ends.
To write a block of data EEPROM, write to all sixteen
latches first, then set the NVMCON register and
program the block.
EXAMPLE 6-4:
DATA EEPROM WORD WRITE
; Point to data memory
MOV
MOV
#LOW_ADDR_WORD,W0
#HIGH_ADDR_WORD,W1
; Init pointer
MOV
W1 TBLPAG
,
MOV
#LOW(WORD),W2
; Get data
TBLWTL
W2 [ W0]
; Write data
,
; The NVMADR captures last table access address
; Select data EEPROM for 1 word op
MOV
MOV
#0x4004,W0
W0 NVMCON
,
; Operate key to allow write operation
DISI
#5
; Block all interrupts with priority <7 for
; next 5 instructions
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
BSET
NOP
NOP
#0x55,W0
W0 NVMKEY
; Write the 0x55 key
,
#0xAA,W1
W1 NVMKEY
; Write the 0xAA key
; Initiate program sequence
,
NVMCON,#WR
; Write cycle will complete in 2mS. CPU is not stalled for the Data Write Cycle
; User can poll WR bit, use NVMIF or Timer IRQ to determine write complete
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 55
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
EXAMPLE 6-5:
DATA EEPROM BLOCK WRITE
MOV
MOV
#LOW_ADDR_WORD,W0 ; Init pointer
#HIGH_ADDR_WORD,W1
MOV
W1 TBLPAG
,
MOV
#data1,W2
; Get 1st data
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data2,W2
; write data
; Get 2nd data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data3,W2
; write data
; Get 3rd data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data4,W2
; write data
; Get 4th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data5,W2
; write data
; Get 5th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data6,W2
; write data
; Get 6th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data7,W2
; write data
; Get 7th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data8,W2
; write data
; Get 8th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data9,W2
; write data
; Get 9th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data10,W2
; write data
; Get 10th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data11,W2
; write data
; Get 11th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data12,W2
; write data
; Get 12th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data13,W2
; write data
; Get 13th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data14,W2
; write data
; Get 14th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data15,W2
; write data
; Get 15th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#data16,W2
; write data
; Get 16th data
,
TBLWTL
MOV
MOV
W2 [ W0]++
#0x400A,W0
; write data. The NVMADR captures last table access address.
; Select data EEPROM for multi word op
; Operate Key to allow program operation
; Block all interrupts with priority <7 for
; next 5 instructions
,
W0 NVMCON
,
DISI
#5
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
BSET
NOP
NOP
#0x55,W0
W0 NVMKEY
; Write the 0x55 key
,
#0xAA,W1
W1 NVMKEY
; Write the 0xAA key
; Start write cycle
,
NVMCON,#WR
6.4
Write Verify
6.5
Protection Against Spurious Write
Depending on the application, good programming
practice may dictate that the value written to the mem-
ory should be verified against the original value. This
should be used in applications where excessive writes
can stress bits near the specification limit.
There are conditions when the device may not want to
write to the data EEPROM memory. To protect against
spurious EEPROM writes, various mechanisms have
been built-in. On power-up, the WREN bit is cleared;
also, the Power-up Timer prevents EEPROM write.
The write initiate sequence and the WREN bit together
help prevent an accidental write during brown-out,
power glitch, or software malfunction.
DS70139E-page 56
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Any bit and its associated data and Control registers
that are not valid for a particular device are disabled.
7.0
I/O PORTS
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual “ (DS70046).
That means the corresponding LATx and TRISx
registers and the port pin read as zeros.
When a pin is shared with another peripheral or func-
tion that is defined as an input only, it is nevertheless
regarded as a dedicated port because there is no
other competing source of outputs.
All of the device pins (except VDD, VSS, MCLR and
OSC1/CLKI) are shared between the peripherals and
the parallel I/O ports.
A parallel I/O (PIO) port that shares a pin with a periph-
eral is, in general, subservient to the peripheral. The
peripheral’s output buffer data and control signals are
provided to a pair of multiplexers. The multiplexers
select whether the peripheral or the associated port
has ownership of the output data and control signals of
the I/O pad cell. Figure 7-1 shows how ports are shared
with other peripherals and the associated I/O cell (pad)
to which they are connected.
All I/O input ports feature Schmitt Trigger inputs for
improved noise immunity.
7.1
Parallel I/O (PIO) Ports
When a peripheral is enabled and the peripheral is
actively driving an associated pin, the use of the pin as
a general purpose output pin is disabled. The I/O pin
can be read, but the output driver for the parallel port bit
is disabled. If a peripheral is enabled, but the peripheral
is not actively driving a pin, that pin can be driven by a
port.
The format of the registers for the shared ports,
(PORTB, PORTC, PORTD and PORTF) are shown in
Table 7-1 through Table 7-6.
Note:
The actual bits in use vary between
devices.
All port pins have three registers directly associated
with the operation of the port pin. The Data Direction
register (TRISx) determines whether the pin is an input
or an output. If the data direction bit is a ‘1’, then the pin
is an input. All port pins are defined as inputs after a
Reset. Reads from the latch (LATx), read the latch.
Writes to the latch, write the latch (LATx). Reads from
the port (PORTx), read the port pins and writes to the
port pins, write the latch (LATx).
FIGURE 7-1:
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF A SHARED PORT STRUCTURE
Output Multiplexers
Peripheral Module
Peripheral Input Data
Peripheral Module Enable
Peripheral Output Enable
Peripheral Output Data
I/O Cell
1
0
Output Enable
1
0
Output Data
PIO Module
Read TRIS
I/O Pad
Data Bus
WR TRIS
D
Q
CK
TRIS Latch
D
Q
WR LAT +
WR Port
CK
Data Latch
Read LAT
Read Port
Input Data
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 57
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
7.2.1
I/O PORT WRITE/READ TIMING
7.2
Configuring Analog Port Pins
One instruction cycle is required between a port
direction change or port write operation and a read
operation of the same port. Typically this instruction
would be a NOP.
The use of the ADPCFG and TRIS registers control the
operation of the A/D port pins. The port pins that are
desired as analog inputs must have their correspond-
ing TRIS bit set (input). If the TRIS bit is cleared
(output), the digital output level (VOH or VOL) is
converted.
EXAMPLE 7-1:
PORT WRITE/READ
EXAMPLE
When the PORT register is read, all pins configured as
analog input channels are read as cleared (a low level).
MOV #0xF0, W0; Configure PORTB<7:4>
; as inputs
MOV W0, TRISB; and PORTB<3:0> as outputs
Pins configured as digital inputs will not convert an ana-
log input. Analog levels on any pin that is defined as a
digital input (including the ANx pins) may cause the
input buffer to consume current that exceeds the
device specifications.
NOP
; additional instruction cycle
btss PORTB, #7; bit test RB7 and skip if set
DS70139E-page 58
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 7-1:
PORTB REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F2011/3012
SFR
Addr.
Name
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TRISB
PORTB
LATB
02C6
02C8
02CB
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TRISB7 TRISB6 TRISB5 TRISB4 TRISB3 TRISB2 TRISB1 TRISB0 0000 0000 1111 1111
RB7 RB6 RB5 RB4 RB3 RB2 RB1 RB0 0000 0000 0000 0000
LATB7 LATB6 LATB5 LATB4 LATB3 LATB2 LATB1 LATB0 0000 0000 0000 0000
TABLE 7-2:
PORTB REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F2012/3013
SFR
Addr.
Name
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TRISB
PORTB
LATB
02C6
02C8
02CB
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TRISB9 TRISB8 TRISB7 TRISB6 TRISB5 TRISB4 TRISB3 TRISB2 TRISB1 TRISB0 0000 0011 1111 1111
RB9
RB8
RB7
RB6
RB5
RB4
RB3
RB2
RB1
RB0
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATB9
LATB8
LATB7 LATB6 LATB5 LATB4 LATB3 LATB2 LATB1 LATB0 0000 0000 0000 0000
TABLE 7-3:
PORTC REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
SFR
Name
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TRISC
PORTC
LATC
02CC
02CE
02D0
TRISC15 TRISC14 TRISC13
RC15 RC14 RC13
LATC15 LATC14 LATC13
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1110 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
TABLE 7-4:
PORTD REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F2011/3012
SFR
Addr.
Name
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TRISD
PORTD 02D4
LATD 02D6
02D2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TRISD0 0000 0000 0000 0001
RD0 0000 0000 0000 0000
LATD0 0000 0000 0000 0000
TABLE 7-5:
PORTD REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F2012/3013
SFR
Addr.
Name
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TRISD
PORTD 02D4
LATD 02D6
02D2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TRISD9 TRISD8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0011 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
RD9
RD8
LATD9
LATD8
TABLE 7-6:
PORTF REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F2012/3013
SFR
Addr.
Name
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TRISF
PORTF 02E0
LATF 02E2
02DE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TRISF6 TRISF5 TRISF4 TRISF3 TRISF2
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0111 1100
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
RF6
RF5
RF4
RF3
RF2
LATF6
LATF5
LATF4
LATF3
LATF2
Note:
The dsPIC30F2011/3012 do not have TRISF, PORTF or LATF.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
7.3
Input Change Notification Module
The input change notification module provides the
dsPIC30F devices the ability to generate interrupt
requests to the processor, in response to a change of
state on selected input pins. This module is capable of
detecting input change of states even in Sleep mode,
when the clocks are disabled. There are up to 10 exter-
nal signals (CN0 through CN7, CN17 and CN18) that
may be selected (enabled) for generating an interrupt
request on a change of state.
TABLE 7-7:
INPUT CHANGE NOTIFICATION REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F2011/3012 (BITS 7-0)
SFR
Name
Addr.
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
CNEN1
CNEN2
CNPU1
CNPU2
00C0
00C2
00C4
00C6
CN7IE
—
CN6IE
—
CN5IE
—
CN4IE
—
CN3IE
—
CN2IE
—
CN1IE
—
CN0IE
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
CN7PUE CN6PUE CN5PUE CN4PUE CN3PUE CN2PUE CN1PUE
CN0PUE 0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TABLE 7-8:
INPUT CHANGE NOTIFICATION REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F2012/3013 (BITS 7-0)
SFR
Name
Addr.
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
CNEN1
CNEN2
CNPU1
CNPU2
00C0
00C2
00C4
00C6
CN7IE
—
CN6IE
—
CN5IE
—
CN4IE
—
CN3IE
—
CN2IE
CN1IE
CN0IE
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
CN18IE
CN17IE
CN7PUE CN6PUE CN5PUE CN4PUE CN3PUE CN2PUE CN1PUE
CN18PUE CN17PUE
CN0PUE 0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
—
—
—
—
—
Note: Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 61
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 62
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
• INTCON1<15:0>, INTCON2<15:0>
Global interrupt control functions are derived from
8.0
INTERRUPTS
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
these two registers. INTCON1 contains the con-
trol and status flags for the processor exceptions.
The INTCON2 register controls the external
interrupt request signal behavior and the use of
the alternate vector table.
Note:
Interrupt flag bits get set when an interrupt
condition occurs, regardless of the state of
its corresponding enable bit. User soft-
ware should ensure the appropriate inter-
rupt flag bits are clear prior to enabling an
interrupt.
The dsPIC30F sensor family has up to 21 interrupt
sources and 4 processor exceptions (traps) which must
be arbitrated based on a priority scheme.
The CPU is responsible for reading the Interrupt Vector
Table (IVT) and transferring the address contained in
the interrupt vector to the program counter. The inter-
rupt vector is transferred from the program data bus
into the program counter via a 24-bit wide multiplexer
on the input of the program counter.
All interrupt sources can be user assigned to one of 7
priority levels, 1 through 7, via the IPCx registers. Each
interrupt source is associated with an interrupt vector,
as shown in Table 8-1. Levels 7 and 1 represent the
highest and lowest maskable priorities, respectively.
The Interrupt Vector Table (IVT) and Alternate Interrupt
Vector Table (AIVT) are placed near the beginning of
program memory (0x000004). The IVT and AIVT are
shown in Figure 8-1.
Note:
Assigning a priority level of ‘0’ to an inter-
rupt source is equivalent to disabling that
interrupt.
If the NSTDIS bit (INTCON1<15>) is set, nesting of
interrupts is prevented. Thus, if an interrupt is currently
being serviced, processing of a new interrupt is pre-
vented even if the new interrupt is of higher priority than
the one currently being serviced.
The interrupt controller is responsible for pre-
processing the interrupts and processor exceptions
before they are presented to the processor core. The
peripheral interrupts and traps are enabled, prioritized
and controlled using centralized Special Function Reg-
isters:
Note:
The IPL bits become read-only whenever
the NSTDIS bit has been set to ‘1’.
• IFS0<15:0>, IFS1<15:0>, IFS2<15:0>
All interrupt request flags are maintained in these
three registers. The flags are set by their respec-
tive peripherals or external signals and they are
cleared via software.
Certain interrupts have specialized control bits for fea-
tures like edge or level triggered interrupts, interrupt-
on-change, etc. Control of these features remains
within the peripheral module which generates the
interrupt.
• IEC0<15:0>, IEC1<15:0>, IEC2<15:0>
All interrupt enable control bits are maintained in
these three registers. These control bits are used
to individually enable interrupts from the
peripherals or external signals.
The DISI instruction can be used to disable the
processing of interrupts of priorities 6 and lower for a
certain number of instructions, during which the DISI bit
(INTCON2<14>) remains set.
• IPC0<15:0>... IPC10<7:0>
When an interrupt is serviced, the PC is loaded with the
address stored in the vector location in program mem-
ory that corresponds to the interrupt. There are 63 dif-
ferent vectors within the IVT (refer to Table 8-1). These
vectors are contained in locations 0x000004 through
0x0000FE of program memory (refer to Table 8-1).
These locations contain 24-bit addresses, and in order
to preserve robustness, an address error trap takes
place if the PC attempts to fetch any of these words
during normal execution. This prevents execution of
random data as a result of accidentally decrementing a
PC into vector space, accidentally mapping a data
space address into vector space, or the PC rolling over
to 0x000000 after reaching the end of implemented
program memory space. Execution of a GOTOinstruc-
tion to this vector space also generates an address
error trap.
The user assignable priority level associated with
each of these 41 interrupts is held centrally in
these eleven registers.
• IPL<3:0>
The current CPU priority level is explicitly stored
in the IPL bits. IPL<3> is present in the CORCON
register, whereas IPL<2:0> are present in the
STATUS register (SR) in the processor core.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 63
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 8-1:
INTERRUPT VECTOR TABLE
8.1
Interrupt Priority
INT
Vector
The user assignable interrupt priority (IP<2:0>) bits for
each individual interrupt source are located in the LS
3 bits of each nibble within the IPCx register(s). Bit 3 of
each nibble is not used and is read as a ‘0’. These bits
define the priority level assigned to a particular interrupt
by the user.
Interrupt Source
Number Number
Highest Natural Order Priority
0
1
8
INT0 — External Interrupt 0
IC1 — Input Capture 1
OC1 — Output Compare 1
T1 — Timer 1
9
2
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Note:
The user selectable priority levels start at
0 as the lowest priority and level 7 as the
highest priority.
3
4
IC2 — Input Capture 2
OC2 — Output Compare 2
T2 — Timer 2
5
Natural Order Priority is determined by the position of
an interrupt in the vector table, and only affects
interrupt operation when multiple interrupts with the
same user-assigned priority become pending at the
same time.
6
7
T3 — Timer 3
8
SPI1
9
U1RX — UART1 Receiver
U1TX — UART1 Transmitter
ADC — ADC Convert Done
NVM — NVM Write Complete
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17-22
23
24
25
26-41
42
43-53
Table 8-1 lists the interrupt numbers and interrupt
sources for the dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
devices and their associated vector numbers.
2
SI2C — I C™ Slave Interrupt
2
Note 1: The natural order priority scheme has 0
as the highest priority and 53 as the
lowest priority.
MI2C — I C Master Interrupt
Input Change Interrupt
INT1 — External Interrupt 1
2: The natural order priority number is the
25-30 Reserved
same as the INT number.
31
32
33
INT2 — External Interrupt 2
The ability for the user to assign every interrupt to one
of seven priority levels means that the user can assign
a very high overall priority level to an interrupt with a
low natural order priority. For example, the PLVD (Low
Voltage Detect) can be given a priority of 7. The INT0
(External Interrupt 0) may be assigned to priority level
1, thus giving it a very low effective priority.
U2RX* — UART2 Receiver
U2TX* — UART2 Transmitter
34-49 Reserved
50
LVD — Low-Voltage Detect
51-61 Reserved
Lowest Natural Order Priority
*
Only the dsPIC30F3013 has UART2 and the U2RX,
U2TX interrupts. These locations are reserved for
the dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012.
DS70139E-page 64
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
8.2
Reset Sequence
8.3
Traps
A Reset is not a true exception because the interrupt
controller is not involved in the Reset process. The pro-
cessor initializes its registers in response to a Reset
which forces the PC to zero. The processor then begins
program execution at location 0x000000. A GOTO
instruction is stored in the first program memory loca-
tion immediately followed by the address target for the
GOTOinstruction. The processor executes the GOTOto
the specified address and then begins operation at the
specified target (start) address.
Traps can be considered as non-maskable interrupts
indicating a software or hardware error, which adhere
to a predefined priority as shown in Figure 8-1. They
are intended to provide the user a means to correct
erroneous operation during debug and when operating
within the application.
Note:
If the user does not intend to take correc-
tive action in the event of a trap error
condition, these vectors must be loaded
with the address of a default handler that
simply contains the RESET instruction. If,
on the other hand, one of the vectors
containing an invalid address is called, an
address error trap is generated.
8.2.1
RESET SOURCES
In addition to external Reset and Power-on Reset
(POR), there are 6 sources of error conditions which
‘trap’ to the Reset vector.
Note that many of these trap conditions can only be
detected when they occur. Consequently, the question-
able instruction is allowed to complete prior to trap
exception processing. If the user chooses to recover
from the error, the result of the erroneous action that
caused the trap may have to be corrected.
• Watchdog Time-out:
The watchdog has timed out, indicating that the
processor is no longer executing the correct flow
of code.
• Uninitialized W Register Trap:
An attempt to use an uninitialized W register as
an Address Pointer causes a Reset.
There are 8 fixed priority levels for traps: Level 8
through Level 15, which implies that the IPL3 is always
set during processing of a trap.
• Illegal Instruction Trap:
Attempted execution of any unused opcodes
results in an illegal instruction trap. Note that a
fetch of an illegal instruction does not result in an
illegal instruction trap if that instruction is flushed
prior to execution due to a flow change.
If the user is not currently executing a trap, and he sets
the IPL<3:0> bits to a value of ‘0111’ (Level 7), then all
interrupts are disabled, but traps can still be processed.
8.3.1
TRAP SOURCES
• Brown-out Reset (BOR):
The following traps are provided with increasing prior-
ity. However, since all traps can be nested, priority has
little effect.
A momentary dip in the power supply to the
device has been detected which may result in
malfunction.
• Trap Lockout:
Occurrence of multiple trap conditions
simultaneously causes a Reset.
Math Error Trap:
The math error trap executes under the following three
circumstances:
1. If an attempt is made to divide by zero, the
divide operation is aborted on a cycle boundary
and the trap is taken.
2. If enabled, a math error trap is taken when an
arithmetic operation on either accumulator A or
B causes an overflow from bit 31 and the accu-
mulator guard bits are not utilized.
3. If enabled, a math error trap is taken when an
arithmetic operation on either accumulator A or
B causes a catastrophic overflow from bit 39 and
all saturation is disabled.
4. If the shift amount specified in a shift instruction
is greater than the maximum allowed shift
amount, a trap occurs.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 65
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Address Error Trap:
Stack Error Trap:
This trap is initiated when any of the following
circumstances occurs:
This trap is initiated under the following conditions:
1. The Stack Pointer is loaded with a value which
is greater than the (user programmable) limit
value written into the SPLIM register (stack
overflow).
1. A misaligned data word access is attempted.
2. A data fetch from our unimplemented data
memory location is attempted.
2. The Stack Pointer is loaded with a value which
is less than 0x0800 (simple stack underflow).
3. A data access of an unimplemented program
memory location is attempted.
4. An instruction fetch from vector space is
attempted.
Oscillator Fail Trap:
This trap is initiated if the external oscillator fails and
operation becomes reliant on an internal RC backup.
Note:
In the MAC class of instructions, wherein
the data space is split into X and Y data
space, unimplemented X space includes
all of Y space, and unimplemented Y
space includes all of X space.
8.3.2
HARD AND SOFT TRAPS
It is possible that multiple traps can become active
within the same cycle (e.g., a misaligned word stack
write to an overflowed address). In such a case, the
fixed priority shown in Figure 8-2 is implemented,
which may require the user to check if other traps are
pending, in order to completely correct the Fault.
5. Execution of a “BRA #literal” instruction or a
“GOTO #literal” instruction, where literal
is an unimplemented program memory address.
6. Executing instructions after modifying the PC to
point to unimplemented program memory
addresses. The PC may be modified by loading
a value into the stack and executing a RETURN
instruction.
‘Soft’ traps include exceptions of priority level 8 through
level 11, inclusive. The arithmetic error trap (level 11)
falls into this category of traps.
‘Hard’ traps include exceptions of priority level 12
through level 15, inclusive. The address error (level
12), stack error (level 13) and oscillator error (level 14)
traps fall into this category.
Each hard trap that occurs must be acknowledged
before code execution of any type can continue. If a
lower priority hard trap occurs while a higher priority
trap is pending, acknowledged, or is being processed,
a hard trap conflict occurs.
The device is automatically Reset in a hard trap conflict
condition. The TRAPR Status bit (RCON<15>) is set
when the Reset occurs, so that the condition may be
detected in software.
DS70139E-page 66
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 8-1:
TRAP VECTORS
FIGURE 8-2:
INTERRUPT STACK
FRAME
Reset - GOTOInstruction
Reset - GOTOAddress
0x000000
0x000002
0x000004
0x0000 15
0
Reserved
Oscillator Fail Trap Vector
Address Error Trap Vector
Stack Error Trap Vector
Math Error Trap Vector
Reserved Vector
IVT
Reserved Vector
Reserved Vector
Interrupt 0 Vector
Interrupt 1 Vector
—
W15 (before CALL)
W15 (after CALL)
PC<15:0>
SRL IPL3 PC<22:16>
<Free Word>
0x000014
—
—
Interrupt 52 Vector
Interrupt 53 Vector
Reserved
POP :[--W15]
PUSH:[W15++]
0x00007E
0x000080
0x000082
Reserved
0x000084
Reserved
Oscillator Fail Trap Vector
Stack Error Trap Vector
Address Error Trap Vector
Math Error Trap Vector
Reserved Vector
Note 1: The user can always lower the priority
level by writing a new value into SR. The
Interrupt Service Routine must clear the
interrupt flag bits in the IFSx register
before lowering the processor interrupt
priority, in order to avoid recursive
interrupts.
AIVT
Reserved Vector
Reserved Vector
0x000094
0x0000FE
Interrupt 0 Vector
Interrupt 1 Vector
—
—
—
Interrupt 52 Vector
Interrupt 53 Vector
2: The IPL3 bit (CORCON<3>) is always
clear when interrupts are being pro-
cessed. It is set only during execution of
traps.
8.4
Interrupt Sequence
All interrupt event flags are sampled in the beginning of
each instruction cycle by the IFSx registers. A pending
Interrupt Request (IRQ) is indicated by the flag bit
being equal to a ‘1’ in an IFSx register. The IRQ causes
an interrupt to occur if the corresponding bit in the Inter-
rupt Enable (IECx) register is set. For the remainder of
the instruction cycle, the priorities of all pending inter-
rupt requests are evaluated.
The RETFIE(return from interrupt) instruction unstacks
the program counter and STATUS registers to return
the processor to its state prior to the interrupt
sequence.
8.5
Alternate Vector Table
In program memory, the Interrupt Vector Table (IVT) is
followed by the Alternate Interrupt Vector Table (AIVT),
as shown in Figure 8-1. Access to the alternate vector
table is provided by the ALTIVT bit in the INTCON2 reg-
ister. If the ALTIVT bit is set, all interrupt and exception
processes use the alternate vectors instead of the
default vectors. The alternate vectors are organized in
the same manner as the default vectors. The AIVT sup-
ports emulation and debugging efforts by providing a
means to switch between an application and a support
environment without requiring the interrupt vectors to
be reprogrammed. This feature also enables switching
between applications for evaluation of different
software algorithms at run time.
If there is a pending IRQ with a priority level greater
than the current processor priority level in the IPL bits,
the processor is interrupted.
The processor then stacks the current program counter
and the low byte of the processor STATUS register
(SRL), as shown in Figure 8-2. The low byte of the
STATUS register contains the processor priority level at
the time prior to the beginning of the interrupt cycle.
The processor then loads the priority level for this inter-
rupt into the STATUS register. This action disables all
lower priority interrupts until the completion of the
Interrupt Service Routine.
If the AIVT is not required, the program memory allo-
cated to the AIVT may be used for other purposes.
AIVT is not a protected section and may be freely
programmed by the user.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 67
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
8.6
Fast Context Saving
8.7
External Interrupt Requests
A context saving option is available using shadow reg-
isters. Shadow registers are provided for the DC, N,
OV, Z and C bits in SR, and the registers W0 through
W3. The shadows are only one level deep. The shadow
registers are accessible using the PUSH.Sand POP.S
instructions only.
The interrupt controller supports three external inter-
rupt request signals, INT0-INT2. These inputs are edge
sensitive; they require a low-to-high or a high-to-low
transition to generate an interrupt request. The
INTCON2 register has three bits, INT0EP-INT2EP, that
select the polarity of the edge detection circuitry.
When the processor vectors to an interrupt, the
PUSH.S instruction can be used to store the current
value of the aforementioned registers into their
respective shadow registers.
8.8
Wake-up from Sleep and Idle
The interrupt controller may be used to wake-up the
processor from either Sleep or Idle modes, if Sleep or
Idle mode is active when the interrupt is generated.
If an ISR of a certain priority uses the PUSH.S and
POP.S instructions for fast context saving, then a
higher priority ISR should not include the same instruc-
tions. Users must save the key registers in software
during a lower priority interrupt if the higher priority ISR
uses fast context saving.
If an enabled interrupt request of sufficient priority is
received by the interrupt controller, then the standard
interrupt request is presented to the processor. At the
same time, the processor wakes up from Sleep or Idle
and begin execution of the Interrupt Service Routine
(ISR) needed to process the interrupt request.
DS70139E-page 68
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 8-2:
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012 INTERRUPT CONTROLLER REGISTER MAP
SFR
Name
ADR Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0100 0100 0100 0100
0100 0100 0100 0100
0100 0100 0100 0100
0100 0100 0100 0100
0000 0000 0000 0100
0100 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0100 0100
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0100 0000 0000
INTCON1 0080 NSTDIS
INTCON2 0082 ALTIVT
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
OVATE OVBTE COVTE
—
—
—
—
—
—
MATHERR ADDRERR STKERR OSCFAIL
—
DISI
—
—
—
—
IC2IF
—
—
T1IF
—
INT2EP INT1EP INT0EP
IFS0
IFS1
IFS2
IEC0
IEC1
IEC2
IPC0
IPC1
IPC2
IPC3
IPC4
IPC5
IPC6
IPC7
IPC8
IPC9
IPC10
0084 CNIF MI2CIF SI2CIF NVMIF
ADIF U1TXIF U1RXIF SPI1IF
T3IF
INT2IF
—
T2IF OC2IF
OC1IF
—
IC1IF
INT0IF
INT1IF
—
0086
0088
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LVDIF
—
—
—
—
008C CNIE MI2CIE SI2CIE NVMIE ADIE U1TXIE U1RXIE SPI1IE
T3IE
INT2IE
—
T2IE OC2IE
IC2IE
—
T1IE
—
OC1IE
—
IC1IE
INT0IE
INT1IE
—
008E
0090
0094
0096
0098
009A
009C
009E
00A0
00A2
00A4
00A6
00A8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LVDIE
—
—
—
—
—
—
T1IP<2:0>
OC1IP<2:0>
—
IC1IP<2:0>
—
INT0IP<2:0>
T31P<2:0>
T2IP<2:0>
—
OC2IP<2:0>
—
IC2IP<2:0>
ADIP<2:0>
U1TXIP<2:0>
—
U1RXIP<2:0>
—
SPI1IP<2:0>
CNIP<2:0>
MI2CIP<2:0>
—
SI2CIP<2:0>
—
NVMIP<2:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1
—
—
0
—
—
0
—
INT1IP<2:0>
INT2IP<2:0>
—
—
—
—
1
—
0
—
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LVDIP<2:0>
—
—
Legend: u= uninitialized bit
Note: Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TABLE 8-3:
dsPIC30F3013 INTERRUPT CONTROLLER REGISTER MAP
SFR
Name
ADR Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0100 0100 0100 0100
0100 0100 0100 0100
0100 0100 0100 0100
0100 0100 0100 0100
0000 0000 0000 0100
0100 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0100 0100
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0100 0000 0000
INTCON1 0080 NSTDIS
INTCON2 0082 ALTIVT
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
OVATE OVBTE COVTE
—
—
—
—
—
—
MATHERR ADDRERR STKERR OSCFAIL
—
DISI
—
—
—
—
IC2IF
—
—
T1IF
—
INT2EP INT1EP INT0EP
IFS0
IFS1
IFS2
IEC0
IEC1
IEC2
IPC0
IPC1
IPC2
IPC3
IPC4
IPC5
IPC6
IPC7
IPC8
IPC9
IPC10
0084 CNIF MI2CIF SI2CIF NVMIF
ADIF U1TXIF U1RXIF SPI1IF
T3IF
T2IF OC2IF
OC1IF
—
IC1IF
—
INT0IF
INT1IF
—
0086
0088
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
U2TXIF U2RXIF INT2IF
—
—
—
—
LVDIF
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
008C CNIE MI2CIE SI2CIE NVMIE ADIE U1TXIE U1RXIE SPI1IE
T3IE
T2IE OC2IE
IC2IE
—
T1IE
—
OC1IE
—
IC1IE
INT0IE
INT1IE
—
008E
0090
0094
0096
0098
009A
009C
009E
00A0
00A2
00A4
00A6
00A8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
U2TXIE U2RXIE INT2IE
—
—
—
—
—
LVDIE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
T1IP<2:0>
OC1IP<2:0>
IC1IP<2:0>
—
INT0IP<2:0>
IC2IP<2:0>
SPI1IP<2:0>
NVMIP<2:0>
INT1IP<2:0>
T31P<2:0>
T2IP<2:0>
OC2IP<2:0>
—
ADIP<2:0>
U1TXIP<2:0>
U1RXIP<2:0>
—
CNIP<2:0>
MI2CIP<2:0>
SI2CIP<2:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
INT2IP<2:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
U2TXIP<2:0>
—
U2RXIP<2:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LVDIP<2:0>
—
Legend: u= uninitialized bit
Note: Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bit(s) in the 16-bit SFR, T1CON. Figure 9-1
9.0
TIMER1 MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual “ (DS70046).
presents a block diagram of the 16-bit timer module.
16-bit Timer Mode: In the 16-bit Timer mode, the timer
increments on every instruction cycle up to a match
value preloaded into the Period register PR1, then
resets to ‘0’ and continues to count.
This section describes the 16-bit general purpose
Timer1 module and associated operational modes.
Figure 9-1 depicts the simplified block diagram of the
16-bit Timer1 module. The following sections provide
detailed descriptions including setup and Control regis-
ters, along with associated block diagrams for the oper-
ational modes of the timers.
When the CPU goes into the Idle mode, the timer stops
incrementing unless the TSIDL (T1CON<13>) bit = 0.
If TSIDL = 1, the timer module logic resumes the incre-
menting sequence on termination of CPU Idle mode.
16-bit Synchronous Counter Mode: In the 16-bit
Synchronous Counter mode, the timer increments on
the rising edge of the applied external clock signal
which is synchronized with the internal phase clocks.
The timer counts up to a match value preloaded in PR1,
then resets to ‘0’ and continues.
The Timer1 module is a 16-bit timer that serves as the
time counter for the real-time clock or operates as a
free-running interval timer/counter. The 16-bit timer has
the following modes:
When the CPU goes into the Idle mode, the timer stops
incrementing unless the respective TSIDL bit = 0. If
TSIDL = 1, the timer module logic resumes the incre-
menting sequence upon termination of the CPU Idle
mode.
• 16-bit Timer
• 16-bit Synchronous Counter
• 16-bit Asynchronous Counter
These operational characteristics are supported:
16-bit Asynchronous Counter Mode: In the 16-bit
Asynchronous Counter mode, the timer increments on
every rising edge of the applied external clock signal.
The timer counts up to a match value preloaded in PR1,
then resets to ‘0’ and continues.
• Timer gate operation
• Selectable prescaler settings
• Timer operation during CPU Idle and Sleep
modes
• Interrupt on 16-bit Period register match or falling
edge of external gate signal
When the timer is configured for the Asynchronous
mode of operation and the CPU goes into the Idle
mode, the timer stops incrementing if TSIDL = 1.
FIGURE 9-1:
16-BIT TIMER1 MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM
PR1
Comparator x 16
TMR1
Equal
Reset
TSYNC
1
0
Sync
0
1
T1IF
Event Flag
Q
Q
D
TGATE
CK
TGATE
TCKPS<1:0>
2
TON
SOSCO/
T1CK
1x
01
00
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
Gate
Sync
LPOSCEN
SOSCI
TCY
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 71
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
9.1
Timer Gate Operation
9.4
Timer Interrupt
The 16-bit timer can be placed in the Gated Time Accu-
mulation mode. This mode allows the internal TCY to
increment the respective timer when the gate input sig-
nal (T1CK pin) is asserted high. Control bit, TGATE
(T1CON<6>), must be set to enable this mode. The
timer must be enabled (TON = 1) and the timer clock
source set to internal (TCS = 0).
The 16-bit timer has the ability to generate an interrupt-
on-period match. When the timer count matches the
Period register, the T1IF bit is asserted and an interrupt
is generated, if enabled. The T1IF bit must be cleared in
software. The timer interrupt flag, T1IF, is located in the
IFS0 Control register in the interrupt controller.
When the Gated Time Accumulation mode is enabled,
an interrupt is also generated on the falling edge of the
gate signal (at the end of the accumulation cycle).
When the CPU goes into the Idle mode, the timer stops
incrementing unless TSIDL = 0. If TSIDL = 1, the timer
resumes the incrementing sequence upon termination
of the CPU Idle mode.
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the respec-
tive timer interrupt enable bit, T1IE. The timer interrupt
enable bit is located in the IEC0 Control register in the
interrupt controller.
9.2
Timer Prescaler
The input clock (FOSC/4 or external clock) to the 16-bit
Timer has a prescale option of 1:1, 1:8, 1:64 and 1:256,
selected by control bits, TCKPS<1:0> (T1CON<5:4>).
The prescaler counter is cleared when any of the
following occurs:
9.5
Real-Time Clock
Timer1, when operating in Real-Time Clock (RTC)
mode, provides time of day and event time-stamping
capabilities. Key operational features of the RTC are:
• a write to the TMR1 register
• Operation from 32 kHz LP oscillator
• 8-bit prescaler
• a write to the T1CON register
• device Reset, such as POR and BOR
• Low power
However, if the timer is disabled (TON = 0), then the
timer prescaler cannot be reset since the prescaler
clock is halted.
• Real-Time Clock interrupts
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bit(s) in the T1CON Control register.
TMR1 is not cleared when T1CON is written. It is
cleared by writing to the TMR1 register.
FIGURE 9-2:
RECOMMENDED
COMPONENTS FOR
TIMER1 LP OSCILLATOR
RTC
9.3
Timer Operation During Sleep
Mode
The timer operates during CPU Sleep mode if:
C1
• The timer module is enabled (TON = 1), and
SOSCI
• The timer clock source is selected as external
(TCS = 1), and
32.768 kHz
XTAL
dsPIC30FXXXX
• The TSYNC bit (T1CON<2>) is asserted to a logic
‘0’ which defines the external clock source as
asynchronous.
SOSCO
C2
R
When all three conditions are true, the timer continues
to count up to the Period register and be reset to
0x0000.
C1 = C2 = 18 pF; R = 100K
When a match between the timer and the Period regis-
ter occurs, an interrupt can be generated if the
respective timer interrupt enable bit is asserted.
DS70139E-page 72
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
9.5.1
RTC OSCILLATOR OPERATION
9.5.2
RTC INTERRUPTS
When the TON = 1, TCS = 1and TGATE = 0, the timer
increments on the rising edge of the 32 kHz LP oscilla-
tor output signal, up to the value specified in the Period
register and is then reset to ‘0’.
When an interrupt event occurs, the respective interrupt
flag, T1IF, is asserted and an interrupt is generated if
enabled. The T1IF bit must be cleared in software. The
respective Timer interrupt flag, T1IF, is located in the
IFS0 register in the interrupt controller.
The TSYNC bit must be asserted to a logic ‘0’
(Asynchronous mode) for correct operation.
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the respec-
tive timer interrupt enable bit, T1IE. The timer interrupt
enable bit is located in the IEC0 Control register in the
interrupt controller.
Enabling LPOSCEN (OSCCON<1>) disables the
normal Timer and Counter modes and enables a timer
carry-out wake-up event.
When the CPU enters Sleep mode, the RTC continues
to operate, provided the 32 kHz external crystal oscilla-
tor is active and the control bits have not been
changed. The TSIDL bit should be cleared to ‘0’ in
order for RTC to continue operation in Idle mode.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 73
TABLE 9-1:
TIMER1 REGISTER MAP
SFR Name Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14 Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10 Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TMR1
PR1
0100
0102
0104
Timer1 Register
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
1111 1111 1111 1111
0000 0000 0000 0000
Period Register 1
TGATE TCKPS1 TCKPS0
T1CON
TON
—
TSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TSYNC
TCS
—
Legend: u= uninitialized bit
Note: Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
16-bit Timer Mode: In the 16-bit mode, Timer2 and
Timer3 can be configured as two independent 16-bit
10.0 TIMER2/3 MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual “(DS70046).
timers. Each timer can be set up in either 16-bit Timer
mode or 16-bit Synchronous Counter mode. See
Section 9.0 “Timer1 Module” for details on these two
operating modes.
The only functional difference between Timer2 and
Timer3 is that Timer2 provides synchronization of the
clock prescaler output. This is useful for high frequency
external clock inputs.
This section describes the 32-bit general purpose
Timer module (Timer2/3) and associated Operational
modes. Figure 10-1 depicts the simplified block dia-
gram of the 32-bit Timer2/3 module. Figure 10-2 and
Figure 10-3 show Timer2/3 configured as two
independent 16-bit timers, Timer2 and Timer3,
respectively.
32-bit Timer Mode: In the 32-bit Timer mode, the timer
increments on every instruction cycle, up to a match
value preloaded into the combined 32-bit Period
register PR3/PR2, then resets to ‘0’ and continues to
count.
The Timer2/3 module is a 32-bit timer (which can be
configured as two 16-bit timers) with selectable
operating modes. These timers are utilized by other
peripheral modules, such as:
For synchronous 32-bit reads of the Timer2/Timer3
pair, reading the ls word (TMR2 register) causes the ms
word to be read and latched into a 16-bit holding regis-
ter, termed TMR3HLD.
• Input Capture
• Output Compare/Simple PWM
For synchronous 32-bit writes, the holding register
(TMR3HLD) must first be written to. When followed by
a write to the TMR2 register, the contents of TMR3HLD
is transferred and latched into the MSB of the 32-bit
timer (TMR3).
The following sections provide a detailed description,
including setup and Control registers, along with asso-
ciated block diagrams for the operational modes of the
timers.
32-bit Synchronous Counter Mode: In the 32-bit
Synchronous Counter mode, the timer increments on
the rising edge of the applied external clock signal
which is synchronized with the internal phase clocks.
The timer counts up to a match value preloaded in the
combined 32-bit period register, PR3/PR2, then resets
to ‘0’ and continues.
The 32-bit timer has the following modes:
• Two independent 16-bit timers (Timer2 and
Timer3) with all 16-bit operating modes (except
Asynchronous Counter mode)
• Single 32-bit timer operation
• Single 32-bit synchronous counter
When the timer is configured for the Synchronous
Counter mode of operation and the CPU goes into the
Idle mode, the timer stops incrementing unless the
TSIDL (T2CON<13>) bit = 0. If TSIDL = 1, the timer
module logic resumes the incrementing sequence
upon termination of the CPU Idle mode.
Further, the following operational characteristics are
supported:
• ADC event trigger
• Timer gate operation
• Selectable prescaler settings
• Timer operation during Idle and Sleep modes
• Interrupt on a 32-bit period register match
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bit(s) in the 16-bit T2CON and T3CON
SFRs.
For 32-bit timer/counter operation, Timer2 is the ls word
and Timer3 is the ms word of the 32-bit timer.
Note:
For 32-bit timer operation, T3CON control
bits are ignored. Only T2CON control bits
are used for setup and control. Timer2
clock and gate inputs are utilized for the
32-bit timer module, but an interrupt is
generated with the Timer3 interrupt flag
(T3IF) and the interrupt is enabled with the
Timer3 interrupt enable bit (T3IE).
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 75
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 10-1:
32-BIT TIMER2/3 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus<15:0>
TMR3HLD
16
16
Write TMR2
Read TMR2
16
Reset
Sync
TMR3
MSB
TMR2
LSB
ADC Event Trigger
Comparator x 32
Equal
PR3
PR2
0
1
T3IF
Event Flag
Q
Q
D
TGATE (T2CON<6>)
CK
TGATE
(T2CON<6>)
TCKPS<1:0>
2
TON
T2CK
1x
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
Gate
Sync
01
00
TCY
Note:
Timer Configuration bit T32 (T2CON<3>) must be set to ‘1’ for a 32-bit timer/counter operation. All control
bits are respective to the T2CON register.
DS70139E-page 76
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 10-2:
16-BIT TIMER2 BLOCK DIAGRAM
PR2
Comparator x 16
TMR2
Equal
Reset
Sync
0
1
T2IF
Event Flag
TGATE
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE
TCKPS<1:0>
2
TON
T2CK
1x
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
Gate
Sync
01
00
TCY
FIGURE 10-3:
16-BIT TIMER3 BLOCK DIAGRAM
PR3
ADC Event Trigger
Equal
Comparator x 16
TMR3
Reset
0
1
T3IF
Event Flag
TGATE
Q
Q
D
CK
TGATE
TCKPS<1:0>
2
TON
T3CK
Sync
TCY
1x
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
01
00
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 77
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
10.1 Timer Gate Operation
10.4 Timer Operation During Sleep
Mode
The 32-bit timer can be placed in the Gated Time Accu-
mulation mode. This mode allows the internal TCY to
increment the respective timer when the gate input sig-
nal (T2CK pin) is asserted high. Control bit, TGATE
(T2CON<6>), must be set to enable this mode. When
in this mode, Timer2 is the originating clock source.
The TGATE setting is ignored for Timer3. The timer
must be enabled (TON = 1) and the timer clock source
set to internal (TCS = 0).
The timer does not operate during CPU Sleep mode
because the internal clocks are disabled.
10.5 Timer Interrupt
The 32-bit timer module can generate an interrupt-on-
period match or on the falling edge of the external gate
signal. When the 32-bit timer count matches the
respective 32-bit period register, or the falling edge of
the external “gate” signal is detected, the T3IF bit
(IFS0<7>) is asserted and an interrupt is generated if
enabled. In this mode, the T3IF interrupt flag is used as
the source of the interrupt. The T3IF bit must be
cleared in software.
The falling edge of the external signal terminates the
count operation but does not reset the timer. The user
must reset the timer in order to start counting from zero.
10.2 ADC Event Trigger
When a match occurs between the 32-bit timer (TMR3/
TMR2) and the 32-bit combined period register (PR3/
PR2), or between the 16-bit timer TMR3 and the 16-bit
period register PR3, a special ADC trigger event signal
is generated by Timer3.
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the
respective timer interrupt enable bit, T3IE (IEC0<7>).
10.3 Timer Prescaler
The input clock (FOSC/4 or external clock) to the timer
has a prescale option of 1:1, 1:8, 1:64, and 1:256,
selected by control bits, TCKPS<1:0> (T2CON<5:4>
and T3CON<5:4>). For the 32-bit timer operation, the
originating clock source is Timer2. The prescaler oper-
ation for Timer3 is not applicable in this mode. The
prescaler counter is cleared when any of the following
occurs:
• a write to the TMR2/TMR3 register
• a write to the T2CON/T3CON register
• device Reset, such as POR and BOR
However, if the timer is disabled (TON = 0), then the
Timer 2 prescaler cannot be reset since the prescaler
clock is halted.
TMR2/TMR3 is not cleared when T2CON/T3CON is
written.
DS70139E-page 78
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 10-1: TIMER2/3 REGISTER MAP
SFR Name Addr.
TMR2 0106
TMR3HLD 0108
Bit 15
Bit 14 Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10 Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
Timer2 Register
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
1111 1111 1111 1111
1111 1111 1111 1111
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
Timer3 Holding Register (for 32-bit timer operations only)
Timer3 Register
TMR3
PR2
010A
010C
010E
0110
0112
Period Register 2
PR3
Period Register 3
T2CON
T3CON
TON
TON
—
—
TSIDL
TSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TGATE TCKPS1 TCKPS0
TGATE TCKPS1 TCKPS0
T32
—
—
—
TCS
TCS
—
—
Legend: u= uninitialized bit
Note: Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 80
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
These operating modes are determined by setting the
11.0 INPUT CAPTURE MODULE
appropriate bits in the IC1CON and IC2CON registers.
The dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013 devices have two
capture channels.
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
11.1 Simple Capture Event Mode
The simple capture events in the dsPIC30F product
family are:
This section describes the input capture module and
associated operational modes. The features provided
by this module are useful in applications requiring fre-
quency (period) and pulse measurement.
• Capture every falling edge
• Capture every rising edge
• Capture every 4th rising edge
• Capture every 16th rising edge
• Capture every rising and falling edge
Figure 11-1 depicts a block diagram of the input cap-
ture module. Input capture is useful for such modes as:
• Frequency/Period/Pulse Measurements
• Additional Sources of External Interrupts
These simple Input Capture modes are configured by
setting the appropriate bits, ICM<2:0> (ICxCON<2:0>).
Important operational features of the input capture
module are:
11.1.1
CAPTURE PRESCALER
• Simple Capture Event mode
There are four input capture prescaler settings speci-
fied by bits ICM<2:0> (ICxCON<2:0>). Whenever the
capture channel is turned off, the prescaler counter is
cleared. In addition, any Reset clears the prescaler
counter.
• Timer2 and Timer3 mode selection
• Interrupt on input capture event
FIGURE 11-1:
INPUT CAPTURE MODE BLOCK DIAGRAM
T3_CNT
16
From GP Timer Module
T2_CNT
16
ICTMR
1
0
ICx pin
Edge
Detection
Logic
FIFO
R/W
Logic
Prescaler
1, 4, 16
Clock
Synchronizer
ICM<2:0>
Mode Select
3
ICxBUF
ICBNE, ICOV
ICI<1:0>
Interrupt
Logic
ICxCON
Data Bus
Set Flag
ICxIF
Note:
Where ‘x’ is shown, reference is made to the registers or bits associated to the respective input capture
channel (1 or 2).
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 81
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
11.1.2
CAPTURE BUFFER OPERATION
11.2 Input Capture Operation During
Sleep and Idle Modes
Each capture channel has an associated FIFO buffer
which is four 16-bit words deep. There are two status
flags which provide status on the FIFO buffer:
An input capture event generates a device wake-up or
interrupt, if enabled, if the device is in CPU Idle or Sleep
mode.
• ICBNE — Input Capture Buffer Not Empty
• ICOV — Input Capture Overflow
Independent of the timer being enabled, the input cap-
ture module wakes up from the CPU Sleep or Idle mode
when a capture event occurs if ICM<2:0> = 111and the
interrupt enable bit is asserted. The same wake-up can
generate an interrupt if the conditions for processing the
interrupt have been satisfied. The wake-up feature is
useful as a method of adding extra external pin inter-
rupts.
The ICBNE is set on the first input capture event and
remains set until all capture events have been read
from the FIFO. As each word is read from the FIFO, the
remaining words are advanced by one position within
the buffer.
In the event that the FIFO is full with four capture
events, and a fifth capture event occurs prior to a read
of the FIFO, an overflow condition occurs and the ICOV
bit is set to a logic ‘1’. The fifth capture event is lost and
is not stored in the FIFO. No additional events are cap-
tured until all four events have been read from the
buffer.
11.2.1
INPUT CAPTURE IN CPU SLEEP
MODE
CPU Sleep mode allows input capture module opera-
tion with reduced functionality. In the CPU Sleep mode,
the ICI<1:0> bits are not applicable and the input cap-
ture module can only function as an external interrupt
source.
If a FIFO read is performed after the last read and no
new capture event has been received, the read will
yield indeterminate results.
The capture module must be configured for interrupt
only on rising edge (ICM<2:0> = 111) in order for the
input capture module to be used while the device is in
Sleep mode. The prescale settings of 4:1 or 16:1 are
not applicable in this mode.
11.1.3
TIMER2 AND TIMER3 SELECTION
MODE
The input capture module consists of up to 8 input cap-
ture channels. Each channel can select between one of
two timers for the time base, Timer2 or Timer3.
11.2.2
INPUT CAPTURE IN CPU IDLE
MODE
Selection of the timer resource is accomplished
through SFR bit, ICTMR (ICxCON<7>). Timer3 is the
default timer resource available for the input capture
module.
CPU Idle mode allows input capture module operation
with full functionality. In the CPU Idle mode, the Inter-
rupt mode selected by the ICI<1:0> bits is applicable,
as well as the 4:1 and 16:1 capture prescale settings
which are defined by control bits ICM<2:0>. This mode
requires the selected timer to be enabled. Moreover,
the ICSIDL bit must be asserted to a logic ‘0’.
11.1.4
HALL SENSOR MODE
When the input capture module is set for capture on
every edge, rising and falling, ICM<2:0> = 001, the fol-
lowing operations are performed by the input capture
logic:
If the input capture module is defined as
ICM<2:0> = 111 in CPU Idle mode, the input capture
pin serves only as an external interrupt pin.
• The input capture interrupt flag is set on every
edge, rising and falling.
• The interrupt on Capture mode setting bits,
ICI<1:0>, is ignored since every capture
generates an interrupt.
11.3 Input Capture Interrupts
The input capture channels have the ability to generate
an interrupt based upon the selected number of cap-
ture events. The selection number is set by control bits,
ICI<1:0> (ICxCON<6:5>).
• A capture overflow condition is not generated in
this mode.
Each channel provides an interrupt flag (ICxIF) bit. The
respective capture channel interrupt flag is located in
the corresponding IFSx register.
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the respec-
tive capture channel interrupt enable (ICxIE) bit. The
capture interrupt enable bit is located in the
corresponding IEC Control register.
DS70139E-page 82
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 11-1: INPUT CAPTURE REGISTER MAP
SFR Name Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Input 1 Capture Register
ICTMR
Input 2 Capture Register
ICTMR
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
IC1BUF
IC1CON
IC2BUF
IC2CON
0140
0142
0144
0146
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
—
—
—
ICSIDL
ICSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ICI<1:0>
ICOV
ICOV
ICBNE
ICBNE
ICM<2:0>
ICM<2:0>
—
ICI<1:0>
Legend: u= uninitialized bit
Note: Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 84
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
The key operational features of the output compare
module include:
12.0 OUTPUT COMPARE MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
• Timer2 and Timer3 Selection mode
• Simple Output Compare Match mode
• Dual Output Compare Match mode
• Simple PWM mode
• Output Compare During Sleep and Idle modes
• Interrupt on Output Compare/PWM Event
This section describes the output compare module and
associated operational modes. The features provided
by this module are useful in applications requiring oper-
ational modes, such as:
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bits in the 16-bit OC1CON and OC2CON
registers. The dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013 devices
have 2 compare channels.
• Generation of Variable Width Output Pulses
• Power Factor Correction
OCxRS and OCxR in Figure 12-1 represent the Dual
Compare registers. In the Dual Compare mode, the
OCxR register is used for the first compare and OCxRS
is used for the second compare.
Figure 12-1 depicts a block diagram of the output
compare module.
FIGURE 12-1:
OUTPUT COMPARE MODE BLOCK DIAGRAM
Set Flag bit
OCxIF
OCxRS
OCxR
Output
Logic
S
R
Q
OCx
Output
Enable
3
OCM<2:0>
Mode Select
Comparator
OCFA
(for x = 1, 2, 3 or 4)
OCTSEL
0
1
0
1
From GP
Timer Module
TMR2<15:0
TMR3<15:0> T2P2_MATCH
T3P3_MATCH
Note:
Where ‘x’ is shown, reference is made to the registers associated with the respective output compare
channel (1 or 2).
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 85
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
12.3.2
CONTINUOUS PULSE MODE
12.1 Timer2 and Timer3 Selection Mode
For the user to configure the module for the generation
of a continuous stream of output pulses, the following
steps are required:
Each output compare channel can select between one
of two 16-bit timers, Timer2 or Timer3.
The selection of the timers is controlled by the OCTSEL
bit (OCxCON<3>). Timer2 is the default timer resource
for the output compare module.
• Determine instruction cycle time TCY.
• Calculate desired pulse value based on TCY.
• Calculate timer to start pulse width from timer start
value of 0x0000.
12.2 Simple Output Compare Match
Mode
• Write pulse width start and stop times into OCxR
and OCxRS (x denotes channel 1, 2, ...,N)
Compare registers, respectively.
When control bits OCM<2:0> (OCxCON<2:0>) = 001,
010 or 011, the selected output compare channel is
configured for one of three simple Output Compare
Match modes:
• Set Timer Period register to value equal to or
greater than value in OCxRS Compare register.
• Set OCM<2:0> = 101.
• Compare forces I/O pin low
• Compare forces I/O pin high
• Compare toggles I/O pin
• Enable timer, TON (TxCON<15>) = 1.
12.4 Simple PWM Mode
The OCxR register is used in these modes. The OCxR
register is loaded with a value and is compared to the
selected incrementing timer count. When a compare
occurs, one of these Compare Match modes occurs. If
the counter resets to zero before reaching the value in
OCxR, the state of the OCx pin remains unchanged.
When control bits OCM<2:0> (OCxCON<2:0>) = 110
or 111, the selected output compare channel is config-
ured for the PWM mode of operation. When configured
for the PWM mode of operation, OCxR is the main latch
(read-only) and OCxRS is the secondary latch. This
enables glitchless PWM transitions.
The user must perform the following steps in order to
configure the output compare module for PWM
operation:
12.3 Dual Output Compare Match Mode
When control bits OCM<2:0> (OCxCON<2:0>) = 100
or 101, the selected output compare channel is config-
ured for one of two Dual Output Compare modes,
which are:
1. Set the PWM period by writing to the appropriate
period register.
2. Set the PWM duty cycle by writing to the OCxRS
register.
• Single Output Pulse mode
• Continuous Output Pulse mode
3. Configure the output compare module for PWM
operation.
12.3.1
SINGLE PULSE MODE
4. Set the TMRx prescale value and enable the
For the user to configure the module for the generation
of a single output pulse, the following steps are
required (assuming timer is off):
Timer, TON (TxCON<15>) = 1.
12.4.1
INPUT PIN FAULT PROTECTION
FOR PWM
• Determine instruction cycle time TCY.
• Calculate desired pulse width value based on TCY.
When control bits OCM<2:0> (OCxCON<2:0>) = 111,
the selected output compare channel is again config-
ured for the PWM mode of operation with the additional
feature of input Fault protection. While in this mode, if
a logic ‘0’ is detected on the OCFA/B pin, the respective
PWM output pin is placed in the high impedance input
state. The OCFLT bit (OCxCON<4>) indicates whether
a Fault condition has occurred. This state is maintained
until both of the following events have occurred:
• Calculate time to start pulse from timer start value
of 0x0000.
• Write pulse width start and stop times into OCxR
and OCxRS Compare registers (x denotes
channel 1, 2, ...,N).
• Set Timer Period register to value equal to or
greater than value in OCxRS Compare register.
• Set OCM<2:0> = 100.
• The external Fault condition has been removed.
• Enable timer, TON (TxCON<15>) = 1.
• The PWM mode has been re-enabled by writing
to the appropriate control bits.
To initiate another single pulse, issue another write to
set OCM<2:0> = 100.
DS70139E-page 86
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
When the selected TMRx is equal to its respective
period register, PRx, the following four events occur on
the next increment cycle:
12.4.2
PWM PERIOD
The PWM period is specified by writing to the PRx
register. The PWM period can be calculated using
Equation 12-1.
• TMRx is cleared.
• The OCx pin is set.
EQUATION 12-1:
- Exception 1: If PWM duty cycle is 0x0000,
the OCx pin remains low.
PWM period = [(PRx) + 1] • 4 • TOSC •
(TMRx prescale value)
- Exception 2: If duty cycle is greater than PRx,
the pin remains high.
• The PWM duty cycle is latched from OCxRS into
OCxR.
PWM frequency is defined as 1/[PWM period].
• The corresponding timer interrupt flag is set.
See Figure 12-2 for key PWM period comparisons.
Timer3 is referred to in Figure 12-2 for clarity.
FIGURE 12-2:
PWM OUTPUT TIMING
Period
Duty Cycle
TMR3 = PR3
T3IF = 1
(Interrupt Flag)
TMR3 = PR3
T3IF = 1
(Interrupt Flag)
OCxR = OCxRS
OCxR = OCxRS
TMR3 = Duty Cycle
(OCxR)
TMR3 = Duty Cycle
(OCxR)
12.5 Output Compare Operation During
CPU Sleep Mode
12.7 Output Compare Interrupts
The output compare channels have the ability to gener-
ate an interrupt on a compare match, for whichever
Match mode has been selected.
When the CPU enters Sleep mode, all internal clocks
are stopped. Therefore, when the CPU enters the
Sleep state, the output compare channel drives the pin
to the active state that was observed prior to entering
the CPU Sleep state.
For all modes except the PWM mode, when a compare
event occurs, the respective interrupt flag (OCxIF) is
asserted and an interrupt is generated if enabled. The
OCxIF bit is located in the corresponding IFS register
and must be cleared in software. The interrupt is
enabled via the respective compare interrupt enable
(OCxIE) bit located in the corresponding IEC Control
register.
For example, if the pin was high when the CPU entered
the Sleep state, the pin remains high. Likewise, if the
pin was low when the CPU entered the Sleep state, the
pin remains low. In either case, the output compare
module resumes operation when the device wakes up.
For the PWM mode, when an event occurs, the respec-
tive timer interrupt flag (T2IF or T3IF) is asserted and
an interrupt is generated if enabled. The IF bit is
located in the IFS0 register and must be cleared in soft-
ware. The interrupt is enabled via the respective timer
interrupt enable bit (T2IE or T3IE) located in the IEC0
Control register. The output compare interrupt flag is
never set during the PWM mode of operation.
12.6 Output Compare Operation During
CPU Idle Mode
When the CPU enters the Idle mode, the output
compare module can operate with full functionality.
The output compare channel operates during the CPU
Idle mode if the OCSIDL bit (OCxCON<13>) is at logic
‘0’ and the selected time base (Timer2 or Timer3) is
enabled and the TSIDL bit of the selected timer is set
to logic ‘0’.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 87
TABLE 12-1: OUTPUT COMPARE REGISTER MAP
SFR Name Addr. Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
OC1RS
OC1R
0180
0182
0184
0186
0188
018A
Output Compare 1 Secondary Register
Output Compare 1 Main Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
OC1CON
OC2RS
OC2R
—
—
—
—
OCSIDL
OCSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
OCFLT
OCFLT
OCTSEL
OCTSEL
OCM<2:0>
OCM<2:0>
Output Compare 2 Secondary Register
Output Compare 2 Main Register
OC2CON
Legend:
Note:
—
—
—
—
u= uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual “ (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
• SS1 (active-low slave select).
13.0 SPI MODULE
In Master mode operation, SCK1 is a clock output. In
Slave mode, it is a clock input.
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual “ (DS70046).
A series of eight (8) or sixteen (16) clock pulses shift
out bits from the SPI1SR to SDO1 pin and simulta-
neously shift in data from SDI1 pin. An interrupt is
generated when the transfer is complete and the
interrupt flag bit (SPI1IF) is set. This interrupt can be
disabled through the interrupt enable bit, SPI1IE.
The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) module is a syn-
chronous serial interface. It is useful for communicating
with other peripheral devices, such as EEPROMs, shift
registers, display drivers and A/D converters, or other
microcontrollers. It is compatible with Motorola's SPI
and SIOP interfaces. The dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/
3013 devices feature one SPI module, SPI1.
The receive operation is double-buffered. When a com-
plete byte is received, it is transferred from SPI1SR to
SPI1BUF.
If the receive buffer is full when new data is being trans-
ferred from SPI1SR to SPI1BUF, the module will set the
SPIROV bit indicating an overflow condition. The trans-
fer of the data from SPI1SR to SPI1BUF is not com-
pleted and the new data is lost. The module will not
respond to SCL transitions while SPIROV is ‘1’, effec-
tively disabling the module until SPI1BUF is read by
user software.
13.1 Operating Function Description
Figure 13-1 is a simplified block diagram of the SPI
module, which consists of a 16-bit shift register,
SPI1SR , used for shifting data in and out, and a buffer
register, SPI1BUF. Control register SPI1CON (not
shown) configures the module. Additionally, status reg-
ister SPI1STAT (not shown) indicates various status
conditions.
Transmit writes are also double-buffered. The user
writes to SPI1BUF. When the master or slave transfer
is completed, the contents of the shift register
(SPI1SR) are moved to the receive buffer. If any trans-
mit data has been written to the buffer register, the con-
tents of the transmit buffer are moved to SPI1SR. The
received data is thus placed in SPI1BUF and the trans-
mit data in SPI1SR is ready for the next transfer.
Note:
See “dsPIC30F Family Reference Man-
ual” (DS70046) for detailed information on
the control and status registers.
Four I/O pins comprise the serial interface:
• SDI1 (serial data input)
Note:
Both the transmit buffer (SPI1TXB) and
the receive buffer (SPI1RXB) are mapped
to the same register address, SPI1BUF.
• SDO1 (serial data output)
• SCK1 (shift clock input or output)
FIGURE 13-1:
SPI BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal
Data Bus
Read
Write
SPIxBUF
Transmit
SPIxBUF
Receive
SPI1SR
bit 0
SDI1
SDO1
Shift
Clock
Clock
Control
Edge
Select
SS & FSYNC
Control
SS1
Secondary
Prescaler
1:1 – 1:8
Primary
Prescaler
1, 4, 16, 64
FCY
SCK1
Enable Master Clock
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 89
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Figure 13-2 depicts the a master/slave connection
between two processors. In Master mode, the clock is
generated by prescaling the system clock. Data is
transmitted as soon as a value is written to SPI1BUF.
The interrupt is generated at the middle of the transfer
of the last bit.
The user software must disable the module prior to
changing the MODE16 bit. The SPI module is reset
when the MODE16 bit is changed by the user.
A basic difference between 8-bit and 16-bit operation is
that the data is transmitted out of bit 7 of the SPI1SR
for 8-bit operation, and data is transmitted out of bit 15
of the SPI1SR for 16-bit operation. In both modes, data
is shifted into bit 0 of the SPI1SR.
In Slave mode, data is transmitted and received as
external clock pulses appear on SCK. Again, the inter-
rupt is generated when the last bit is latched. If SS1
control is enabled, then transmission and reception are
enabled only when SS1 = low. The SDO1 output will be
disabled in SS1 mode with SS1 high.
13.1.2
SDO1 DISABLE
A control bit, DISSDO, is provided to the SPI1CON reg-
ister to allow the SDO1 output to be disabled. This will
allow the SPI module to be connected in an input only
configuration. SDO1 can also be used for general
purpose I/O.
The clock provided to the module is (FOSC/4). This
clock is then prescaled by the primary (PPRE<1:0>)
and the secondary (SPRE<2:0>) prescale factors. The
CKE bit determines whether transmit occurs on transi-
tion from active clock state to Idle clock state, or vice
versa. The CKP bit selects the Idle state (high or low)
for the clock.
13.2 Framed SPI Support
The module supports a basic framed SPI protocol in
Master or Slave mode. The control bit, FRMEN,
enables framed SPI support and causes the SS1 pin to
perform the Frame Synchronization Pulse (FSYNC)
function. The control bit, SPIFSD, determines whether
the SS1 pin is an input or an output (i.e., whether the
module receives or generates the Frame Synchroniza-
tion Pulse). The frame pulse is an active-high pulse for
a single SPI clock cycle. When Frame Synchronization
is enabled, the data transmission starts only on the
subsequent transmit edge of the SPI clock.
13.1.1
WORD AND BYTE
COMMUNICATION
A control bit, MODE16 (SPI1CON<10>), allows the
module to communicate in either 16-bit or 8-bit mode.
16-bit operation is identical to 8-bit operation except
that the number of bits transmitted is 16 instead of 8.
FIGURE 13-2:
SPI MASTER/SLAVE CONNECTION
SPI Master
SPI Slave
SDO1
SDI1
Serial Input Buffer
(SPI1BUF)
Serial Input Buffer
(SPI1BUF)
SDI1
SDO1
Shift Register
Shift Register
(SPI1SR)
(SPI1SR)
LSb
MSb
MSb
LSb
Serial Clock
SCK1
SCK1
PROCESSOR 1
PROCESSOR 2
DS70139E-page 90
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
13.3 Slave Select Synchronization
13.5 SPI Operation During CPU Idle
Mode
The SS1 pin allows a Synchronous Slave mode. The
SPI must be configured in SPI Slave mode with SS1
pin control enabled (SSEN = 1). When the SS1 pin is
low, transmission and reception are enabled and the
SDOx pin is driven. When SS1 pin goes high, the
SDOx pin is no longer driven. Also, the SPI module is
resynchronized, and all counters/control circuitry are
reset. Therefore, when the SS1 pin is asserted low
again, transmission/reception will begin at the MSb
even if SS1 had been de-asserted in the middle of a
transmit/receive.
When the device enters Idle mode, all clock sources
remain functional. The SPISIDL bit (SPI1STAT<13>)
selects if the SPI module will stop or continue on idle. If
SPISIDL = 0, the module will continue to operate when
the CPU enters Idle mode. If SPISIDL = 1, the module
will stop when the CPU enters Idle mode.
13.4 SPI Operation During CPU Sleep
Mode
During Sleep mode, the SPI module is shut down. If the
CPU enters Sleep mode while an SPI transaction is in
progress, then the transmission and reception is
aborted.
The transmitter and receiver will stop in Sleep mode.
However, register contents are not affected by entering
or exiting Sleep mode.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 91
TABLE 13-1: SPI1 REGISTER MAP
SFR
Name
Addr. Bit 15 Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12 Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
SPI1STAT 0220 SPIEN
—
SPISIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SPIROV
CKP
—
—
—
—
SPITBF SPIRBF 0000 0000 0000 0000
SPI1CON
SPI1BUF
Note:
0222
0224
—
FRMEN SPIFSD
DISSDO MODE16 SMP
CKE
SSEN
MSTEN SPRE2 SPRE1 SPRE0 PPRE1 PPRE0 0000 0000 0000 0000
Transmit and Receive Buffer
0000 0000 0000 0000
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
2
14.1.1
VARIOUS I2C MODES
14.0 I C™ MODULE
The following types of I2C operation are supported:
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
• I2C slave operation with 7-bit address
• I2C slave operation with 10-bit address
• I2C master operation with 7 or 10-bit address
See the I2C programmer’s model (Figure 14-1).
The Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2CTM) module provides
complete hardware support for both Slave and Multi-
Master modes of the I2C serial communication
standard, with a 16-bit interface.
14.1.2
PIN CONFIGURATION IN I2C MODE
I2C has a 2-pin interface: the SCL pin is clock and the
SDA pin is data.
This module offers the following key features:
• I2C interface supporting both master and slave
operation.
• I2C Slave mode supports 7 and 10-bit address.
• I2C Master mode supports 7 and 10-bit address.
• I2C port allows bidirectional transfers between
master and slaves.
• Serial clock synchronization for I2C port can be
used as a handshake mechanism to suspend and
resume serial transfer (SCLREL control).
• I2C supports multi-master operation; detects bus
collision and will arbitrate accordingly.
14.1.3
I2C REGISTERS
I2CCON and I2CSTAT are control and status registers,
respectively. The I2CCON register is readable and writ-
able. The lower 6 bits of I2CSTAT are read-only. The
remaining bits of the I2CSTAT are read/write.
I2CRSR is the shift register used for shifting data,
whereas I2CRCV is the buffer register to which data
bytes are written, or from which data bytes are read.
I2CRCV is the receive buffer as shown in Figure 14-1.
I2CTRN is the transmit register to which bytes are
written during a transmit operation, as shown in
Figure 14-2.
The I2CADD register holds the slave address. A Status
bit, ADD10, indicates 10-bit Address mode. The
I2CBRG acts as the Baud Rate Generator reload
value.
14.1 Operating Function Description
The hardware fully implements all the master and slave
functions of the I2C Standard and Fast mode
specifications, as well as 7 and 10-bit addressing.
In receive operations, I2CRSR and I2CRCV together
Thus, the I2C module can operate either as a slave or
a master on an I2C bus.
form
a double-buffered receiver. When I2CRSR
receives a complete byte, it is transferred to I2CRCV
and an interrupt pulse is generated. During
transmission, the I2CTRN is not double-buffered.
Note:
Following a Restart condition in 10-bit
mode, the user only needs to match the
first 7-bit address.
FIGURE 14-1:
PROGRAMMER’S MODEL
I2CRCV (8 bits)
Bit 0
Bit 7
I2CTRN (8 bits)
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 8
I2CBRG (9 bits)
Bit 0
I2CCON (16 bits)
Bit 0
Bit 15
Bit 15
I2CSTAT (16 bits)
Bit 0
I2CADD (10 bits)
Bit 0
Bit 9
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 93
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 14-2:
I2C™ BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal
Data Bus
I2CRCV
Read
Shift
Clock
SCL
SDA
I2CRSR
LSB
Addr_Match
Match Detect
I2CADD
Write
Read
Start and
Stop bit Detect
Write
Read
Start, Restart,
Stop bit Generate
Collision
Detect
Write
Read
Acknowledge
Generation
Clock
Stretching
Write
Read
I2CTRN
LSB
Shift
Clock
Reload
Control
Write
Read
I2CBRG
BRG Down
Counter
FCY
DS70139E-page 94
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
2
14.3.2
SLAVE RECEPTION
14.2 I C Module Addresses
If the R_W bit received is a ‘0’ during an address
match, then Receive mode is initiated. Incoming bits
are sampled on the rising edge of SCL. After 8 bits are
received, if I2CRCV is not full or I2COV is not set,
I2CRSR is transferred to I2CRCV. ACK is sent on the
ninth clock.
The I2CADD register contains the Slave mode
addresses. The register is a 10-bit register.
If the A10M bit (I2CCON<10>) is ‘0’, the address is
interpreted by the module as a 7-bit address. When an
address is received, it is compared to the 7 LSb of the
I2CADD register.
If the RBF flag is set, indicating that I2CRCV is still
holding data from a previous operation (RBF = 1), then
ACK is not sent; however, the interrupt pulse is gener-
ated. In the case of an overflow, the contents of the
I2CRSR are not loaded into the I2CRCV.
If the A10M bit is ‘1’, the address is assumed to be a
10-bit address. When an address is received, it will be
compared with the binary value ‘11110 A9 A8’ (where
A9and A8are two Most Significant bits of I2CADD). If
that value matches, the next address will be compared
with the Least Significant 8 bits of I2CADD, as specified
in the 10-bit addressing protocol.
Note:
The I2CRCV will be loaded if the I2COV
bit = 1and the RBF flag = 0. In this case,
a read of the I2CRCV was performed but
the user did not clear the state of the
I2COV bit before the next receive
occurred. The acknowledgement is not
sent (ACK = 1) and the I2CRCV is
updated.
The 7-bit I2C Slave Addresses supported by the
dsPIC30F are shown in Table 14-1.
TABLE 14-1: 7-BIT I2C™ SLAVE
ADDRESSES
0x00
General call address or start byte
Reserved
0x01-0x03
0x04-0x07
0x04-0x77
0x78-0x7b
2
14.4 I C 10-bit Slave Mode Operation
Hs-mode Master codes
Valid 7-bit addresses
In 10-bit mode, the basic receive and transmit opera-
tions are the same as in the 7-bit mode. However, the
criteria for address match is more complex.
The I2C specification dictates that a slave must be
addressed for a write operation with two address bytes
following a Start bit.
Valid 10-bit addresses (lower 7
bits)
0x7c-0x7f
Reserved
2
14.3 I C 7-bit Slave Mode Operation
The A10M bit is a control bit that signifies that the
address in I2CADD is a 10-bit address rather than a 7-bit
address. The address detection protocol for the first byte
of a message address is identical for 7-bit and 10-bit
messages, but the bits being compared are different.
Once enabled (I2CEN = 1), the slave module will wait
for a Start bit to occur (i.e., the I2C module is ‘Idle’). Fol-
lowing the detection of a Start bit, 8 bits are shifted into
I2CRSR and the address is compared against
I2CADD. In 7-bit mode (A10M = 0), bits I2CADD<6:0>
are compared against I2CRSR<7:1> and I2CRSR<0>
is the R_W bit. All incoming bits are sampled on the ris-
ing edge of SCL.
I2CADD holds the entire 10-bit address. Upon receiv-
ing an address following a Start bit, I2CRSR <7:3> is
compared against a literal ‘11110’ (the default 10-bit
address) and I2CRSR<2:1> are compared against
I2CADD<9:8>. If a match occurs and if R_W = 0, the
interrupt pulse is sent. The ADD10 bit will be cleared to
indicate a partial address match. If a match fails or
R_W = 1, the ADD10 bit is cleared and the module
returns to the Idle state.
If an address match occurs, an acknowledgement will
be sent, and the slave event interrupt flag (SI2CIF) is
set on the falling edge of the ninth (ACK) bit. The
address match does not affect the contents of the
I2CRCV buffer or the RBF bit.
The low byte of the address is then received and com-
pared with I2CADD<7:0>. If an address match occurs,
the interrupt pulse is generated and the ADD10 bit is
set, indicating a complete 10-bit address match. If an
address match did not occur, the ADD10 bit is cleared
and the module returns to the Idle state.
14.3.1
SLAVE TRANSMISSION
If the R_W bit received is a ‘1’, then the serial port will
go into Transmit mode. It will send ACK on the ninth bit
and then hold SCL to ‘0’ until the CPU responds by writ-
ing to I2CTRN. SCL is released by setting the SCLREL
bit, and 8 bits of data are shifted out. Data bits are
shifted out on the falling edge of SCL, such that SDA is
valid during SCL high. The interrupt pulse is sent on the
falling edge of the ninth clock pulse, regardless of the
status of the ACK received from the master.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 95
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Clock stretching takes place following the ninth clock of
the receive sequence. On the falling edge of the ninth
clock at the end of the ACK sequence, if the RBF bit is
set, the SCLREL bit is automatically cleared, forcing
the SCL output to be held low. The user’s ISR must set
the SCLREL bit before reception is allowed to continue.
By holding the SCL line low, the user has time to ser-
vice the ISR and read the contents of the I2CRCV
before the master device can initiate another receive
sequence. This will prevent buffer overruns from
occurring.
14.4.1
10-BIT MODE SLAVE
TRANSMISSION
Once a slave is addressed in this fashion with the full
10-bit address (we will refer to this state as
“PRIOR_ADDR_MATCH”), the master can begin
sending data bytes for a slave reception operation.
14.4.2
10-BIT MODE SLAVE RECEPTION
Once addressed, the master can generate a Repeated
Start, reset the high byte of the address and set the
R_W bit without generating a Stop bit, thus initiating a
slave transmit operation.
Note 1: If the user reads the contents of the
I2CRCV, clearing the RBF bit before the
falling edge of the ninth clock, the
SCLREL bit will not be cleared and clock
stretching will not occur.
14.5 Automatic Clock Stretch
In the Slave modes, the module can synchronize buffer
reads and write to the master device by clock stretching.
2: The SCLREL bit can be set in software
regardless of the state of the RBF bit. The
user should be careful to clear the RBF bit
in the ISR before the next receive
sequence in order to prevent an overflow
condition.
14.5.1
TRANSMIT CLOCK STRETCHING
Both 10-bit and 7-bit Transmit modes implement clock
stretching by asserting the SCLREL bit after the falling
edge of the ninth clock, if the TBF bit is cleared, indicat-
ing the buffer is empty.
In Slave Transmit modes, clock stretching is always
performed irrespective of the STREN bit.
14.5.4
CLOCK STRETCHING DURING
10-BIT ADDRESSING (STREN = 1)
Clock synchronization takes place following the ninth
clock of the transmit sequence. If the device samples
an ACK on the falling edge of the ninth clock and if the
TBF bit is still clear, then the SCLREL bit is automati-
cally cleared. The SCLREL being cleared to ‘0’ will
assert the SCL line low. The user’s ISR must set the
SCLREL bit before transmission is allowed to continue.
By holding the SCL line low, the user has time to ser-
vice the ISR and load the contents of the I2CTRN
before the master device can initiate another transmit
sequence.
Clock stretching takes place automatically during the
addressing sequence. Because this module has a
register for the entire address, it is not necessary for
the protocol to wait for the address to be updated.
After the address phase is complete, clock stretching
will occur on each data receive or transmit sequence as
was described earlier.
14.6 Software Controlled Clock
Stretching (STREN = 1)
Note 1: If the user loads the contents of I2CTRN,
setting the TBF bit before the falling edge
of the ninth clock, the SCLREL bit will not
be cleared and clock stretching will not
occur.
When the STREN bit is ‘1’, the SCLREL bit may be
cleared by software to allow software to control the
clock stretching. The logic will synchronize writes to the
SCLREL bit with the SCL clock. Clearing the SCLREL
bit will not assert the SCL output until the module
detects a falling edge on the SCL output and SCL is
sampled low. If the SCLREL bit is cleared by the user
while the SCL line has been sampled low, the SCL out-
put will be asserted (held low). The SCL output will
remain low until the SCLREL bit is set, and all other
devices on the I2C bus have de-asserted SCL. This
ensures that a write to the SCLREL bit will not violate
the minimum high time requirement for SCL.
2: The SCLREL bit can be set in software,
regardless of the state of the TBF bit.
14.5.2
RECEIVE CLOCK STRETCHING
The STREN bit in the I2CCON register can be used to
enable clock stretching in Slave Receive mode. When
the STREN bit is set, the SCL pin will be held low at the
end of each data receive sequence.
If the STREN bit is ‘0’, a software write to the SCLREL
bit will be disregarded and have no effect on the
SCLREL bit.
14.5.3
CLOCK STRETCHING DURING
7-BIT ADDRESSING (STREN = 1)
When the STREN bit is set in Slave Receive mode, the
SCL line is held low when the buffer register is full. The
method for stretching the SCL output is the same for
both 7 and 10-bit addressing modes.
DS70139E-page 96
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
2
14.7 Interrupts
14.11 I C Master Support
The I2C module generates two interrupt flags, MI2CIF
(I2C Master Interrupt Flag) and SI2CIF (I2C Slave Inter-
rupt Flag). The MI2CIF interrupt flag is activated on
completion of a master message event. The SI2CIF
interrupt flag is activated on detection of a message
directed to the slave.
As a master device, six operations are supported:
• Assert a Start condition on SDA and SCL.
• Assert a Restart condition on SDA and SCL.
• Write to the I2CTRN register initiating
transmission of data/address.
• Generate a Stop condition on SDA and SCL.
• Configure the I2C port to receive data.
14.8 Slope Control
• Generate an ACK condition at the end of a
received byte of data.
The I2C standard requires slope control on the SDA
and SCL signals for Fast mode (400 kHz). The control
bit, DISSLW, enables the user to disable slew rate con-
trol if desired. It is necessary to disable the slew rate
control for 1 MHz mode.
2
14.12 I C Master Operation
The master device generates all of the serial clock
pulses and the Start and Stop conditions. A transfer is
ended with a Stop condition or with a Repeated Start
condition. Since the Repeated Start condition is also
the beginning of the next serial transfer, the I2C bus will
not be released.
14.9 IPMI Support
The control bit, IPMIEN, enables the module to support
Intelligent Peripheral Management Interface (IPMI).
When this bit is set, the module accepts and acts upon
all addresses.
In Master Transmitter mode, serial data is output
through SDA, while SCL outputs the serial clock. The
first byte transmitted contains the slave address of the
receiving device (7 bits) and the data direction bit. In
this case, the data direction bit (R_W) is logic ‘0’. Serial
data is transmitted 8 bits at a time. After each byte is
transmitted, an ACK bit is received. Start and Stop con-
ditions are output to indicate the beginning and the end
of a serial transfer.
14.10 General Call Address Support
The general call address can address all devices.
When this address is used, all devices should, in
theory, respond with an acknowledgement.
The general call address is one of eight addresses
reserved for specific purposes by the I2C protocol. It
consists of all ‘0’s with R_W = 0.
In Master Receive mode, the first byte transmitted con-
tains the slave address of the transmitting device
(7 bits) and the data direction bit. In this case, the data
direction bit (R_W) is logic ‘1’. Thus, the first byte trans-
mitted is a 7-bit slave address, followed by a ‘1’ to indi-
cate receive bit. Serial data is received via SDA while
SCL outputs the serial clock. Serial data is received
8 bits at a time. After each byte is received, an ACK bit
is transmitted. Start and Stop conditions indicate the
beginning and end of transmission.
The general call address is recognized when the Gen-
eral Call Enable (GCEN) bit is set (I2CCON<7> = 1).
Following a Start bit detection, 8 bits are shifted into
I2CRSR and the address is compared with I2CADD,
and is also compared with the general call address
which is fixed in hardware.
If a general call address match occurs, the I2CRSR is
transferred to the I2CRCV after the eighth clock, the
RBF flag is set and on the falling edge of the ninth bit
(ACK bit), the master event interrupt flag (MI2CIF) is
set.
14.12.1 I2C MASTER TRANSMISSION
Transmission of a data byte, a 7-bit address, or the sec-
ond half of a 10-bit address, is accomplished by simply
writing a value to I2CTRN register. The user should
only write to I2CTRN when the module is in a WAIT
state. This action will set the Buffer Full Flag (TBF) and
allow the Baud Rate Generator to begin counting and
start the next transmission. Each bit of address/data
will be shifted out onto the SDA pin after the falling
edge of SCL is asserted. The Transmit Status Flag,
TRSTAT (I2CSTAT<14>), indicates that a master
transmit is in progress.
When the interrupt is serviced, the source for the inter-
rupt can be checked by reading the contents of the
I2CRCV to determine if the address was device
specific or a general call address.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 97
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
14.12.2 I2C MASTER RECEPTION
If a transmit was in progress when the bus collision
occurred, the transmission is halted, the TBF flag is
cleared, the SDA and SCL lines are de-asserted and a
value can now be written to I2CTRN. When the user
services the I2C master event Interrupt Service Rou-
tine, if the I2C bus is free (i.e., the P bit is set), the user
can resume communication by asserting a Start
condition.
Master mode reception is enabled by programming the
Receive Enable bit, RCEN (I2CCON<3>). The I2C
module must be Idle before the RCEN bit is set, other-
wise the RCEN bit will be disregarded. The Baud Rate
Generator begins counting and on each rollover, the
state of the SCL pin ACK and data are shifted into the
I2CRSR on the rising edge of each clock.
If a Start, Restart, Stop or Acknowledge condition was
in progress when the bus collision occurred, the condi-
tion is aborted, the SDA and SCL lines are de-asserted,
and the respective control bits in the I2CCON register
are cleared to ‘0’. When the user services the bus col-
lision Interrupt Service Routine, and if the I2C bus is
free, the user can resume communication by asserting
a Start condition.
14.12.3 BAUD RATE GENERATOR
In I2C Master mode, the reload value for the BRG is
located in the I2CBRG register. When the BRG is
loaded with this value, the BRG counts down to ‘0’ and
stops until another reload has taken place. If clock arbi-
tration is taking place, for instance, the BRG is reloaded
when the SCL pin is sampled high.
The master will continue to monitor the SDA and SCL
pins, and if a Stop condition occurs, the MI2CIF bit will
be set.
As per the I2C standard, FSCK may be 100 kHz or
400 kHz. However, the user can specify any baud rate
up to 1 MHz. I2CBRG values of ‘0’ or ‘1’ are illegal.
A write to the I2CTRN will start the transmission of data
at the first data bit regardless of where the transmitter
left off when bus collision occurred.
EQUATION 14-1: SERIAL CLOCK RATE
In a multi-master environment, the interrupt generation
on the detection of Start and Stop conditions allows the
determination of when the bus is free. Control of the I2C
bus can be taken when the P bit is set in the I2CSTAT
register, or the bus is Idle and the S and P bits are
cleared.
FCY
FSCL
FCY
1,111,111
I2CBRG =
– 1
–
(
)
14.12.4 CLOCK ARBITRATION
Clock arbitration occurs when the master de-asserts
the SCL pin (SCL allowed to float high) during any
receive, transmit, or Restart/Stop condition. When the
SCL pin is allowed to float high, the Baud Rate Gener-
ator (BRG) is suspended from counting until the SCL
pin is actually sampled high. When the SCL pin is sam-
pled high, the Baud Rate Generator is reloaded with
the contents of I2CBRG and begins counting. This
ensures that the SCL high time will always be at least
one BRG rollover count in the event that the clock is
held low by an external device.
2
14.13 I C Module Operation During CPU
Sleep and Idle Modes
14.13.1 I2C OPERATION DURING CPU
SLEEP MODE
When the device enters Sleep mode, all clock sources
to the module are shut down and stay at logic ‘0’. If
Sleep occurs in the middle of a transmission and the
state machine is partially into a transmission as the
clocks stop, then the transmission is aborted. Similarly,
if Sleep occurs in the middle of a reception, then the
reception is aborted.
14.12.5 MULTI-MASTER COMMUNICATION,
BUS COLLISION, AND BUS
ARBITRATION
14.13.2 I2C OPERATION DURING CPU IDLE
MODE
For the I2C, the I2CSIDL bit selects if the module will
stop on Idle or continue on Idle. If I2CSIDL = 0, the
module will continue operation on assertion of the Idle
mode. If I2CSIDL = 1, the module will stop on Idle.
Multi-master operation support is achieved by bus arbi-
tration. When the master outputs address/data bits
onto the SDA pin, arbitration takes place when the
master outputs a ‘1’ on SDA by letting SDA float high
while another master asserts a ‘0’. When the SCL pin
floats high, data should be stable. If the expected data
on SDA is a ‘1’ and the data sampled on the SDA
pin = 0, then a bus collision has taken place. The
master will set the MI2CIF pulse and reset the master
portion of the I2C port to its Idle state.
DS70139E-page 98
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 14-2: I2C REGISTER MAP
SFR Name Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
I2CRCV
I2CTRN
I2CBRG
I2CCON
I2CSTAT
I2CADD
Note:
0200
0202
0204
0206
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Receive Register
Transmit Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 1111 1111
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
Baud Rate Generator
GCEN STREN ACKDT ACKEN RCEN
GCSTAT ADD10 IWCOL I2COV D_A
Address Register
I2CEN
I2CSIDL SCLREL IPMIEN A10M DISSLW SMEN
PEN
R_W
RSEN
RBF
SEN 0001 0000 0000 0000
0208 ACKSTAT TRSTAT
020A
—
—
—
—
—
—
BCL
—
P
S
TBF
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
—
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 100
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
15.1 UART Module Overview
15.0 UNIVERSAL ASYNCHRONOUS
RECEIVER TRANSMITTER
(UART) MODULE
The key features of the UART module are:
• Full-duplex, 8 or 9-bit data communication
• Even, odd or no parity options (for 8-bit data)
• One or two Stop bits
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
• Fully integrated Baud Rate Generator with 16-bit
prescaler
• Baud rates range from 38 bps to 1.875 Mbps at a
30 MHz instruction rate
This section describes the Universal Asynchronous
Receiver/Transmitter Communications module. The
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012 processors have one UART
module (UART1). The dsPIC30F3013 processor has
two UART modules (UART1 and UART2).
• 4-word deep transmit data buffer
• 4-word deep receive data buffer
• Parity, framing and buffer overrun error detection
• Support for interrupt only on address detect
(9th bit = 1)
• Separate transmit and receive interrupts
• Loopback mode for diagnostic support
• Alternate receive and transmit pins for UART1
FIGURE 15-1:
UART TRANSMITTER BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal Data Bus
Control and Status bits
Write
Write
UTX8 UxTXREG Low Byte
Transmit Control
– Control TSR
– Control Buffer
– Generate Flags
– Generate Interrupt
Load TSR
UxTXIF
UTXBRK
Data
Transmit Shift Register (UxTSR)
‘0’ (Start)
‘1’ (Stop)
UxTX
16x Baud Clock
from Baud Rate
Generator
Parity
Generator
16 Divider
Parity
Control
Signals
Note:
x = 1 or 2.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 101
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 15-2:
UART RECEIVER BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal Data Bus
16
Read
Write
Read Read
Write
UxMODE
UxSTA
UxRXREG Low Byte
URX8
Receive Buffer Control
– Generate Flags
– Generate Interrupt
– Shift Data Characters
8-9
LPBACK
From UxTX
Load RSR
to Buffer
Receive Shift Register
(UxRSR)
1
0
Control
Signals
UxRX
· Start bit Detect
· Parity Check
· Stop bit Detect
· Shift Clock Generation
· Wake Logic
16 Divider
16x Baud Clock from
Baud Rate Generator
UxRXIF
DS70139E-page 102
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
15.2 Enabling and Setting Up UART
15.3 Transmitting Data
15.2.1 ENABLING THE UART
15.3.1 TRANSMITTING IN 8-BIT DATA
MODE
The UART module is enabled by setting the UARTEN
bit in the UxMODE register (where x = 1 or 2). Once
enabled, the UxTX and UxRX pins are configured as an
output and an input respectively, overriding the TRIS
and LAT register bit settings for the corresponding I/O
port pins. The UxTX pin is at logic ‘1’ when no
transmission is taking place.
The following steps must be performed in order to
transmit 8-bit data:
1. Set up the UART:
First, the data length, parity and number of Stop
bits must be selected. Then, the transmit and
receive interrupt enable and priority bits are
setup in the UxMODE and UxSTA registers.
Also, the appropriate baud rate value must be
written to the UxBRG register.
15.2.2
DISABLING THE UART
The UART module is disabled by clearing the UARTEN
bit in the UxMODE register. This is the default state
after any Reset. If the UART is disabled, all I/O pins
operate as port pins under the control of the LAT and
TRIS bits of the corresponding port pins.
2. Enable the UART by setting the UARTEN bit
(UxMODE<15>).
3. Set the UTXEN bit (UxSTA<10>), thereby
enabling a transmission.
Disabling the UART module resets the buffers to empty
states. Any data characters in the buffers are lost and
the baud rate counter is reset.
4. Write the byte to be transmitted to the lower byte
of UxTXREG. The value will be transferred to the
Transmit Shift register (UxTSR) immediately
and the serial bit stream will start shifting out
during the next rising edge of the baud clock.
Alternatively, the data byte may be written while
UTXEN = 0, following which, the user may set
UTXEN. This will cause the serial bit stream to
begin immediately because the baud clock will
start from a cleared state.
All error and status flags associated with the UART
module are reset when the module is disabled. The
URXDA, OERR, FERR, PERR, UTXEN, UTXBRK and
UTXBF bits are cleared, whereas RIDLE and TRMT
are set. Other control bits, including ADDEN,
URXISEL<1:0>, UTXISEL, as well as the UxMODE
and UxBRG registers, are not affected.
5. A transmit interrupt will be generated, depend-
ing on the value of the interrupt control bit
UTXISEL (UxSTA<15>).
Clearing the UARTEN bit while the UART is active will
abort all pending transmissions and receptions and
reset the module as defined above. Re-enabling the
UART will restart the UART in the same configuration.
15.3.2
TRANSMITTING IN 9-BIT DATA
MODE
15.2.3
ALTERNATE I/O
The sequence of steps involved in the transmission of
9-bit data is similar to 8-bit transmission, except that a
16-bit data word (of which the upper 7 bits are always
clear) must be written to the UxTXREG register.
The alternate I/O function is enabled by setting the
ALTIO bit (UxMODE<10>). If ALTIO = 1, the UxATX
and UxARX pins (alternate transmit and alternate
receive pins, respectively) are used by the UART mod-
ule instead of the UxTX and UxRX pins. If ALTIO = 0,
the UxTX and UxRX pins are used by the UART
module.
15.3.3
TRANSMIT BUFFER (UXTXB)
The transmit buffer is 9 bits wide and 4 characters
deep. Including the Transmit Shift register (UxTSR),
the user effectively has a 5-deep FIFO (First-In, First-
Out) buffer. The UTXBF bit (UxSTA<9>) indicates
whether the transmit buffer is full.
15.2.4
SETTING UP DATA, PARITY AND
STOP BIT SELECTIONS
Control bits PDSEL<1:0> in the UxMODE register are
used to select the data length and parity used in the
transmission. The data length may either be 8 bits with
even, odd or no parity, or 9 bits with no parity.
If a user attempts to write to a full buffer, the new data
will not be accepted into the FIFO and no data shift will
occur within the buffer. This enables recovery from a
buffer overrun condition.
The STSEL bit determines whether one or two Stop bits
will be used during data transmission.
The FIFO is reset during any device Reset, but is not
affected when the device enters or wakes up from a
Power Saving mode.
The default (power-on) setting of the UART is 8 bits, no
parity and 1 Stop bit (typically represented as 8, N, 1).
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 103
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
15.3.4
TRANSMIT INTERRUPT
15.4.2
RECEIVE BUFFER (UXRXB)
The transmit interrupt flag (U1TXIF or U2TXIF) is
located in the corresponding interrupt flag register.
The receive buffer is 4 words deep. Including the
Receive Shift register (UxRSR), the user effectively
has a 5-word deep FIFO buffer.
The transmitter generates an edge to set the UxTXIF
bit. The condition for generating the interrupt depends
on the UTXISEL control bit:
URXDA (UxSTA<0>) = 1 indicates that the receive
buffer has data available. URXDA = 0implies that the
buffer is empty. If a user attempts to read an empty
buffer, the old values in the buffer will be read and no
data shift will occur within the FIFO.
a) If UTXISEL = 0, an interrupt is generated when
a word is transferred from the transmit buffer to
the Transmit Shift register (UxTSR). This means
that the transmit buffer has at least one empty
word.
The FIFO is reset during any device Reset. It is not
affected when the device enters or wakes up from a
Power Saving mode.
b) If UTXISEL = 1, an interrupt is generated when
a word is transferred from the transmit buffer to
the Transmit Shift register (UxTSR) and the
transmit buffer is empty.
15.4.3
RECEIVE INTERRUPT
The receive interrupt flag (U1RXIF or U2RXIF) can be
read from the corresponding interrupt flag register. The
interrupt flag is set by an edge generated by the
receiver. The condition for setting the receive interrupt
flag depends on the settings specified by the
URXISEL<1:0> (UxSTA<7:6>) control bits.
Switching between the two Interrupt modes during
operation is possible and sometimes offers more
flexibility.
15.3.5
TRANSMIT BREAK
a) If URXISEL<1:0> = 00or 01, an interrupt is gen-
erated every time a data word is transferred
from the Receive Shift register (UxRSR) to the
receive buffer. There may be one or more
characters in the receive buffer.
Setting the UTXBRK bit (UxSTA<11>) will cause the
UxTX line to be driven to logic ‘0’. The UTXBRK bit
overrides all transmission activity. Therefore, the user
should generally wait for the transmitter to be Idle
before setting UTXBRK.
b) If URXISEL<1:0> = 10, an interrupt is generated
when a word is transferred from the Receive Shift
register (UxRSR) to the receive buffer, which as a
result of the transfer, contains 3 characters.
To send a Break character, the UTXBRK bit must be set
by software and must remain set for a minimum of 13
baud clock cycles. The UTXBRK bit is then cleared by
software to generate Stop bits. The user must wait for
a duration of at least one or two baud clock cycles in
order to ensure a valid Stop bit(s) before reloading the
UxTXB, or starting other transmitter activity. Transmis-
sion of a Break character does not generate a transmit
interrupt.
c) If URXISEL<1:0> = 11, an interrupt is set when
a word is transferred from the Receive Shift reg-
ister (UxRSR) to the receive buffer, which as a
result of the transfer, contains 4 characters (i.e.,
becomes full).
Switching between the Interrupt modes during opera-
tion is possible, though generally not advisable during
normal operation.
15.4 Receiving Data
15.4.1
RECEIVING IN 8-BIT OR 9-BIT
DATA MODE
15.5 Reception Error Handling
The following steps must be performed while receiving
8-bit or 9-bit data:
15.5.1
RECEIVE BUFFER OVERRUN
ERROR (OERR BIT)
1. Set up the UART (see Section 15.3.1 “Trans-
mitting in 8-bit data mode”).
The OERR bit (UxSTA<1>) is set if all of the following
conditions occur:
2. Enable the UART (see Section 15.3.1 “Trans-
mitting in 8-bit data mode”).
a) The receive buffer is full.
3. A receive interrupt will be generated when one
or more data words have been received,
depending on the receive interrupt settings
specified by the URXISEL bits (UxSTA<7:6>).
b) The Receive Shift register is full, but unable to
transfer the character to the receive buffer.
c) The Stop bit of the character in the UxRSR is
detected, indicating that the UxRSR needs to
transfer the character to the buffer.
4. Read the OERR bit to determine if an overrun
error has occurred. The OERR bit must be reset
in software.
Once OERR is set, no further data is shifted in UxRSR
(until the OERR bit is cleared in software or a Reset
occurs). The data held in UxRSR and UxRXREG
remains valid.
5. Read the received data from UxRXREG. The act
of reading UxRXREG will move the next word to
the top of the receive FIFO, and the PERR and
FERR values will be updated.
DS70139E-page 104
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
15.5.2
FRAMING ERROR (FERR)
15.6 Address Detect Mode
The FERR bit (UxSTA<2>) is set if a ‘0’ is detected
instead of a Stop bit. If two Stop bits are selected, both
Stop bits must be ‘1’, otherwise FERR will be set. The
read-only FERR bit is buffered along with the received
data. It is cleared on any Reset.
Setting the ADDEN bit (UxSTA<5>) enables this spe-
cial mode in which a 9th bit (URX8) value of ‘1’ identi-
fies the received word as an address, rather than data.
This mode is only applicable for 9-bit data communica-
tion. The URXISEL control bit does not have any
impact on interrupt generation in this mode since an
interrupt (if enabled) will be generated every time the
received word has the 9th bit set.
15.5.3
PARITY ERROR (PERR)
The PERR bit (UxSTA<3>) is set if the parity of the
received word is incorrect. This error bit is applicable
only if a Parity mode (odd or even) is selected. The
read-only PERR bit is buffered along with the received
data bytes. It is cleared on any Reset.
15.7 Loopback Mode
Setting the LPBACK bit enables this special mode in
which the UxTX pin is internally connected to the UxRX
pin. When configured for the Loopback mode, the
UxRX pin is disconnected from the internal UART
receive logic. However, the UxTX pin still functions as
in a normal operation.
15.5.4
IDLE STATUS
When the receiver is active (i.e., between the initial
detection of the Start bit and the completion of the Stop
bit), the RIDLE bit (UxSTA<4>) is ‘0’. Between the com-
pletion of the Stop bit and detection of the next Start bit,
the RIDLE bit is ‘1’, indicating that the UART is Idle.
To select this mode:
a) Configure UART for desired mode of operation.
b) Set LPBACK = 1to enable Loopback mode.
15.5.5
RECEIVE BREAK
c) Enable transmission as defined in Section 15.3
“Transmitting Data”.
The receiver will count and expect a certain number of
bit times based on the values programmed in the
PDSEL (UxMODE<2:1>) and STSEL (UxMODE<0>)
bits.
15.8 Baud Rate Generator
The UART has a 16-bit Baud Rate Generator to allow
maximum flexibility in baud rate generation. The Baud
Rate Generator register (UxBRG) is readable and
writable. The baud rate is computed as follows:
If the break is longer than 13 bit times, the reception is
considered complete after the number of bit times
specified by PDSEL and STSEL. The URXDA bit is set,
FERR is set, zeros are loaded into the receive FIFO,
interrupts are generated if appropriate and the RIDLE
bit is set.
BRG = 16-bit value held in UxBRG register
(0 through 65535)
When the module receives a long break signal and the
receiver has detected the Start bit, the data bits and the
invalid Stop bit (which sets the FERR), the receiver
must wait for a valid Stop bit before looking for the next
Start bit. It cannot assume that the break condition on
the line is the next Start bit.
FCY = Instruction Clock Rate (1/TCY)
The baud rate is given by Equation 15-1.
EQUATION 15-1: BAUD RATE
Baud Rate = FCY / (16*(BRG+1))
Break is regarded as a character containing all ‘0’s with
the FERR bit set. The Break character is loaded into
the buffer. No further reception can occur until a Stop bit
is received. Note that RIDLE goes high when the Stop
bit has not yet been received.
Therefore, the maximum baud rate possible is:
FCY /16 (if BRG = 0),
and the minimum baud rate possible is:
FCY / (16* 65536).
With a full 16-bit Baud Rate Generator at 30 MIPS
operation, the minimum baud rate achievable is
28.5 bps.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 105
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
15.10.2 UART OPERATION DURING CPU
15.9 Auto-Baud Support
IDLE MODE
To allow the system to determine baud rates of
received characters, the input can be optionally linked
to a selected capture input (IC1 for UART1 and IC2 for
UART2). To enable this mode, you must program the
input capture module to detect the falling and rising
edges of the Start bit.
For the UART, the USIDL bit selects if the module will
stop operation when the device enters Idle mode or
whether the module will continue on Idle. If USIDL = 0,
the module will continue operation during Idle mode. If
USIDL = 1, the module will stop on Idle.
15.10 UART Operation During CPU
Sleep and Idle Modes
15.10.1 UART OPERATION DURING CPU
SLEEP MODE
When the device enters Sleep mode, all clock sources
to the module are shut down and stay at logic ‘0’. If
entry into Sleep mode occurs while a transmission is in
progress, then the transmission is aborted. The UxTX
pin is driven to logic ‘1’. Similarly, if entry into Sleep
mode occurs while a reception is in progress, then the
reception is aborted. The UxSTA, UxMODE, transmit
and receive registers and buffers, and the UxBRG
register are not affected by Sleep mode.
If the WAKE bit (UxMODE<7>) is set before the device
enters Sleep mode, then a falling edge on the UxRX pin
will generate a receive interrupt. The Receive Interrupt
Select mode bit (URXISEL) has no effect for this func-
tion. If the receive interrupt is enabled, then this will
wake-up the device from Sleep. The UARTEN bit must
be set in order to generate a wake-up interrupt.
DS70139E-page 106
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 15-1: UART1 REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
SFR Name Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
U1MODE
U1STA
020C UARTEN
020E UTXISEL
—
—
—
—
USIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
ALTIO
—
—
WAKE
LPBACK ABAUD
—
—
PDSEL1 PDSEL0 STSEL 0000 0000 0000 0000
UTXBRK UTXEN UTXBF
TRMT URXISEL1 URXISEL0 ADDEN RIDLE PERR
FERR
OERR URXDA 0000 0001 0001 0000
0000 000u uuuu uuuu
U1TXREG 0210
U1RXREG 0212
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
UTX8
Transmit Register
Receive Register
—
URX8
0000 0000 0000 0000
U1BRG
0214
u= uninitialized bit
Baud Rate Generator Prescaler
0000 0000 0000 0000
Legend:
TABLE 15-2: UART2 REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F3013(1)
SFR
Name
Addr.
Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
U2MODE
U2STA
0216 UARTEN
0218 UTXISEL
—
—
—
—
USIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
ALTIO
—
—
WAKE
LPBACK ABAUD
—
—
PDSEL1 PDSEL0 STSEL 0000 0000 0000 0000
UTXBRK UTXEN UTXBF
TRMT URXISEL1 URXISEL0 ADDEN RIDLE PERR
FERR
OERR URXDA 0000 0001 0001 0000
0000 000u uuuu uuuu
U2TXREG 021A
U2RXREG 021C
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
UTX8
Transmit Register
Receive Register
—
URX8
0000 0000 0000 0000
U2BRG
021E
u= uninitialized bit
UART2 is not available on the dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
Baud Rate Generator Prescaler
0000 0000 0000 0000
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 108
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
The ADC module has six 16-bit registers:
16.0 12-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL
• A/D Control Register 1 (ADCON1)
• A/D Control Register 2 (ADCON2)
• A/D Control Register 3 (ADCON3)
• A/D Input Select Register (ADCHS)
• A/D Port Configuration Register (ADPCFG)
• A/D Input Scan Selection Register (ADCSSL)
CONVERTER (ADC) MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
The ADCON1, ADCON2 and ADCON3 registers
control the operation of the ADC module. The ADCHS
register selects the input channels to be converted. The
ADPCFG register configures the port pins as analog
inputs or as digital I/O. The ADCSSL register selects
inputs for scanning.
The 12-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter allows conver-
sion of an analog input signal to a 12-bit digital number.
This module is based on a Successive Approximation
Register (SAR) architecture and provides a maximum
sampling rate of 200 ksps. The ADC module has up to
10 analog inputs which are multiplexed into a sample
and hold amplifier. The output of the sample and hold
is the input into the converter which generates the
result. The analog reference voltage is software select-
able to either the device supply voltage (AVDD/AVSS) or
the voltage level on the (VREF+/VREF-) pin. The ADC
has a unique feature of being able to operate while the
device is in Sleep mode with RC oscillator selection.
Note:
The SSRC<2:0>, ASAM, SMPI<3:0>,
BUFM and ALTS bits, as well as the
ADCON3 and ADCSSL registers, must
not be written to while ADON = 1. This
would lead to indeterminate results.
The block diagram of the 12-bit ADC module is shown
in Figure 16-1.
FIGURE 16-1:
12-BIT ADC FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM
AVDD/VREF+
AVSS/VREF-
Comparator
DAC
0000
AN0
0001
0010
0011
AN1
AN2
AN3
12-bit SAR
Conversion Logic
0100
0101
0110
0111
1000
1001
AN4
AN5
AN6
AN7
AN8
AN9
16-word, 12-bit
Dual Port
Buffer
Sample/Sequence
Control
Sample
CH0
S/H
Input
Switches
Input MUX
Control
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 109
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
16.1 A/D Result Buffer
16.3 Selecting the Conversion
Sequence
The module contains a 16-word dual port read-only
buffer, called ADCBUF0...ADCBUFF, to buffer the A/D
results. The RAM is 12 bits wide but the data obtained
is represented in one of four different 16-bit data for-
mats. The contents of the sixteen A/D Conversion
Result Buffer registers, ADCBUF0 through ADCBUFF,
cannot be written by user software.
Several groups of control bits select the sequence in
which the A/D connects inputs to the sample/hold
channel, converts a channel, writes the buffer memory
and generates interrupts.
The sequence is controlled by the sampling clocks.
The SMPI bits select the number of acquisition/
conversion sequences that would be performed before
an interrupt occurs. This can vary from 1 sample per
interrupt to 16 samples per interrupt.
16.2 Conversion Operation
After the ADC module has been configured, the sample
acquisition is started by setting the SAMP bit. Various
sources, such as a programmable bit, timer time-outs
and external events, will terminate acquisition and start
a conversion. When the A/D conversion is complete,
the result is loaded into ADCBUF0...ADCBUFF, and
the DONE bit and the A/D interrupt flag, ADIF, are set
after the number of samples specified by the SMPI bit.
The ADC module can be configured for different inter-
rupt rates as described in Section 16.3 “Selecting the
Conversion Sequence”.
The BUFM bit will split the 16-word results buffer into
two 8-word groups. Writing to the 8-word buffers will be
alternated on each interrupt event.
Use of the BUFM bit will depend on how much time is
available for the moving of the buffers after the
interrupt.
If the processor can quickly unload a full buffer within
the time it takes to acquire and convert one channel,
the BUFM bit can be ‘0’ and up to 16 conversions (cor-
responding to the 16 input channels) may be done per
interrupt. The processor will have one acquisition and
conversion time to move the sixteen conversions.
The following steps should be followed for doing an
A/D conversion:
1. Configure the ADC module:
If the processor cannot unload the buffer within the
acquisition and conversion time, the BUFM bit should be
‘1’. For example, if SMPI<3:0> (ADCON2<5:2>) = 0111,
then eight conversions will be loaded into 1/2 of the
buffer, following which an interrupt occurs. The next
eight conversions will be loaded into the other 1/2 of the
buffer. The processor will have the entire time between
interrupts to move the eight conversions.
• Configure analog pins, voltage reference and
digital I/O
• Select A/D input channels
• Select A/D conversion clock
• Select A/D conversion trigger
• Turn on ADC module
2. Configure A/D interrupt (if required):
• Clear ADIF bit
The ALTS bit can be used to alternate the inputs
selected during the sampling sequence. The input
multiplexer has two sets of sample inputs: MUX A and
MUX B. If the ALTS bit is ‘0’, only the MUX A inputs are
selected for sampling. If the ALTS bit is ‘1’ and
SMPI<3:0> = 0000 on the first sample/convert
sequence, the MUX A inputs are selected and on the
next acquire/convert sequence, the MUX B inputs are
selected.
• Select A/D interrupt priority
3. Start sampling
4. Wait the required acquisition time
5. Trigger acquisition end, start conversion
6. Wait for A/D conversion to complete, by either:
• Waiting for the A/D interrupt, or
• Waiting for the DONE bit to get set
7. Read A/D result buffer; clear ADIF if required
The CSCNA bit (ADCON2<10>) will allow the multi-
plexer input to be alternately scanned across a
selected number of analog inputs for the MUX A group.
The inputs are selected by the ADCSSL register. If a
particular bit in the ADCSSL register is ‘1’, the corre-
sponding input is selected. The inputs are always
scanned from lower to higher numbered inputs, starting
after each interrupt. If the number of inputs selected is
greater than the number of samples taken per interrupt,
the higher numbered inputs are unused.
DS70139E-page 110
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
The internal RC oscillator is selected by setting the
ADRC bit.
16.4 Programming the Start of
Conversion Trigger
For correct ADC conversions, the ADC conversion
clock (TAD) must be selected to ensure a minimum TAD
time of 334 nsec (for VDD = 5V). Refer to Section 20.0
“Electrical Characteristics” for minimum TAD under
other operating conditions.
The conversion trigger will terminate acquisition and
start the requested conversions.
The SSRC<2:0> bits select the source of the conver-
sion trigger. The SSRC bits provide for up to 4 alternate
sources of conversion trigger.
Example 16-1 shows a sample calculation for the
ADCS<5:0> bits, assuming a device operating speed
of 30 MIPS.
When SSRC<2:0> = 000, the conversion trigger is
under software control. Clearing the SAMP bit will
cause the conversion trigger.
EXAMPLE 16-1:
ADC CONVERSION
CLOCK AND SAMPLING
RATE CALCULATION
When SSRC<2:0> = 111(Auto-Start mode), the con-
version trigger is under A/D clock control. The SAMC
bits select the number of A/D clocks between the start
of acquisition and the start of conversion. This provides
the fastest conversion rates on multiple channels.
SAMC must always be at least 1 clock cycle.
Minimum TAD = 334 nsec
TCY = 33 .33 nsec (30 MIPS)
TAD
TCY
334 nsec
33.33 nsec
Other trigger sources can come from timer modules or
external interrupts.
ADCS<5:0> = 2
– 1
= 2 •
– 1
16.5 Aborting a Conversion
= 19.04
Clearing the ADON bit during a conversion will abort
the current conversion and stop the sampling sequenc-
ing until the next sampling trigger. The ADCBUF will not
be updated with the partially completed A/D conversion
sample. That is, the ADCBUF will continue to contain
the value of the last completed conversion (or the last
value written to the ADCBUF register).
Therefore,
Set ADCS<5:0> = 19
TCY
2
Actual TAD =
(ADCS<5:0> + 1)
33.33 nsec
2
=
(19 + 1)
If the clearing of the ADON bit coincides with an auto-
start, the clearing has a higher priority and a new
conversion will not start.
= 334 nsec
If SSRC<2:0> = ‘111’ and SAMC<4:0> = ‘00001’
After the A/D conversion is aborted, a 2 TAD wait is
required before the next sampling may be started by
setting the SAMP bit.
Since,
Sampling Time = Acquisition Time + Conversion Time
= 1 TAD + 14 TAD
= 15 x 334 nsec
16.6 Selecting the ADC Conversion
Clock
Therefore,
1
Sampling Rate =
(15 x 334 nsec)
The ADC conversion requires 14 TAD. The source of
the ADC conversion clock is software selected, using a
six-bit counter. There are 64 possible options for TAD.
= ~200 kHz
EQUATION 16-1: ADC CONVERSION
CLOCK
TAD = TCY * (0.5*(ADCS<5:0> + 1))
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 111
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
16.7
ADC Speeds
The dsPIC30F 12-bit ADC specifications permit a max-
imum of 200 ksps sampling rate. Table 16-1 summa-
rizes the conversion speeds for the dsPIC30F 12-bit
ADC and the required operating conditions.
Figure 16-2 depicts the recommended circuit for the
conversion rates above 200 ksps. The dsPIC30F2011
is shown as an example.
TABLE 16-1: 12-BIT ADC EXTENDED CONVERSION RATES
dsPIC30F 12-bit ADC Conversion Rates
TAD
Sampling
Speed
Rs Max
VDD
Temperature
Channels Configuration
Minimum Time Min
Up to 200
ksps(1)
334 ns
668 ns
1 TAD
1 TAD
2.5 kΩ
4.5V to 5.5V -40°C to +85°C
V
REF- VREF+
CHX
ANx
S/H
ADC
Up to 100
ksps
2.5 kΩ
3.0V to 5.5V -40°C to +125°C
VREF
-
V
REF
or
+
or
AVSS AVDD
CHX
ANx
S/H
ADC
ANx or VREF
-
Note 1: External VREF- and VREF+ pins must be used for correct operation. See Figure 16-2 for recommended
circuit.
FIGURE 16-2:
ADC VOLTAGE REFERENCE SCHEMATIC
VDD
See Note 1:
R2
10
VDD
VDD
VDD
C2
0.1 μF
C1
0.01 μF
VDD
C8
1 μF
C7
0.1 μF
C6
0.01 μF
R1
10
1
2
3
4
21
20
19
18
VDD
VDD
dsPIC30F2011
AVDD
AVDD
AVDD
VSS
6
7
VSS
15
C5
1 μF
C4
0.1 μF
C3
0.01 μF
VDD
Note 1: Ensure adequate bypass capacitors are provided on each VDD pin.
DS70139E-page 112
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
The configuration procedures below give the required
setup values for the conversion speeds above 100
ksps.
The following figure shows the timing diagram of the
ADC running at 200 ksps. The TAD selection in conjunc-
tion with the guidelines described above allows a con-
version speed of 200 ksps. See Example 16-1 for code
example.
16.7.1
200 KSPS CONFIGURATION
GUIDELINE
16.8 A/D Acquisition Requirements
The following configuration items are required to
achieve a 200 ksps conversion rate.
The analog input model of the 12-bit ADC is shown in
Figure 16-3. The total sampling time for the A/D is a
function of the internal amplifier settling time and the
holding capacitor charge time.
• Comply with conditions provided in Table 16-1.
• Connect external VREF+ and VREF- pins following
the recommended circuit shown in Figure 16-2.
• Set SSRC<2.0> = 111in the ADCON1 register to
enable the auto convert option.
For the ADC to meet its specified accuracy, the charge
holding capacitor (CHOLD) must be allowed to fully
charge to the voltage level on the analog input pin. The
source impedance (RS), the interconnect impedance
(RIC), and the internal sampling switch (RSS) imped-
ance combine to directly affect the time required to
charge the capacitor CHOLD. The combined imped-
ance of the analog sources must therefore be small
enough to fully charge the holding capacitor within the
chosen sample time. To minimize the effects of pin
leakage currents on the accuracy of the ADC, the max-
imum recommended source impedance, RS, is 2.5 kΩ.
After the analog input channel is selected (changed),
this sampling function must be completed prior to start-
ing the conversion. The internal holding capacitor will
be in a discharged state prior to each sample opera-
tion.
• Enable automatic sampling by setting the ASAM
control bit in the ADCON1 register.
• Write the SMPI<3.0> control bits in the ADCON2
register for the desired number of conversions
between interrupts.
• Configure the ADC clock period to be:
1
= 334 ns
(14 + 1) x 200,000
by writing to the ADCS<5:0> control bits in the
ADCON3 register.
• Configure the sampling time to be 1 TAD by
writing: SAMC<4:0> = 00001.
FIGURE 16-3:
12-BIT A/D CONVERTER ANALOG INPUT MODEL
VDD
RIC ≤ 250Ω
RSS ≤ 3 kΩ
Sampling
Switch
VT = 0.6V
VT = 0.6V
ANx
RSS
Rs
CHOLD
CPIN
= DAC capacitance
VA
I leakage
500 nA
= 18 pF
VSS
Legend: CPIN
= input capacitance
= threshold voltage
VT
I leakage = leakage current at the pin due to
various junctions
RIC
= interconnect resistance
RSS
= sampling switch resistance
= sample/hold capacitance (from DAC)
CHOLD
Note: CPIN value depends on device package and is not tested. Effect of CPIN negligible if Rs ≤ 2.5 kΩ.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 113
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
inates all digital switching noise from the conversion.
When the conversion is complete, the CONV bit will be
cleared and the result loaded into the ADCBUF register.
16.9 Module Power-Down Modes
The module has 2 internal power modes.
When the ADON bit is ‘1’, the module is in Active mode;
it is fully powered and functional.
If the A/D interrupt is enabled, the device will wake-up
from Sleep. If the A/D interrupt is not enabled, the ADC
module will then be turned off, although the ADON bit
will remain set.
When ADON is ‘0’, the module is in Off mode. The dig-
ital and analog portions of the circuit are disabled for
maximum current savings.
16.10.2 A/D OPERATION DURING CPU IDLE
MODE
In order to return to the Active mode from Off mode, the
user must wait for the ADC circuitry to stabilize.
The ADSIDL bit selects if the module will stop on Idle or
continue on Idle. If ADSIDL = 0, the module will con-
tinue operation on assertion of Idle mode. If ADSIDL =
1, the module will stop on Idle.
16.10 A/D Operation During CPU Sleep
and Idle Modes
16.10.1 A/D OPERATION DURING CPU
SLEEP MODE
16.11 Effects of a Reset
A device Reset forces all registers to their Reset state.
This forces the ADC module to be turned off, and any
conversion and sampling sequence is aborted. The val-
ues that are in the ADCBUF registers are not modified.
The A/D Result register will contain unknown data after
a Power-on Reset.
When the device enters Sleep mode, all clock sources
to the module are shut down and stay at logic ‘0’.
If Sleep occurs in the middle of a conversion, the con-
version is aborted. The converter will not continue with
a partially completed conversion on exit from Sleep
mode.
Register contents are not affected by the device
entering or leaving Sleep mode.
16.12 Output Formats
The A/D result is 12 bits wide. The data buffer RAM is
also 12 bits wide. The 12-bit data can be read in one of
four different formats. The FORM<1:0> bits select the
format. Each of the output formats translates to a 16-bit
result on the data bus.
The ADC module can operate during Sleep mode if the
A/D clock source is set to RC (ADRC = 1). When the RC
clock source is selected, the ADC module waits one
instruction cycle before starting the conversion. This
allows the SLEEPinstruction to be executed which elim-
FIGURE 16-4:
RAM Contents:
Read to Bus:
A/D OUTPUT DATA FORMATS
d11 d10 d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
Signed Fractional
d11 d10 d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
d11 d10 d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Fractional
Signed Integer
Integer
d11 d11 d11 d11 d11 d10 d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
0
0
0
0
d11 d10 d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
DS70139E-page 114
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
16.13 Configuring Analog Port Pins
16.14 Connection Considerations
The use of the ADPCFG and TRIS registers control the
operation of the A/D port pins. The port pins that are
desired as analog inputs must have their correspond-
ing TRIS bit set (input). If the TRIS bit is cleared (out-
put), the digital output level (VOH or VOL) will be
converted.
The analog inputs have diodes to VDD and VSS as ESD
protection. This requires that the analog input be
between VDD and VSS. If the input voltage exceeds this
range by greater than 0.3V (either direction), one of the
diodes becomes forward biased and it may damage the
device if the input current specification is exceeded.
The A/D operation is independent of the state of the
CH0SA<3:0>/CH0SB<3:0> bits and the TRIS bits.
An external RC filter is sometimes added for anti-
aliasing of the input signal. The R component should be
selected to ensure that the sampling time requirements
are satisfied. Any external components connected (via
high-impedance) to an analog input pin (capacitor,
zener diode, etc.) should have very little leakage
current at the pin.
When reading the PORT register, all pins configured as
analog input channels will read as cleared.
Pins configured as digital inputs will not convert an ana-
log input. Analog levels on any pin that is defined as a
digital input (including the ANx pins) may cause the
input buffer to consume current that exceeds the
device specifications.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 115
TABLE 16-2: A/D CONVERTER REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F2011/3012
SFR
Name
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
ADCBUF0 0280
ADCBUF1 0282
ADCBUF2 0284
ADCBUF3 0286
ADCBUF4 0288
ADCBUF5 028A
ADCBUF6 028C
ADCBUF7 028E
ADCBUF8 0290
ADCBUF9 0292
ADCBUFA 0294
ADCBUFB 0296
ADCBUFC 0298
ADCBUFD 029A
ADCBUFE 029C
ADCBUFF 029E
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 0
ADC Data Buffer 1
ADC Data Buffer 2
ADC Data Buffer 3
ADC Data Buffer 4
ADC Data Buffer 5
ADC Data Buffer 6
ADC Data Buffer 7
ADC Data Buffer 8
ADC Data Buffer 9
ADC Data Buffer 10
ADC Data Buffer 11
ADC Data Buffer 12
ADC Data Buffer 13
ADC Data Buffer 14
ADC Data Buffer 15
SSRC<2:0>
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADCON1
ADCON2
ADCON3
ADCHS
ADPCFG
ADCSSL
Legend:
Note:
02A0
02A2
02A4
02A6
02A8
02AA
ADON
—
ADSIDL
—
—
—
CSCNA
FORM<1:0>
—
—
ASAM SAMP
BUFM
DONE
ALTS
VCFG<2:0>
—
—
BUFS
ADRC
—
—
SMPI<3:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SAMC<4:0>
—
ADCS<5:0>
CH0SA<3:0>
CH0NB
—
CH0SB<3:0>
—
—
CH0NA
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PCFG7 PCFG6 PCFG5 PCFG4 PCFG3 PCFG2 PCFG1 PCFG0
CSSL7 CSSL6 CSSL5 CSSL4 CSSL3 CSSL2 CSSL1 CSSL0
—
u= uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TABLE 16-3: A/D CONVERTER REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F2012/3013
SFR
Name
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
ADCBUF0 0280
ADCBUF1 0282
ADCBUF2 0284
ADCBUF3 0286
ADCBUF4 0288
ADCBUF5 028A
ADCBUF6 028C
ADCBUF7 028E
ADCBUF8 0290
ADCBUF9 0292
ADCBUFA 0294
ADCBUFB 0296
ADCBUFC 0298
ADCBUFD 029A
ADCBUFE 029C
ADCBUFF 029E
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 0
ADC Data Buffer 1
ADC Data Buffer 2
ADC Data Buffer 3
ADC Data Buffer 4
ADC Data Buffer 5
ADC Data Buffer 6
ADC Data Buffer 7
ADC Data Buffer 8
ADC Data Buffer 9
ADC Data Buffer 10
ADC Data Buffer 11
ADC Data Buffer 12
ADC Data Buffer 13
ADC Data Buffer 14
ADC Data Buffer 15
SSRC<2:0>
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADCON1
ADCON2
ADCON3
ADCHS
ADPCFG
ADCSSL
Legend:
Note:
02A0
02A2
02A4
02A6
02A8
02AA
ADON
—
ADSIDL
—
—
—
CSCNA
FORM<1:0>
—
—
ASAM SAMP
BUFM
DONE
ALTS
VCFG<2:0>
—
—
BUFS
ADRC
—
—
SMPI<3:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SAMC<4:0>
—
ADCS<5:0>
CH0SA<3:0>
CH0NB
—
CH0SB<3:0>
—
—
CH0NA
—
—
—
—
PCFG9 PCFG8 PCFG7 PCFG6 PCFG5 PCFG4 PCFG3 PCFG2 PCFG1 PCFG0
CSSL9 CSSL8 CSSL7 CSSL6 CSSL5 CSSL4 CSSL3 CSSL2 CSSL1 CSSL0
—
u= uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 118
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
17.1 Oscillator System Overview
17.0 SYSTEM INTEGRATION
The dsPIC30F oscillator system has the following
modules and features:
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
• Various external and internal oscillator options as
clock sources
• An on-chip PLL to boost internal operating
frequency
• A clock switching mechanism between various
clock sources
There are several features intended to maximize sys-
tem reliability, minimize cost through elimination of
external components, provide Power Saving Operating
modes and offer code protection:
• Programmable clock postscaler for system power
savings
• A Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) that detects
clock failure and takes fail-safe measures
• Oscillator Selection
• Reset
• Clock Control register (OSCCON)
- Power-on Reset (POR)
- Power-up Timer (PWRT)
- Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
- Programmable Brown-out Reset (BOR)
• Watchdog Timer (WDT)
• Low-Voltage Detect
• Configuration bits for main oscillator selection
Configuration bits determine the clock source upon
Power-on Reset (POR) and Brown-out Reset (BOR).
Thereafter, the clock source can be changed between
permissible clock sources. The OSCCON register con-
trols the clock switching and reflects system clock
related status bits.
• Power-Saving Modes (Sleep and Idle)
• Code Protection
Table 17-1 provides a summary of the dsPIC30F Oscil-
lator Operating modes. A simplified diagram of the
oscillator system is shown in Figure 17-1.
• Unit ID Locations
• In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP)
dsPIC30F devices have a Watchdog Timer which is
permanently enabled via the Configuration bits or can
be software controlled. It runs off its own RC oscillator
for added reliability. There are two timers that offer
necessary delays on power-up. One is the Oscillator
Start-up Timer (OST), intended to keep the chip in
Reset until the crystal oscillator is stable. The other is
the Power-up Timer (PWRT) which provides a delay on
power-up only, designed to keep the part in Reset while
the power supply stabilizes. With these two timers
on-chip, most applications need no external Reset
circuitry.
Sleep mode is designed to offer a very low current
Power-Down mode. The user can wake-up from Sleep
through external Reset, Watchdog Timer Wake-up, or
through an interrupt. Several oscillator options are also
made available to allow the part to fit a wide variety of
applications. In the Idle mode, the clock sources are
still active but the CPU is shut-off. The RC oscillator
option saves system cost while the LP crystal option
saves power.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 119
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 17-1: OSCILLATOR OPERATING MODES
Oscillator Mode
XTL
Description
200 kHz-4 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2.
4 MHz-10 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2.
XT
XT w/PLL 4x
XT w/PLL 8x
XT w/PLL 16x
LP
4 MHz-10 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2, 4x PLL enabled.
4 MHz-10 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2, 8x PLL enabled.
4 MHz-7.5 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2, 16x PLL enabled(1)
.
32 kHz crystal on SOSCO:SOSCI(2)
.
HS
10 MHz-25 MHz crystal.
HS/2 w/PLL 4x
HS/2 w/PLL 8x
HS/2 w/PLL 16x
HS/3 w/PLL 4x
HS/3 w/PLL 8x
HS/3 w/PLL 16x
EC
10 MHz -20 MHz crystal, divide by 2, 4x PLL enabled.
10 MHz-20 MHz crystal, divide by 2, 8x PLL enabled.
10 MHz-15 MHz crystal, divide by 2, 16x PLL enabled(1)
12 MHz-25 MHz crystal, divide by 3, 4x PLL enabled.
12 MHz-25 MHz crystal, divide by 3, 8x PLL enabled.
.
12 MHz-22.5 MHz crystal, divide by 3, 16x PLL enabled(1)
.
External clock input (0-40 MHz).
ECIO
External clock input (0-40 MHz), OSC2 pin is I/O.
EC w/PLL 4x
EC w/PLL 8x
EC w/PLL 16x
ERC
External clock input (4-10 MHz), OSC2 pin is I/O, 4x PLL enabled.
External clock input (4-10 MHz), OSC2 pin is I/O, 8x PLL enabled.
External clock input (4-7.5 MHz), OSC2 pin is I/O, 16x PLL enabled(1)
.
External RC oscillator, OSC2 pin is FOSC/4 output(3)
.
ERCIO
External RC oscillator, OSC2 pin is I/O(3)
7.37 MHz internal RC oscillator.
.
FRC
FRC w/PLL 4x
FRC w/PLL 8x
FRC w/PLL 16x
LPRC
7.37 MHz Internal RC oscillator, 4x PLL enabled.
7.37 MHz Internal RC oscillator, 8x PLL enabled.
7.37 MHz Internal RC oscillator, 16x PLL enabled.
512 kHz internal RC oscillator.
Note 1: dsPIC30F maximum operating frequency of 120 MHz must be met.
2: LP oscillator can be conveniently shared as system clock, as well as real-time clock for Timer1.
3: Requires external R and C. Frequency operation up to 4 MHz.
DS70139E-page 120
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 17-1:
OSCILLATOR SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM
Oscillator Configuration bits
PWRSAVInstruction
Wake-up Request
FPLL
OSC1
OSC2
Primary
PLL
Oscillator
x4, x8, x16
PLL
Lock
Primary Osc
COSC<2:0>
NOSC<2:0>
OSWEN
Internal FRC Osc
Primary
Oscillator
Internal Fast RC
Oscillator (FRC)
Stability Detector
Oscillator
Start-up
Timer
POR Done
Clock
Programmable
Switching
and Control
Block
Secondary Osc
Clock Divider
System
Clock
SOSCO
SOSCI
Secondary
Oscillator
Stability Detector
32 kHz LP
Oscillator
2
POST<1:0>
LPRC
Internal Low
Power RC
Oscillator (LPRC)
CF
Fail-Safe Clock
Monitor (FSCM)
FCKSM<1:0>
2
Oscillator Trap
To Timer1
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 121
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
17.2.2
OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER
(OST)
17.2 Oscillator Configurations
17.2.1
INITIAL CLOCK SOURCE
SELECTION
In order to ensure that a crystal oscillator (or ceramic
resonator) has started and stabilized, an Oscillator
Start-up Timer is included. It is a simple 10-bit counter
that counts 1024 TOSC cycles before releasing the
oscillator clock to the rest of the system. The time-out
period is designated as TOST.
While coming out of Power-on Reset or Brown-out
Reset, the device selects its clock source based on:
a) FOS<2:0> Configuration bits that select one of
four oscillator groups,
The TOST time is involved every time the oscillator has
to restart (i.e., on POR, BOR and wake-up from Sleep).
The Oscillator Start-up Timer is applied to the LP oscil-
lator, XT, XTL and HS modes (upon wake-up from
Sleep, POR and BOR) for the primary oscillator.
b) and FPR<4:0> Configuration bits that select one
of 15 oscillator choices within the primary group.
The selection is as shown in Table 17-2.
TABLE 17-2: CONFIGURATION BIT VALUES FOR CLOCK SELECTION
Oscillator
OSC2
Function
Oscillator Mode
FOS<2:0>
FPR<4:0>
Source
ECIO w/PLL 4x
PLL
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
X
X
X
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
X
X
X
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
X
X
X
I/O
I/O
ECIO wPLL 8x
ECIO w/ PLL 16x
FRC w/PLL 4X
FRC w/PLL 8x
FRC w/PLL 16x
XT wPLL 4x
XT w/PLL 8x
XT w/PLL 16x
HS2 w/PLL 4x
HS2 wPLL 8x
HS2 w/ PLL 16x
HS3 w/PLL 4x
HS3 w/PLL 8x
HS3 w/PLL 16x
ECIO
PLL
PLL
I/O
PLL
I/O
PLL
I/O
PLL
I/O
PLL
OSC2
OSC2
OSC2
OSC2
OSC2
OSC2
OSC2
OSC2
OSC2
I/O
PLL
PLL
PLL
PLL
PLL
PLL
PLL
PLL
External
External
External
External
External
External
External
Secondary
Internal FRC
Internal LPRC
XT
OSC2
OSC2
CLKO
CLKO
I/O
HS
EC
ERC
ERCIO
XTL
OSC2
(Note 1, 2)
(Note 1, 2)
(Note 1, 2)
LP
FRC
LPRC
Note 1: OSC2 pin function is determined by the Primary Oscillator mode selection (FPR<4:0>).
2: OSC1 pin cannot be used as an I/O pin even if the secondary oscillator or an internal clock source is
selected at all times.
DS70139E-page 122
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
17.2.3
LP OSCILLATOR CONTROL
Note:
When a 16x PLL is used, the FRC fre-
quency must not be tuned to a frequency
greater than 7.5 MHz.
Enabling the LP oscillator is controlled with two elements:
1. The current oscillator group bits COSC<2:0>.
2. The LPOSCEN bit (OSCCON register).
TABLE 17-4: FRC TUNING
TUN<3:0>
The LP oscillator is on (even during Sleep mode) if
LPOSCEN = 1. The LP oscillator is the device clock if:
FRC Frequency
Bits
• COSC<2:0> = 000(LP selected as main oscillator)
0111
0110
0101
0100
0011
0010
0001
0000
+ 10.5%
+ 9.0%
+ 7.5%
+ 6.0%
+ 4.5%
+ 3.0%
+ 1.5%
and
• LPOSCEN = 1
Keeping the LP oscillator on at all times allows for a fast
switch to the 32 kHz system clock for lower power oper-
ation. Returning to the faster main oscillator will still
require a start-up time
17.2.4
PHASE LOCKED LOOP (PLL)
Center Frequency (oscillator is
running at calibrated frequency)
The PLL multiplies the clock which is generated by the
primary oscillator or Fast RC oscillator. The PLL is
selectable to have either gains of x4, x8, and x16. Input
and output frequency ranges are summarized in
Table 17-3.
1111
1110
1101
1100
1011
1010
1001
1000
- 1.5%
- 3.0%
- 4.5%
- 6.0%
- 7.5%
- 9.0%
- 10.5%
- 12.0%
TABLE 17-3: PLL FREQUENCY RANGE
PLL
FIN
FOUT
Multiplier
4 MHz-10 MHz
4 MHz-10 MHz
4 MHz-7.5 MHz
x4
x8
16 MHz-40 MHz
32 MHz-80 MHz
64 MHz-120 MHz
17.2.6
LOW-POWER RC OSCILLATOR
(LPRC)
x16
The PLL features a lock output which is asserted when
the PLL enters a phase locked state. Should the loop
fall out of lock (e.g., due to noise), the lock signal will be
rescinded. The state of this signal is reflected in the
read-only LOCK bit in the OSCCON register.
The LPRC oscillator is a component of the Watchdog
Timer (WDT) and oscillates at a nominal frequency of
512 kHz. The LPRC oscillator is the clock source for
the Power-up Timer (PWRT) circuit, WDT and clock
monitor circuits. It may also be used to provide a low-
frequency clock source option for applications where
power consumption is critical and timing accuracy is
not required.
17.2.5
FAST RC OSCILLATOR (FRC)
The FRC oscillator is a fast (7.37 MHz ±2% nominal)
internal RC oscillator. This oscillator is intended to pro-
vide reasonable device operating speeds without the
use of an external crystal, ceramic resonator, or RC
network. The FRC oscillator can be used with the PLL
to obtain higher clock frequencies.
The LPRC oscillator is always enabled at a Power-on
Reset because it is the clock source for the PWRT.
After the PWRT expires, the LPRC oscillator will
remain on if one of the following is true:
• The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is enabled
• The WDT is enabled
The dsPIC30F operates from the FRC oscillator when-
ever the current oscillator selection control bits in the
OSCCON register (OSCCON<14:12>) are set to ‘001’.
• The LPRC oscillator is selected as the system
clock via the COSC<2:0> control bits in the
OSCCON register
The four bit field specified by TUN<3:0> (OSCTUN
<3:0>) allows the user to tune the internal fast RC
oscillator (nominal 7.37 MHz). The user can tune the
FRC oscillator within a range of +10.5% (840 kHz)
and -12% (960 kHz) in steps of 1.50% around the
factory-calibrated setting, see Table 17-4.
If one of the above conditions is not true, the LPRC will
shut-off after the PWRT expires.
Note 1: OSC2 pin function is determined by the
Primary Oscillator mode selection
(FPR<4:0>).
If OSCCON<14:12> are set to ‘111’ and FPR<4:0> are
set to ‘00001’, ‘01010’ or ‘00011’, then a PLL
multiplier of 4, 8 or 16 (respectively) is applied.
2: OSC1 pin cannot be used as an I/O pin
even if the secondary oscillator or an
internal clock source is selected at all
times.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 123
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
The OSCCON register holds the Control and Status
bits related to clock switching.
17.2.7
FAIL-SAFE CLOCK MONITOR
The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) allows the device
to continue to operate even in the event of an oscillator
failure. The FSCM function is enabled by appropriately
programming the FCKSM Configuration bits (clock
switch and monitor selection bits) in the FOSC Device
Configuration register. If the FSCM function is enabled,
the LPRC internal oscillator will run at all times (except
during Sleep mode) and will not be subject to control by
the SWDTEN bit.
• COSC<2:0>: Read-only bits always reflect the
current oscillator group in effect.
• NOSC<2:0>: Control bits which are written to
indicate the new oscillator group of choice.
- On POR and BOR, COSC<2:0> and
NOSC<2:0> are both loaded with the Config-
uration bit values FOS<2:0>.
• LOCK: The LOCK bit indicates a PLL lock.
In the event of an oscillator failure, the FSCM will gen-
erate a clock failure trap event and will switch the sys-
tem clock over to the FRC oscillator. The user will then
have the option to either attempt to restart the oscillator
or execute a controlled shutdown. The user may decide
to treat the trap as a warm Reset by simply loading the
Reset address into the oscillator fail trap vector. In this
event, the CF (Clock Fail) bit (OSCCON<3>) is also set
whenever a clock failure is recognized.
• CF: Read-only bit indicating if a clock fail detect
has occurred.
• OSWEN: Control bit changes from a ‘0’ to a ‘1’
when a clock transition sequence is initiated.
Clearing the OSWEN control bit will abort a clock
transition in progress (used for hang-up
situations).
If Configuration bits FCKSM<1:0> = 1x, then the clock
switching and Fail-Safe Clock monitoring functions are
disabled. This is the default Configuration bit setting.
In the event of a clock failure, the WDT is unaffected
and continues to run on the LPRC clock.
If clock switching is disabled, then the FOS<2:0> and
FPR<4:0> bits directly control the oscillator selection
and the COSC<2:0> bits do not control the clock selec-
tion. However, these bits will reflect the clock source
selection.
If the oscillator has a very slow start-up time coming out
of POR, BOR or Sleep, it is possible that the PWRT
timer will expire before the oscillator has started. In
such cases, the FSCM will be activated and the FSCM
will initiate a clock failure trap, and the COSC<2:0> bits
are loaded with FRC oscillator selection. This will effec-
tively shut-off the original oscillator that was trying to
start.
Note:
The application should not attempt to
switch to a clock of frequency lower than
100 kHz when the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor
is enabled. If such clock switching is
performed, the device may generate an
oscillator fail trap and switch to the Fast RC
oscillator.
The user may detect this situation and restart the
oscillator in the clock fail trap ISR.
Upon a clock failure detection, the FSCM module will
initiate a clock switch to the FRC oscillator as follows:
1. The COSC bits (OSCCON<14:12>) are loaded
with the FRC oscillator selection value.
17.2.8
PROTECTION AGAINST
ACCIDENTAL WRITES TO OSCCON
2. CF bit is set (OSCCON<3>).
A write to the OSCCON register is intentionally made
difficult because it controls clock switching and clock
scaling.
3. OSWEN control bit (OSCCON<0>) is cleared.
For the purpose of clock switching, the clock sources
are sectioned into four groups:
To write to the OSCCON low byte, the following code
sequence must be executed without any other
instructions in between:
1. Primary (with or without PLL)
2. Secondary
3. Internal FRC
Byte Write “0x46” to OSCCON low
Byte Write “0x57” to OSCCON low
4. Internal LPRC
The user can switch between these functional groups
but cannot switch between options within a group. If the
primary group is selected, then the choice within the
group is always determined by the FPR<4:0> Configu-
ration bits.
Byte write is allowed for one instruction cycle. Write the
desired value or use bit manipulation instruction.
To write to the OSCCON high byte, the following
instructions must be executed without any other
instructions in between:
Byte Write“0x78” to OSCCON high
Byte Write“0x9A” to OSCCON high
Byte write is allowed for one instruction cycle. Write the
desired value or use bit manipulation instruction.
DS70139E-page 124
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Different registers are affected in different ways by var-
ious Reset conditions. Most registers are not affected
17.3 Reset
The PIC18F1220/1320 differentiates between various
kinds of Reset:
by a WDT wake-up since this is viewed as the resump-
tion of normal operation. Status bits from the RCON
register are set or cleared differently in different Reset
situations, as indicated in Table 17-5. These bits are
used in software to determine the nature of the Reset.
a) Power-on Reset (POR)
b) MCLR Reset during normal operation
c) MCLR Reset during Sleep
A block diagram of the On-Chip Reset Circuit is shown
in Figure 17-2.
d) Watchdog Timer (WDT) Reset (during normal
operation)
A MCLR noise filter is provided in the MCLR Reset
path. The filter detects and ignores small pulses.
e) Programmable Brown-out Reset (BOR)
f) RESETInstruction
Internally generated Resets do not drive MCLR pin low.
g) Reset caused by trap lockup (TRAPR)
h) Reset caused by illegal opcode or by using an
uninitialized W register as an address pointer
(IOPUWR)
FIGURE 17-2:
RESET SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM
RESET
Instruction
Digital
Glitch Filter
MCLR
Sleep or Idle
WDT
Module
POR
VDD Rise
Detect
S
VDD
Brown-out
Reset
BOR
BOREN
Q
R
SYSRST
Trap Conflict
Illegal Opcode/
Uninitialized W Register
The POR circuit inserts a small delay, TPOR, which is
nominally 10 μs and ensures that the device bias cir-
cuits are stable. Furthermore, a user selected power-
up time-out (TPWRT) is applied. The TPWRT parameter
is based on device Configuration bits and can be 0 ms
(no delay), 4 ms, 16 ms or 64 ms. The total delay is at
device power-up, TPOR + TPWRT. When these delays
have expired, SYSRST will be negated on the next
leading edge of the Q1 clock and the PC will jump to the
Reset vector.
17.3.1
POR: POWER-ON RESET
A power-on event will generate an internal POR pulse
when a VDD rise is detected. The Reset pulse will occur
at the POR circuit threshold voltage (VPOR) which is
nominally 1.85V. The device supply voltage character-
istics must meet specified starting voltage and rise rate
requirements. The POR pulse will reset a POR timer
and place the device in the Reset state. The POR also
selects the device clock source identified by the
oscillator configuration fuses.
The timing for the SYSRST signal is shown in
Figure 17-3 through Figure 17-5.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 125
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 17-3:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR TIED TO VDD)
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
INTERNAL Reset
FIGURE 17-4:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 1
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
INTERNAL Reset
FIGURE 17-5:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 2
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
INTERNAL Reset
DS70139E-page 126
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
selected, the BOR will activate the Oscillator Start-up
Timer (OST). The system clock is held until OST
expires. If the PLL is used, then the clock will be held
until the LOCK bit (OSCCON<5>) is ‘1’.
17.3.1.1
POR with Long Crystal Start-up Time
(with FSCM Enabled)
The oscillator start-up circuitry is not linked to the POR
circuitry. Some crystal circuits (especially low fre-
quency crystals) will have a relatively long start-up
time. Therefore, one or more of the following conditions
is possible after the POR timer and the PWRT have
expired:
Concurrently, the POR time-out (TPOR) and the PWRT
time-out (TPWRT) will be applied before the internal Reset
is released. If TPWRT = 0and a crystal oscillator is being
used, then a nominal delay of TFSCM = 100 μs is applied.
The total delay in this case is (TPOR + TFSCM).
• The oscillator circuit has not begun to oscillate.
The BOR Status bit (RCON<1>) will be set to indicate
that a BOR has occurred. The BOR circuit, if enabled,
will continue to operate while in Sleep or Idle modes
and will reset the device should VDD fall below the BOR
threshold voltage.
• The Oscillator Start-up Timer has not expired (if a
crystal oscillator is used).
• The PLL has not achieved a LOCK (if PLL is
used).
If the FSCM is enabled and one of the above conditions
is true, then a clock failure trap will occur. The device
will automatically switch to the FRC oscillator and the
user can switch to the desired crystal oscillator in the
trap ISR.
FIGURE 17-6:
EXTERNAL POWER-ON
RESET CIRCUIT (FOR
SLOW VDD POWER-UP)
VDD
17.3.1.2
Operating without FSCM and PWRT
D
If the FSCM is disabled and the Power-up Timer
(PWRT) is also disabled, then the device will exit rap-
idly from Reset on power-up. If the clock source is
FRC, LPRC, ERC or EC, it will be active immediately.
R
R1
MCLR
dsPIC30F
C
If the FSCM is disabled and the system clock has not
started, the device will be in a frozen state at the Reset
vector until the system clock starts. From the user’s
perspective, the device will appear to be in Reset until
a system clock is available.
Note 1: External Power-on Reset circuit is required
only if the VDD power-up slope is too slow.
The diode D helps discharge the capacitor
quickly when VDD powers down.
2: R should be suitably chosen so as to make
sure that the voltage drop across R does not
violate the device’s electrical specifications.
3: R1 should be suitably chosen so as to limit
any current flowing into MCLR from external
capacitor C, in the event of MCLR/VPP pin
breakdown due to Electrostatic Discharge
(ESD) or Electrical Overstress (EOS).
17.3.2
BOR: PROGRAMMABLE
BROWN-OUT RESET
The BOR (Brown-out Reset) module is based on an
internal voltage reference circuit. The main purpose of
the BOR module is to generate a device Reset when a
brown-out condition occurs. Brown-out conditions are
generally caused by glitches on the AC mains (i.e.,
missing portions of the AC cycle waveform due to bad
power transmission lines, or voltage sags due to exces-
sive current draw when a large inductive load is turned
on).
Note:
Dedicated supervisory devices, such as
the MCP1XX and MCP8XX, may also be
used as an external Power-on Reset
circuit.
The BOR module allows selection of one of the
following voltage trip points (see Table 20-11):
• 2.6V-2.71V
• 4.1V-4.4V
• 4.58V-4.73V
Note:
The BOR voltage trip points indicated here
are nominal values provided for design
guidance only. Refer to the Electrical
Specifications in the specific device data
sheet for BOR voltage limit specifications.
A BOR will generate a Reset pulse which will reset the
device. The BOR will select the clock source based on
the device Configuration bit values (FOS<2:0> and
FPR<4:0>). Furthermore, if an Oscillator mode is
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 127
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Table 17-5 shows the Reset conditions for the RCON
register. Since the control bits within the RCON register
are R/W, the information in the table means that all the
bits are negated prior to the action specified in the
condition column.
TABLE 17-5: INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR RCON REGISTER: CASE 1
Program
Condition
TRAPR IOPUWR EXTR SWR WDTO IDLE SLEEP POR BOR
Counter
Power-on Reset
Brown-out Reset
0x000000
0x000000
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
MCLR Reset during normal 0x000000
operation
Software Reset during
normal operation
0x000000
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
MCLR Reset during Sleep
MCLR Reset during Idle
WDT Time-out Reset
WDT Wake-up
0x000000
0x000000
0x000000
PC + 2
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Interrupt Wake-up from
Sleep
PC + 2(1)
Clock Failure Trap
Trap Reset
0x000004
0x000000
0x000000
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Illegal Operation Trap
Legend: u= unchanged, x= unknown, - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an enabled interrupt, the PC is loaded with the corresponding interrupt vector.
Table 17-6 shows a second example of the bit
conditions for the RCON register. In this case, it is not
assumed the user has set/cleared specific bits prior to
action specified in the condition column.
TABLE 17-6: INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR RCON REGISTER: CASE 2
Program
Condition
TRAPR IOPUWR EXTR SWR WDTO IDLE SLEEP POR BOR
Counter
Power-on Reset
0x000000
0x000000
0x000000
0
u
u
0
u
u
0
u
1
0
u
0
0
u
0
0
u
0
0
u
0
1
0
u
1
1
u
Brown-out Reset
MCLR Reset during normal
operation
Software Reset during
normal operation
0x000000
u
u
0
1
0
0
0
u
u
MCLR Reset during Sleep
MCLR Reset during Idle
WDT Time-out Reset
WDT Wake-up
0x000000
0x000000
0x000000
PC + 2
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
1
1
0
u
u
u
u
0
u
u
0
0
1
1
u
0
1
0
u
u
1
0
0
1
1
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Interrupt Wake-up from
Sleep
PC + 2(1)
Clock Failure Trap
Trap Reset
0x000004
0x000000
0x000000
u
1
u
u
u
1
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Illegal Operation Reset
Legend: u= unchanged, x= unknown, - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an enabled interrupt, the PC is loaded with the corresponding interrupt vector.
DS70139E-page 128
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
17.4 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
17.6 Power-Saving Modes
There are two power-saving states that can be entered
through the execution of a special instruction, PWRSAV;
17.4.1 WATCHDOG TIMER OPERATION
The primary function of the Watchdog Timer (WDT) is
to reset the processor in the event of a software mal-
function. The WDT is a free-running timer which runs
off an on-chip RC oscillator, requiring no external com-
ponent. Therefore, the WDT timer will continue to oper-
ate even if the main processor clock (e.g., the crystal
oscillator) fails.
these are Sleep and Idle.
The format of the PWRSAVinstruction is as follows:
PWRSAV <parameter>, where ‘parameter’ defines
Idle or Sleep mode.
17.6.1
SLEEP MODE
In Sleep mode, the clock to the CPU and peripherals is
shut down. If an on-chip oscillator is being used, it is
shut down.
17.4.2
ENABLING AND DISABLING
THE WDT
The Watchdog Timer can be “Enabled” or “Disabled”
only through a Configuration bit (FWDTEN) in the
Configuration register, FWDT.
The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is not functional during
Sleep since there is no clock to monitor. However,
LPRC clock remains active if WDT is operational during
Sleep.
Setting FWDTEN = 1enables the Watchdog Timer. The
enabling is done when programming the device. By
default, after chip erase, FWDTEN bit = 1. Any device
programmer capable of programming dsPIC30F
devices allows programming of this and other Configu-
ration bits.
The brown-out protection circuit and the Low-Voltage
Detect circuit, if enabled, will remain functional during
Sleep.
The processor wakes up from Sleep if at least one of
the following conditions has occurred:
If enabled, the WDT will increment until it overflows or
“times out”. A WDT time-out will force a device Reset
(except during Sleep). To prevent a WDT time-out, the
user must clear the Watchdog Timer using a CLRWDT
instruction.
• any interrupt that is individually enabled and
meets the required priority level
• any Reset (POR, BOR and MCLR)
• WDT time-out
If a WDT times out during Sleep, the device will wake-
up. The WDTO bit in the RCON register will be cleared
to indicate a wake-up resulting from a WDT time-out.
On waking up from Sleep mode, the processor will
restart the same clock that was active prior to entry into
Sleep mode. When clock switching is enabled, bits
COSC<2:0> will determine the oscillator source that
will be used on wake-up. If clock switch is disabled,
then there is only one system clock.
Setting FWDTEN = 0 allows user software to enable/
disable the Watchdog Timer via the SWDTEN
(RCON<5>) control bit.
Note:
If a POR or BOR occurred, the selection of
the oscillator is based on the FOS<2:0>
and FPR<4:0> Configuration bits.
17.5 Low Voltage Detect
The Low Voltage Detect (LVD) module is used to detect
when the VDD of the device drops below a threshold
value, VLVD, which is determined by the LVDL<3:0>
bits (RCON<11:8>) and is thus user programmable.
The internal voltage reference circuitry requires a nom-
inal amount of time to stabilize, and the BGST bit
(RCON<13>) indicates when the voltage reference has
stabilized.
If the clock source is an oscillator, the clock to the
device will be held off until OST times out (indicating a
stable oscillator). If PLL is used, the system clock is
held off until LOCK = 1 (indicating that the PLL is
stable). In either case, TPOR, TLOCK and TPWRT delays
are applied.
If EC, FRC, LPRC or ERC oscillators are used, then a
delay of TPOR (~ 10 μs) is applied. This is the smallest
delay possible on wake-up from Sleep.
In some devices, the LVD threshold voltage may be
applied externally on the LVDIN pin.
Moreover, if LP oscillator was active during Sleep and
LP is the oscillator used on wake-up, then the start-up
delay will be equal to TPOR. PWRT delay and OST
timer delay are not applied. In order to have the small-
est possible start-up delay when waking up from Sleep,
one of these faster wake-up options should be selected
before entering Sleep.
The LVD module is enabled by setting the LVDEN bit
(RCON<12>).
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 129
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Any interrupt that is individually enabled (using the cor-
responding IE bit) and meets the prevailing priority level
will be able to wake-up the processor. The processor will
process the interrupt and branch to the ISR. The Sleep
Status bit in the RCON register is set upon wake-up.
Any interrupt that is individually enabled (using IE bit)
and meets the prevailing priority level will be able to
wake-up the processor. The processor will process the
interrupt and branch to the ISR. The Idle Status bit in
the RCON register is set upon wake-up.
Any Reset other than POR will set the Idle Status bit.
On a POR, the Idle bit is cleared.
Note:
In spite of various delays applied (TPOR,
TLOCK and TPWRT), the crystal oscillator
(and PLL) may not be active at the end of
the time-out (e.g., for low-frequency crys-
tals). In such cases, if FSCM is enabled,
then the device will detect this as a clock
failure and process the clock failure trap, the
FRC oscillator will be enabled and the user
will have to re-enable the crystal oscillator. If
FSCM is not enabled, then the device will
simply suspend execution of code until the
clock is stable and will remain in Sleep until
the oscillator clock has started.
If Watchdog Timer is enabled, then the processor will
wake-up from Idle mode upon WDT time-out. The Idle
and WDTO Status bits are both set.
Unlike wake-up from Sleep, there are no time delays
involved in wake-up from Idle.
17.7 Device Configuration Registers
The Configuration bits in each device Configuration
register specify some of the device modes and are
programmed by a device programmer, or by using the
In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™) feature of
the device. Each device Configuration register is a
24-bit register, but only the lower 16 bits of each regis-
ter are used to hold configuration data. There are four
device Configuration registers available to the user:
All Resets will wake-up the processor from Sleep
mode. Any Reset, other than POR, will set the Sleep
Status bit. In a POR, the Sleep bit is cleared.
If the Watchdog Timer is enabled, then the processor
will wake-up from Sleep mode upon WDT time-out. The
Sleep and WDTO Status bits are both set.
1. FOSC (0xF80000): Oscillator Configuration
Register
17.6.2
IDLE MODE
2. FWDT (0xF80002): Watchdog Timer
Configuration Register
In Idle mode, the clock to the CPU is shut down while
peripherals keep running. Unlike Sleep mode, the clock
source remains active.
3. FBORPOR (0xF80004): BOR and POR
Configuration Register
4. FGS (0xF8000A): General Code Segment
Configuration Register
Several peripherals have a control bit in each module
that allows them to operate during Idle.
The placement of the Configuration bits is automati-
cally handled when you select the device in your device
programmer. The desired state of the Configuration bits
may be specified in the source code (dependent on the
language tool used), or through the programming
interface. After the device has been programmed, the
application software may read the Configuration bit
values through the table read instructions. For addi-
tional information, please refer to the Programming
Specifications of the device.
LPRC Fail-Safe Clock remains active if clock failure
detect is enabled.
The processor wakes up from Idle if at least one of the
following conditions has occurred:
• any interrupt that is individually enabled (IE bit is
‘1’) and meets the required priority level
• any Reset (POR, BOR, MCLR)
• WDT time-out
Upon wake-up from Idle mode, the clock is re-applied
to the CPU and instruction execution begins immedi-
ately, starting with the instruction following the PWRSAV
instruction.
Note:
If the code protection Configuration fuse
bits (FGS<GCP> and FGS<GWRP>)
have been programmed, an erase of the
entire code-protected device is only
possible at voltages VDD ≥ 4.5V.
DS70139E-page 130
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
17.8 Peripheral Module Disable (PMD)
17.9 In-Circuit Debugger
Registers
When MPLAB® ICD2 is selected as a Debugger, the In-
Circuit Debugging functionality is enabled. This func-
tion allows simple debugging functions when used with
MPLAB IDE. When the device has this feature enabled,
some of the resources are not available for general
use. These resources include the first 80 bytes of Data
RAM and two I/O pins.
The Peripheral Module Disable (PMD) registers pro-
vide a method to disable a peripheral module by stop-
ping all clock sources supplied to that module. When a
peripheral is disabled via the appropriate PMD control
bit, the peripheral is in a minimum power consumption
state. The Control and Status registers associated with
the peripheral will also be disabled so writes to those
registers will have no effect and read values will be
invalid.
One of four pairs of Debug I/O pins may be selected by
the user using configuration options in MPLAB IDE.
These pin pairs are named EMUD/EMUC, EMUD1/
EMUC1, EMUD2/EMUC2 and EMUD3/EMUC3.
A peripheral module will only be enabled if both the
associated bit in the the PMD register is cleared and
the peripheral is supported by the specific dsPIC DSC
variant. If the peripheral is present in the device, it is
enabled in the PMD register by default.
In each case, the selected EMUD pin is the Emulation/
Debug Data line, and the EMUC pin is the Emulation/
Debug Clock line. These pins will interface to the
MPLAB ICD 2 module available from Microchip. The
selected pair of Debug I/O pins is used by MPLAB
ICD 2 to send commands and receive responses, as
well as to send and receive data. To use the In-Circuit
Debugger function of the device, the design must
implement ICSP connections to MCLR, VDD, VSS,
PGC, PGD and the selected EMUDx/EMUCx pin pair.
Note:
If a PMD bit is set, the corresponding mod-
ule is disabled after a delay of 1 instruction
cycle. Similarly, if a PMD bit is cleared, the
corresponding module is enabled after a
delay of 1 instruction cycle (assuming the
module Control registers are already
configured to enable module operation).
This gives rise to two possibilities:
1. If EMUD/EMUC is selected as the Debug I/O pin
pair, then only a 5-pin interface is required, as
the EMUD and EMUC pin functions are multi-
plexed with the PGD and PGC pin functions in
all dsPIC30F devices.
Note:
In the dsPIC30F2011, dsPIC30F3012 and
dsPIC30F2012 devices, the U2MD bit is
readable and writable and will be read as
‘1’ when set.
2. If EMUD1/EMUC1, EMUD2/EMUC2 or EMUD3/
EMUC3 is selected as the Debug I/O pin pair,
then a 7-pin interface is required, as the
EMUDx/EMUCx pin functions (x = 1, 2 or 3) are
not multiplexed with the PGD and PGC pin
functions.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 131
TABLE 17-7: SYSTEM INTEGRATION REGISTER MAP
SFR Name Addr. Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9
LVDL<3:0>
NOSC<2:0>
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
RCON
0740 TRAPR IOPUWR BGST LVDEN
EXTR
SWR
SWDTEN WDTO SLEEP
IDLE
—
BOR
POR
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
OSCCON
OSCTUN
PMD1
0742
0744
0770
0772
—
—
—
—
COSC<2:0>
—
—
—
POST<1:0>
LOCK
—
—
—
—
—
CF
TUN3
SPI1MD
—
LPOSCEN OSWEN
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TUN2
—
TUN1
—
TUN0
(Note 2)
T3MD T2MD T1MD
—
I2CMD U2MD(3)
U1MD
—
ADCMD
OC1MD
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
PMD2
—
—
—
IC2MD IC1MD
—
—
—
OC2MD
Note 1:
Reset state depends on type of Reset.
2:
3:
Reset state depends on Configuration bits.
Only available on dsPIC30F3013.
TABLE 17-8: DEVICE CONFIGURATION REGISTER MAP
File Name
Addr.
Bits 23-16
Bit 15
Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
FOSC
FWDT
FBORPOR
FGS
F80000
F80002
F80004
F8000A
—
—
—
—
FCKSM<1:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
FOS<2:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
FPR<4:0>
FWDTEN
—
—
—
—
—
Reserved(1)
—
—
FWPSA<1:0>
BORV<1:0>
FWPSB<3:0>
FPWRT<1:0>
Reserved(1) GCP GWRP
MCLREN
—
Reserved(1)
Reserved(1) BOREN
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Note:
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
Note 1: Always reads as ‘1’.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Most bit-oriented instructions (including simple rotate/
shift instructions) have two operands:
18.0 INSTRUCTION SET SUMMARY
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F
Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70030).
• The W register (with or without an address
modifier) or file register (specified by the value of
‘Ws’ or ‘f’)
• The bit in the W register or file register
(specified by a literal value or indirectly by the
contents of register ‘Wb’)
The literal instructions that involve data movement may
use some of the following operands:
The dsPIC30F instruction set adds many
enhancements to the previous PIC® MCU instruction
sets, while maintaining an easy migration from
MCU instruction sets.
PIC
• A literal value to be loaded into a W register or file
register (specified by the value of ‘k’)
• The W register or file register where the literal
value is to be loaded (specified by ‘Wb’ or ‘f’)
Most instructions are a single program memory word
(24 bits). Only three instructions require two program
memory locations.
However, literal instructions that involve arithmetic or
logical operations use some of the following operands:
Each single-word instruction is a 24-bit word divided
into an 8-bit opcode which specifies the instruction
type, and one or more operands which further specify
the operation of the instruction.
• The first source operand which is a register ‘Wb’
without any address modifier
• The second source operand which is a literal
value
The instruction set is highly orthogonal and is grouped
into five basic categories:
• The destination of the result (only if not the same
as the first source operand) which is typically a
register ‘Wd’ with or without an address modifier
• Word or byte-oriented operations
• Bit-oriented operations
• Literal operations
The MACclass of DSP instructions may use some of the
following operands:
• DSP operations
• The accumulator (A or B) to be used (required
operand)
• Control operations
Table 18-1 shows the general symbols used in
describing the instructions.
• The W registers to be used as the two operands
• The X and Y address space prefetch operations
• The X and Y address space prefetch destinations
• The accumulator write-back destination
The dsPIC30F instruction set summary in Table 18-2
lists all the instructions, along with the status flags
affected by each instruction.
The other DSP instructions do not involve any
multiplication, and may include:
Most word or byte-oriented W register instructions
(including barrel shift instructions) have three
operands:
• The accumulator to be used (required)
• The first source operand which is typically a
register ‘Wb’ without any address modifier
• The source or destination operand (designated as
Wso or Wdo, respectively) with or without an
address modifier
• The second source operand which is typically a
register ‘Ws’ with or without an address modifier
• The amount of shift specified by a W register ‘Wn’
or a literal value
• The destination of the result which is typically a
register ‘Wd’ with or without an address modifier
The control instructions may use some of the following
operands:
However, word or byte-oriented file register instructions
have two operands:
• A program memory address
• The file register specified by the value ‘f’
• The mode of the table read and table write
instructions
• The destination, which could either be the file
register ‘f’ or the W0 register, which is denoted as
‘WREG’
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 133
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
All instructions are a single word, except for certain
double-word instructions, which were made double-
word instructions so that all the required information is
available in these 48 bits. In the second word, the
8 MSbs are ‘0’s. If this second word is executed as an
instruction (by itself), it will execute as a NOP.
which are single-word instructions but take two or three
cycles. Certain instructions that involve skipping over
the subsequent instruction require either two or three
cycles if the skip is performed, depending on whether
the instruction being skipped is a single-word or two-
word instruction. Moreover, double-word moves
require two cycles. The double-word instructions
execute in two instruction cycles.
Most single-word instructions are executed in a single
instruction cycle, unless a conditional test is true or the
program counter is changed as a result of the instruc-
tion. In these cases, the execution takes two instruction
cycles with the additional instruction cycle(s) executed
as a NOP. Notable exceptions are the BRA (uncondi-
tional/computed branch), indirect CALL/GOTO, all table
reads and writes, and RETURN/RETFIE instructions,
Note:
For more details on the instruction set,
refer to the Programmer’s Reference
Manual.
TABLE 18-1: SYMBOLS USED IN OPCODE DESCRIPTIONS
Field
Description
#text
(text)
[text]
{ }
Means literal defined by “text”
Means “content of text”
Means “the location addressed by text”
Optional field or operation
Register bit field
<n:m>
.b
Byte mode selection
.d
Double-Word mode selection
Shadow register select
.S
.w
Word mode selection (default)
One of two accumulators {A, B}
Acc
AWB
bit4
Accumulator write-back destination address register ∈ {W13, [W13]+=2}
4-bit bit selection field (used in word addressed instructions) ∈ {0...15}
MCU Status bits: Carry, Digit Carry, Negative, Overflow, Sticky Zero
Absolute address, label or expression (resolved by the linker)
File register address ∈ {0x0000...0x1FFF}
C, DC, N, OV, Z
Expr
f
lit1
1-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0,1}
lit4
4-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...15}
lit5
5-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...31}
lit8
8-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...255}
lit10
10-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...255} for Byte mode, {0:1023} for Word mode
14-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...16384}
lit14
lit16
16-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...65535}
lit23
23-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...8388608}; LSB must be 0
Field does not require an entry, may be blank
DSP Status bits: ACCA Overflow, ACCB Overflow, ACCA Saturate, ACCB Saturate
Program Counter
None
OA, OB, SA, SB
PC
Slit10
Slit16
Slit6
10-bit signed literal ∈ {-512...511}
16-bit signed literal ∈ {-32768...32767}
6-bit signed literal ∈ {-16...16}
DS70139E-page 134
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 18-1: SYMBOLS USED IN OPCODE DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Field
Description
Wb
Base W register ∈ {W0..W15}
Wd
Destination W register ∈ { Wd, [Wd], [Wd++], [Wd--], [++Wd], [--Wd] }
Wdo
Destination W register ∈
{ Wnd, [Wnd], [Wnd++], [Wnd--], [++Wnd], [--Wnd], [Wnd+Wb] }
Wm,Wn
Dividend, Divisor working register pair (direct addressing)
Wm*Wm
Multiplicand and Multiplier working register pair for Square instructions ∈
{W4*W4,W5*W5,W6*W6,W7*W7}
Wm*Wn
Multiplicand and Multiplier working register pair for DSP instructions ∈
{W4*W5,W4*W6,W4*W7,W5*W6,W5*W7,W6*W7}
Wn
One of 16 working registers ∈ {W0..W15}
Wnd
Wns
WREG
Ws
One of 16 destination working registers ∈ {W0..W15}
One of 16 source working registers ∈ {W0..W15}
W0 (working register used in file register instructions)
Source W register ∈ { Ws, [Ws], [Ws++], [Ws--], [++Ws], [--Ws] }
Wso
Source W register ∈
{ Wns, [Wns], [Wns++], [Wns--], [++Wns], [--Wns], [Wns+Wb] }
Wx
X data space prefetch address register for DSP instructions
∈ {[W8]+=6, [W8]+=4, [W8]+=2, [W8], [W8]-=6, [W8]-=4, [W8]-=2,
[W9]+=6, [W9]+=4, [W9]+=2, [W9], [W9]-=6, [W9]-=4, [W9]-=2,
[W9+W12],none}
Wxd
Wy
X data space prefetch destination register for DSP instructions ∈ {W4..W7}
Y data space prefetch address register for DSP instructions
∈ {[W10]+=6, [W10]+=4, [W10]+=2, [W10], [W10]-=6, [W10]-=4, [W10]-=2,
[W11]+=6, [W11]+=4, [W11]+=2, [W11], [W11]-=6, [W11]-=4, [W11]-=2,
[W11+W12], none}
Wyd
Y data space prefetch destination register for DSP instructions ∈ {W4..W7}
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 135
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 18-2: INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW
Base
Instr
#
Assembly
Mnemonic
# of
# of
Status Flags
Affected
Assembly Syntax
Description
Words Cycles
1
ADD
ADD
ADD
ADD
ADD
ADD
ADD
ADD
ADDC
ADDC
ADDC
ADDC
ADDC
AND
AND
AND
AND
AND
ASR
ASR
ASR
ASR
ASR
BCLR
BCLR
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BRA
BSET
BSET
BSW.C
BSW.Z
Acc
Add Accumulators
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
OA,OB,SA,SB
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
OA,OB,SA,SB
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
N,Z
f
f = f + WREG
f,WREG
WREG = f + WREG
1
#lit10,Wn
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wso,#Slit4,Acc
f
Wd = lit10 + Wd
1
Wd = Wb + Ws
1
Wd = Wb + lit5
1
16-bit Signed Add to Accumulator
f = f + WREG + (C)
1
2
3
4
ADDC
1
f,WREG
WREG = f + WREG + (C)
Wd = lit10 + Wd + (C)
Wd = Wb + Ws + (C)
1
#lit10,Wn
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wb,#lit5,Wd
f
1
1
Wd = Wb + lit5 + (C)
1
AND
f = f .AND. WREG
1
f,WREG
WREG = f .AND. WREG
Wd = lit10 .AND. Wd
1
N,Z
#lit10,Wn
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wb,#lit5,Wd
f
1
N,Z
Wd = Wb .AND. Ws
1
N,Z
Wd = Wb .AND. lit5
1
N,Z
ASR
f = Arithmetic Right Shift f
WREG = Arithmetic Right Shift f
Wd = Arithmetic Right Shift Ws
Wnd = Arithmetic Right Shift Wb by Wns
Wnd = Arithmetic Right Shift Wb by lit5
Bit Clear f
1
C,N,OV,Z
C,N,OV,Z
C,N,OV,Z
N,Z
f,WREG
1
Ws,Wd
1
Wb,Wns,Wnd
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
f,#bit4
Ws,#bit4
C,Expr
1
1
N,Z
5
6
BCLR
BRA
1
None
Bit Clear Ws
1
None
Branch if Carry
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
2
None
GE,Expr
GEU,Expr
GT,Expr
GTU,Expr
LE,Expr
LEU,Expr
LT,Expr
LTU,Expr
N,Expr
Branch if greater than or equal
Branch if unsigned greater than or equal
Branch if greater than
Branch if unsigned greater than
Branch if less than or equal
Branch if unsigned less than or equal
Branch if less than
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
Branch if unsigned less than
Branch if Negative
None
None
NC,Expr
NN,Expr
NOV,Expr
NZ,Expr
OA,Expr
OB,Expr
OV,Expr
SA,Expr
SB,Expr
Expr
Branch if Not Carry
None
Branch if Not Negative
Branch if Not Overflow
Branch if Not Zero
None
None
None
Branch if Accumulator A overflow
Branch if Accumulator B overflow
Branch if Overflow
None
None
None
Branch if Accumulator A saturated
Branch if Accumulator B saturated
Branch Unconditionally
Branch if Zero
None
None
None
Z,Expr
1 (2)
2
None
Wn
Computed Branch
None
7
8
BSET
BSW
f,#bit4
Ws,#bit4
Ws,Wb
Bit Set f
1
None
Bit Set Ws
1
None
Write C bit to Ws<Wb>
Write Z bit to Ws<Wb>
1
None
Ws,Wb
1
None
DS70139E-page 136
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 18-2: INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED)
Base
Instr
#
Assembly
Mnemonic
# of
# of
Status Flags
Affected
Assembly Syntax
Description
Words Cycles
9
BTG
BTG
f,#bit4
Ws,#bit4
f,#bit4
Bit Toggle f
1
1
1
1
1
None
None
None
BTG
Bit Toggle Ws
10
11
12
BTSC
BTSC
Bit Test f, Skip if Clear
Bit Test Ws, Skip if Clear
Bit Test f, Skip if Set
1
(2 or 3)
BTSC
BTSS
BTSS
Ws,#bit4
f,#bit4
Ws,#bit4
1
1
1
1
None
None
None
(2 or 3)
BTSS
BTST
1
(2 or 3)
Bit Test Ws, Skip if Set
1
(2 or 3)
BTST
f,#bit4
Ws,#bit4
Ws,#bit4
Ws,Wb
Bit Test f
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Z
BTST.C
BTST.Z
BTST.C
BTST.Z
BTSTS
Bit Test Ws to C
C
Bit Test Ws to Z
Z
C
Bit Test Ws<Wb> to C
Bit Test Ws<Wb> to Z
Bit Test then Set f
Ws,Wb
Z
13
BTSTS
f,#bit4
Z
BTSTS.C Ws,#bit4
BTSTS.Z Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws to C, then Set
Bit Test Ws to Z, then Set
Call subroutine
C
Z
14
15
CALL
CLR
CALL
CALL
CLR
CLR
CLR
CLR
CLRWDT
COM
COM
COM
CP
lit23
None
Wn
Call indirect subroutine
f = 0x0000
None
f
None
WREG
WREG = 0x0000
None
Ws
Ws = 0x0000
None
Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd,AWB
Clear Accumulator
Clear Watchdog Timer
f = f
OA,OB,SA,SB
WDTO,Sleep
N,Z
16
17
CLRWDT
COM
f
f,WREG
Ws,Wd
f
WREG = f
N,Z
Wd = Ws
N,Z
18
CP
Compare f with WREG
Compare Wb with lit5
Compare Wb with Ws (Wb - Ws)
Compare f with 0x0000
Compare Ws with 0x0000
Compare f with WREG, with Borrow
Compare Wb with lit5, with Borrow
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
CP
Wb,#lit5
Wb,Ws
f
CP
19
20
CP0
CPB
CP0
CP0
CPB
CPB
CPB
Ws
f
Wb,#lit5
Wb,Ws
Compare Wb with Ws, with Borrow
(Wb - Ws - C)
21
22
23
24
CPSEQ
CPSGT
CPSLT
CPSNE
CPSEQ
CPSGT
CPSLT
CPSNE
Wb, Wn
Wb, Wn
Wb, Wn
Wb, Wn
Compare Wb with Wn, skip if =
Compare Wb with Wn, skip if >
Compare Wb with Wn, skip if <
Compare Wb with Wn, skip if ≠
1
1
1
1
1
None
None
None
None
(2 or 3)
1
(2 or 3)
1
(2 or 3)
1
(2 or 3)
25
26
DAW
DEC
DAW
Wn
Wn = decimal adjust Wn
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
C
DEC
f
f = f -1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
None
DEC
f,WREG
Ws,Wd
f
WREG = f -1
DEC
Wd = Ws - 1
27
28
DEC2
DISI
DEC2
DEC2
DEC2
DISI
f = f -2
f,WREG
Ws,Wd
#lit14
WREG = f -2
Wd = Ws - 2
Disable Interrupts for k instruction cycles
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 137
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 18-2: INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED)
Base
Instr
#
Assembly
Mnemonic
# of
# of
Status Flags
Affected
Assembly Syntax
Description
Words Cycles
29
DIV
DIV.S
DIV.SD
DIV.U
DIV.UD
DIVF
DO
Wm,Wn
Signed 16/16-bit Integer Divide
Signed 32/16-bit Integer Divide
Unsigned 16/16-bit Integer Divide
Unsigned 32/16-bit Integer Divide
Signed 16/16-bit Fractional Divide
Do code to PC+Expr, lit14+1 times
Do code to PC+Expr, (Wn)+1 times
Euclidean Distance (no accumulate)
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
18
18
18
18
18
2
N,Z,C,OV
N,Z,C,OV
N,Z,C,OV
N,Z,C,OV
N,Z,C,OV
None
Wm,Wn
Wm,Wn
Wm,Wn
30
31
DIVF
DO
Wm,Wn
#lit14,Expr
Wn,Expr
DO
2
None
32
33
ED
ED
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wy,Wxd
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
EDAC
EDAC
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wy,Wxd
Euclidean Distance
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
34
35
36
37
38
EXCH
FBCL
FF1L
EXCH
FBCL
FF1L
FF1R
GOTO
GOTO
INC
Wns,Wnd
Ws,Wnd
Ws,Wnd
Ws,Wnd
Expr
Swap Wns with Wnd
Find Bit Change from Left (MSb) Side
Find First One from Left (MSb) Side
Find First One from Right (LSb) Side
Go to address
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
None
C
C
FF1R
GOTO
C
None
Wn
Go to indirect
None
39
40
41
INC
f
f = f + 1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
N,Z
INC
f,WREG
Ws,Wd
WREG = f + 1
INC
Wd = Ws + 1
INC2
IOR
INC2
INC2
INC2
IOR
f
f = f + 2
f,WREG
Ws,Wd
WREG = f + 2
Wd = Ws + 2
f
f = f .IOR. WREG
IOR
f,WREG
#lit10,Wn
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wso,#Slit4,Acc
WREG = f .IOR. WREG
Wd = lit10 .IOR. Wd
Wd = Wb .IOR. Ws
Wd = Wb .IOR. lit5
Load Accumulator
N,Z
IOR
N,Z
IOR
N,Z
IOR
N,Z
42
LAC
LAC
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
43
44
LNK
LSR
LNK
LSR
LSR
LSR
LSR
LSR
MAC
#lit14
Link frame pointer
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
None
C,N,OV,Z
C,N,OV,Z
C,N,OV,Z
N,Z
f
f = Logical Right Shift f
f,WREG
WREG = Logical Right Shift f
Wd = Logical Right Shift Ws
Wnd = Logical Right Shift Wb by Wns
Wnd = Logical Right Shift Wb by lit5
Ws,Wd
Wb,Wns,Wnd
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
N,Z
45
46
MAC
MOV
Wm*Wn,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd Multiply and Accumulate
,
AWB
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
MAC
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd Square and Accumulate
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
MOV
f,Wn
Move f to Wn
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
None
N,Z
MOV
f
Move f to f
MOV
f,WREG
Move f to WREG
N,Z
MOV
#lit16,Wn
#lit8,Wn
Wn,f
Move 16-bit literal to Wn
Move 8-bit literal to Wn
Move Wn to f
None
None
None
None
N,Z
MOV.b
MOV
MOV
Wso,Wdo
Move Ws to Wd
MOV
WREG,f
Move WREG to f
MOV.D
MOV.D
MOVSAC
Wns,Wd
Move Double from W(ns):W(ns+1) to Wd
Move Double from Ws to W(nd+1):W(nd)
Prefetch and store accumulator
None
None
None
Ws,Wnd
47
MOVSAC
Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd,AWB
DS70139E-page 138
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 18-2: INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED)
Base
Instr
#
Assembly
Mnemonic
# of
# of
Status Flags
Affected
Assembly Syntax
Description
Words Cycles
48
MPY
MPY
Multiply Wm by Wn to Accumulator
Square Wm to Accumulator
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
Wm*Wn,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
MPY
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
49
50
MPY.N
MSC
MPY.N
-(Multiply Wm by Wn) to Accumulator
None
Wm*Wn,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
MSC
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd Multiply and Subtract from Accumulator
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
,
AWB
51
MUL
MUL.SS
MUL.SU
MUL.US
MUL.UU
Wb,Ws,Wnd
Wb,Ws,Wnd
Wb,Ws,Wnd
Wb,Ws,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = signed(Wb) * signed(Ws)
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = signed(Wb) * unsigned(Ws)
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = unsigned(Wb) * signed(Ws)
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
None
None
None
None
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = unsigned(Wb) *
unsigned(Ws)
MUL.SU
MUL.UU
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = signed(Wb) * unsigned(lit5)
1
1
1
1
None
None
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = unsigned(Wb) *
unsigned(lit5)
MUL
NEG
f
W3:W2 = f * WREG
Negate Accumulator
1
1
1
1
None
52
NEG
Acc
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
NEG
f
f = f + 1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
None
NEG
f,WREG
Ws,Wd
WREG = f + 1
NEG
Wd = Ws + 1
53
54
NOP
POP
NOP
No Operation
NOPR
POP
No Operation
None
f
Pop f from top-of-stack (TOS)
Pop from top-of-stack (TOS) to Wdo
None
POP
Wdo
Wnd
None
POP.D
Pop from top-of-stack (TOS) to
W(nd):W(nd+1)
None
POP.S
PUSH
Pop Shadow Registers
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
All
None
None
None
None
WDTO,Sleep
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
C,N,Z
C,N,Z
C,N,Z
N,Z
55
PUSH
f
Push f to top-of-stack (TOS)
Push Wso to top-of-stack (TOS)
Push W(ns):W(ns+1) to top-of-stack (TOS)
Push Shadow Registers
1
PUSH
Wso
Wns
1
PUSH.D
PUSH.S
PWRSAV
RCALL
RCALL
REPEAT
REPEAT
RESET
RETFIE
RETLW
RETURN
RLC
2
1
56
57
PWRSAV
RCALL
#lit1
Expr
Go into Sleep or Idle mode
Relative Call
1
2
Wn
Computed Call
2
58
REPEAT
#lit14
Wn
Repeat Next Instruction lit14+1 times
Repeat Next Instruction (Wn)+1 times
Software device Reset
1
1
59
60
61
62
63
RESET
RETFIE
RETLW
RETURN
RLC
1
Return from interrupt
3 (2)
#lit10,Wn
Return with literal in Wn
3 (2)
Return from Subroutine
3 (2)
1
f
f = Rotate Left through Carry f
WREG = Rotate Left through Carry f
Wd = Rotate Left through Carry Ws
f = Rotate Left (No Carry) f
WREG = Rotate Left (No Carry) f
Wd = Rotate Left (No Carry) Ws
f = Rotate Right through Carry f
WREG = Rotate Right through Carry f
Wd = Rotate Right through Carry Ws
RLC
f,WREG
Ws,Wd
f
1
RLC
1
64
65
RLNC
RRC
RLNC
1
RLNC
f,WREG
Ws,Wd
f
1
N,Z
RLNC
1
N,Z
RRC
1
C,N,Z
C,N,Z
C,N,Z
RRC
f,WREG
Ws,Wd
1
RRC
1
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 139
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 18-2: INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED)
Base
Instr
#
Assembly
Mnemonic
# of
# of
Status Flags
Affected
Assembly Syntax
Description
Words Cycles
66
RRNC
RRNC
RRNC
RRNC
SAC
f
f = Rotate Right (No Carry) f
WREG = Rotate Right (No Carry) f
Wd = Rotate Right (No Carry) Ws
Store Accumulator
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
N,Z
N,Z
f,WREG
Ws,Wd
N,Z
67
SAC
Acc,#Slit4,Wdo
None
None
C,N,Z
None
None
None
SAC.R
SE
Acc,#Slit4,Wdo
Store Rounded Accumulator
Wnd = sign-extended Ws
f = 0xFFFF
68
69
SE
Ws,Wnd
f
SETM
SETM
SETM
SETM
SFTAC
WREG
Ws
WREG = 0xFFFF
Ws = 0xFFFF
70
71
SFTAC
SL
Acc,Wn
Arithmetic Shift Accumulator by (Wn)
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
SFTAC
Acc,#Slit6
Arithmetic Shift Accumulator by Slit6
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
SL
SL
SL
SL
SL
SUB
f
f = Left Shift f
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
C,N,OV,Z
C,N,OV,Z
N,Z
f,WREG
Ws,Wd
WREG = Left Shift f
Wd = Left Shift Ws
Wb,Wns,Wnd
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
Acc
Wnd = Left Shift Wb by Wns
Wnd = Left Shift Wb by lit5
Subtract Accumulators
N,Z
72
SUB
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
SUB
f
f = f - WREG
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
None
SUB
f,WREG
#lit10,Wn
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wb,#lit5,Wd
f
WREG = f - WREG
Wn = Wn - lit10
SUB
SUB
Wd = Wb - Ws
SUB
Wd = Wb - lit5
73
SUBB
SUBB
SUBB
SUBB
SUBB
SUBB
SUBR
SUBR
SUBR
SUBR
SUBBR
SUBBR
SUBBR
SUBBR
SWAP.b
SWAP
TBLRDH
TBLRDL
TBLWTH
TBLWTL
ULNK
XOR
f = f - WREG - (C)
f,WREG
#lit10,Wn
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wb,#lit5,Wd
f
WREG = f - WREG - (C)
Wn = Wn - lit10 - (C)
Wd = Wb - Ws - (C)
Wd = Wb - lit5 - (C)
f = WREG - f
74
75
76
SUBR
SUBBR
SWAP
f,WREG
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wb,#lit5,Wd
f
WREG = WREG - f
Wd = Ws - Wb
Wd = lit5 - Wb
f = WREG - f - (C)
f,WREG
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wn
WREG = WREG -f - (C)
Wd = Ws - Wb - (C)
Wd = lit5 - Wb - (C)
Wn = nibble swap Wn
Wn = byte swap Wn
Read Prog<23:16> to Wd<7:0>
Read Prog<15:0> to Wd
Write Ws<7:0> to Prog<23:16>
Write Ws to Prog<15:0>
Unlink frame pointer
f = f .XOR. WREG
WREG = f .XOR. WREG
Wd = lit10 .XOR. Wd
Wd = Wb .XOR. Ws
Wd = Wb .XOR. lit5
Wnd = Zero-extend Ws
Wn
None
77
78
79
80
81
82
TBLRDH
TBLRDL
TBLWTH
TBLWTL
ULNK
Ws,Wd
None
Ws,Wd
None
Ws,Wd
None
Ws,Wd
None
None
XOR
f
N,Z
XOR
f,WREG
N,Z
XOR
#lit10,Wn
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Ws,Wnd
N,Z
XOR
N,Z
XOR
N,Z
83
ZE
ZE
C,Z,N
DS70139E-page 140
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
19.1 MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment Software
19.0 DEVELOPMENT SUPPORT
The PIC® microcontrollers are supported with a full
range of hardware and software development tools:
The MPLAB IDE software brings an ease of software
development previously unseen in the 8/16-bit micro-
controller market. The MPLAB IDE is a Windows®
operating system-based application that contains:
• Integrated Development Environment
- MPLAB® IDE Software
• Assemblers/Compilers/Linkers
- MPASMTM Assembler
• A single graphical interface to all debugging tools
- Simulator
- MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 C Compilers
- MPLINKTM Object Linker/
MPLIBTM Object Librarian
- Programmer (sold separately)
- Emulator (sold separately)
- In-Circuit Debugger (sold separately)
• A full-featured editor with color-coded context
• A multiple project manager
- MPLAB ASM30 Assembler/Linker/Library
• Simulators
- MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
• Emulators
• Customizable data windows with direct edit of
contents
- MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator
- MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator
• In-Circuit Debugger
• High-level source code debugging
• Visual device initializer for easy register
initialization
- MPLAB ICD 2
• Mouse over variable inspection
• Device Programmers
• Drag and drop variables from source to watch
windows
- PICSTART® Plus Development Programmer
- MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
- PICkit™ 2 Development Programmer
• Extensive on-line help
• Integration of select third party tools, such as
HI-TECH Software C Compilers and IAR
C Compilers
• Low-Cost Demonstration and Development
Boards and Evaluation Kits
The MPLAB IDE allows you to:
• Edit your source files (either assembly or C)
• One touch assemble (or compile) and download
to PIC MCU emulator and simulator tools
(automatically updates all project information)
• Debug using:
- Source files (assembly or C)
- Mixed assembly and C
- Machine code
MPLAB IDE supports multiple debugging tools in a
single development paradigm, from the cost-effective
simulators, through low-cost in-circuit debuggers, to
full-featured emulators. This eliminates the learning
curve when upgrading to tools with increased flexibility
and power.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 141
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
19.2 MPASM Assembler
19.5 MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker
and Librarian
The MPASM Assembler is a full-featured, universal
macro assembler for all PIC MCUs.
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler produces relocatable
machine code from symbolic assembly language for
dsPIC30F devices. MPLAB C30 C Compiler uses the
assembler to produce its object file. The assembler
generates relocatable object files that can then be
archived or linked with other relocatable object files and
archives to create an executable file. Notable features
of the assembler include:
The MPASM Assembler generates relocatable object
files for the MPLINK Object Linker, Intel® standard HEX
files, MAP files to detail memory usage and symbol
reference, absolute LST files that contain source lines
and generated machine code and COFF files for
debugging.
The MPASM Assembler features include:
• Integration into MPLAB IDE projects
• Support for the entire dsPIC30F instruction set
• Support for fixed-point and floating-point data
• Command line interface
• User-defined macros to streamline
assembly code
• Rich directive set
• Conditional assembly for multi-purpose
source files
• Flexible macro language
• MPLAB IDE compatibility
• Directives that allow complete control over the
assembly process
19.6 MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
19.3 MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30
C Compilers
The MPLAB SIM Software Simulator allows code
development in a PC-hosted environment by simulat-
ing the PIC MCUs and dsPIC® DSCs on an instruction
level. On any given instruction, the data areas can be
examined or modified and stimuli can be applied from
a comprehensive stimulus controller. Registers can be
logged to files for further run-time analysis. The trace
buffer and logic analyzer display extend the power of
the simulator to record and track program execution,
actions on I/O, most peripherals and internal registers.
The MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 Code Development
Systems are complete ANSI
C
compilers for
Microchip’s PIC18 family of microcontrollers and the
dsPIC30, dsPIC33 and PIC24 family of digital signal
controllers. These compilers provide powerful integra-
tion capabilities, superior code optimization and ease
of use not found with other compilers.
For easy source level debugging, the compilers provide
symbol information that is optimized to the MPLAB IDE
debugger.
The MPLAB SIM Software Simulator fully supports
symbolic debugging using the MPLAB C18 and
MPLAB C30 C Compilers, and the MPASM and
MPLAB ASM30 Assemblers. The software simulator
offers the flexibility to develop and debug code outside
of the hardware laboratory environment, making it an
excellent, economical software development tool.
19.4 MPLINK Object Linker/
MPLIB Object Librarian
The MPLINK Object Linker combines relocatable
objects created by the MPASM Assembler and the
MPLAB C18 C Compiler. It can link relocatable objects
from precompiled libraries, using directives from a
linker script.
The MPLIB Object Librarian manages the creation and
modification of library files of precompiled code. When
a routine from a library is called from a source file, only
the modules that contain that routine will be linked in
with the application. This allows large libraries to be
used efficiently in many different applications.
The object linker/library features include:
• Efficient linking of single libraries instead of many
smaller files
• Enhanced code maintainability by grouping
related modules together
• Flexible creation of libraries with easy module
listing, replacement, deletion and extraction
DS70139E-page 142
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
19.7 MPLAB ICE 2000
High-Performance
19.9 MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger
Microchip’s In-Circuit Debugger, MPLAB ICD 2, is a
powerful, low-cost, run-time development tool,
connecting to the host PC via an RS-232 or high-speed
In-Circuit Emulator
The MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator is intended
to provide the product development engineer with a
complete microcontroller design tool set for PIC micro-
controllers. Software control of the MPLAB ICE 2000
In-Circuit Emulator is advanced by the MPLAB Inte-
grated Development Environment, which allows edit-
ing, building, downloading and source debugging from
a single environment.
USB interface. This tool is based on the Flash PIC
MCUs and can be used to develop for these and other
PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs. The MPLAB ICD 2 utilizes
the in-circuit debugging capability built into the Flash
devices. This feature, along with Microchip’s In-Circuit
Serial ProgrammingTM (ICSPTM) protocol, offers cost-
effective, in-circuit Flash debugging from the graphical
user interface of the MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment. This enables a designer to develop and
debug source code by setting breakpoints, single step-
ping and watching variables, and CPU status and
peripheral registers. Running at full speed enables
testing hardware and applications in real time. MPLAB
ICD 2 also serves as a development programmer for
selected PIC devices.
The MPLAB ICE 2000 is a full-featured emulator
system with enhanced trace, trigger and data monitor-
ing features. Interchangeable processor modules allow
the system to be easily reconfigured for emulation of
different processors. The architecture of the MPLAB
ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator allows expansion to
support new PIC microcontrollers.
The MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator system has
been designed as a real-time emulation system with
advanced features that are typically found on more
expensive development tools. The PC platform and
Microsoft® Windows® 32-bit operating system were
chosen to best make these features available in a
simple, unified application.
19.10 MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
The MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer is a universal,
CE compliant device programmer with programmable
voltage verification at VDDMIN and VDDMAX for
maximum reliability. It features a large LCD display
(128 x 64) for menus and error messages and a modu-
lar, detachable socket assembly to support various
package types. The ICSP™ cable assembly is included
as a standard item. In Stand-Alone mode, the MPLAB
PM3 Device Programmer can read, verify and program
PIC devices without a PC connection. It can also set
code protection in this mode. The MPLAB PM3
connects to the host PC via an RS-232 or USB cable.
The MPLAB PM3 has high-speed communications and
optimized algorithms for quick programming of large
memory devices and incorporates an SD/MMC card for
file storage and secure data applications.
19.8 MPLAB ICE 4000
High-Performance
In-Circuit Emulator
The MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator is intended to
provide the product development engineer with a
complete microcontroller design tool set for high-end
PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs. Software control of the
MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator is provided by the
MPLAB Integrated Development Environment, which
allows editing, building, downloading and source
debugging from a single environment.
The MPLAB ICE 4000 is a premium emulator system,
providing the features of MPLAB ICE 2000, but with
increased emulation memory and high-speed perfor-
mance for dsPIC30F and PIC18XXXX devices. Its
advanced emulator features include complex triggering
and timing, and up to 2 Mb of emulation memory.
The MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator system has
been designed as a real-time emulation system with
advanced features that are typically found on more
expensive development tools. The PC platform and
Microsoft Windows 32-bit operating system were
chosen to best make these features available in a
simple, unified application.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 143
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
19.11 PICSTART Plus Development
Programmer
19.13 Demonstration, Development and
Evaluation Boards
The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer is an
easy-to-use, low-cost, prototype programmer. It
connects to the PC via a COM (RS-232) port. MPLAB
Integrated Development Environment software makes
using the programmer simple and efficient. The
PICSTART Plus Development Programmer supports
most PIC devices in DIP packages up to 40 pins.
Larger pin count devices, such as the PIC16C92X and
PIC17C76X, may be supported with an adapter socket.
The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer is CE
compliant.
A wide variety of demonstration, development and
evaluation boards for various PIC MCUs and dsPIC
DSCs allows quick application development on fully func-
tional systems. Most boards include prototyping areas for
adding custom circuitry and provide application firmware
and source code for examination and modification.
The boards support a variety of features, including LEDs,
temperature sensors, switches, speakers, RS-232
interfaces, LCD displays, potentiometers and additional
EEPROM memory.
The demonstration and development boards can be
used in teaching environments, for prototyping custom
circuits and for learning about various microcontroller
applications.
19.12 PICkit 2 Development Programmer
The PICkit™ 2 Development Programmer is a low-cost
programmer with an easy-to-use interface for pro-
gramming many of Microchip’s baseline, mid-range
and PIC18F families of Flash memory microcontrollers.
The PICkit 2 Starter Kit includes a prototyping develop-
ment board, twelve sequential lessons, software and
HI-TECH’s PICC™ Lite C compiler, and is designed to
help get up to speed quickly using PIC® micro-
controllers. The kit provides everything needed to
program, evaluate and develop applications using
Microchip’s powerful, mid-range Flash memory family
of microcontrollers.
In addition to the PICDEM™ and dsPICDEM™ demon-
stration/development board series of circuits, Microchip
has a line of evaluation kits and demonstration software
®
for analog filter design, KEELOQ security ICs, CAN,
IrDA®, PowerSmart® battery management, SEEVAL®
evaluation system, Sigma-Delta ADC, flow rate
sensing, plus many more.
Check the Microchip web page (www.microchip.com)
and the latest “Product Selector Guide” (DS00148) for
the complete list of demonstration, development and
evaluation kits.
DS70139E-page 144
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
20.0 ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
This section provides an overview of dsPIC30F electrical characteristics. Additional information will be provided in future
revisions of this document as it becomes available.
For detailed information about the dsPIC30F architecture and core, refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual”
(DS70046).
Absolute maximum ratings for the dsPIC30F family are listed below. Exposure to these maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect device reliability. Functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above
the parameters indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied.
(†)
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Ambient temperature under bias.............................................................................................................-40°C to +125°C
Storage temperature .............................................................................................................................. -65°C to +150°C
Voltage on any pin with respect to VSS (except VDD and MCLR) (Note 1).................................... -0.3V to (VDD + 0.3V)
Voltage on VDD with respect to VSS ......................................................................................................... -0.3V to +5.5V
Voltage on MCLR with respect to VSS........................................................................................................ 0V to +13.25V
Maximum current out of VSS pin ...........................................................................................................................300 mA
Maximum current into VDD pin (Note 2)................................................................................................................250 mA
Input clamp current, IIK (VI < 0 or VI > VDD)..........................................................................................................±20 mA
Output clamp current, IOK (VO < 0 or VO > VDD) ...................................................................................................±20 mA
Maximum output current sunk by any I/O pin..........................................................................................................25 mA
Maximum output current sourced by any I/O pin ....................................................................................................25 mA
Maximum current sunk by all ports .......................................................................................................................200 mA
Maximum current sourced by all ports (Note 2)....................................................................................................200 mA
Note 1: Voltage spikes below VSS at the MCLR/VPP pin, inducing currents greater than 80 mA, may cause latch-up.
Thus, a series resistor of 50-100Ω should be used when applying a “low” level to the MCLR/VPP pin, rather
than pulling this pin directly to VSS.
2: Maximum allowable current is a function of device maximum power dissipation. See Table 20-2 for PDMAX.
†NOTICE: Stresses above those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the
device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those or any other conditions above those
indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied. Exposure to maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect device reliability.
Note: All peripheral electrical characteristics are specified. For exact peripherals available on specific
devices, please refer to the Family Cross Reference Table.
20.1 DC Characteristics
TABLE 20-1: OPERATING MIPS VS. VOLTAGE
Max MIPS
VDD Range
Temp Range
dsPIC30FXXX-30I
dsPIC30FXXX-20E
4.5-5.5V
4.5-5.5V
3.0-3.6V
3.0-3.6V
2.5-3.0V
-40°C to 85°C
-40°C to 125°C
-40°C to 85°C
-40°C to 125°C
-40°C to 85°C
30
—
20
—
10
—
20
—
15
—
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 145
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-2: THERMAL OPERATING CONDITIONS
Rating
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
dsPIC30F201x-30I
dsPIC30F301x-30I
Operating Junction Temperature Range
Operating Ambient Temperature Range
TJ
TA
-40
-40
+125
+85
°C
°C
dsPIC30F201x-20E
dsPIC30F301x-20E
Operating Junction Temperature Range
Operating Ambient Temperature Range
Power Dissipation:
TJ
TA
-40
-40
+150
+125
°C
°C
Internal chip power dissipation:
PINT = VDD × (IDD – ∑
)
IOH
PD
PINT + PI/O
W
I/O Pin power dissipation:
=
({ VDD – VOH} × IOH ) + ∑
(
)
VOL × IOL
PI/O
∑
Maximum Allowed Power Dissipation
PDMAX
(TJ - TA) / θJA
W
TABLE 20-3: THERMAL PACKAGING CHARACTERISTICS
Characteristic
Symbol
Typ
Max
Unit
Notes
Package Thermal Resistance, 18-pin PDIP (P)
Package Thermal Resistance, 18-pin SOIC (SO)
Package Thermal Resistance, 28-pin SPDIP (SP)
Package Thermal Resistance, 28-pin (SOIC)
Package Thermal Resistance, 44-pin QFN
θJA
θJA
θJA
θJA
θJA
44
57
42
49
28
—
—
—
—
—
°C/W
°C/W
°C/W
°C/W
°C/W
1
1
1
1
1
Note 1: Junction to ambient thermal resistance, Theta-ja (θJA) numbers are achieved by package simulations.
TABLE 20-4: DC TEMPERATURE AND VOLTAGE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Typ(1) Max Units
Conditions
Operating Voltage(2)
DC10
DC11
DC12
DC16
VDD
VDD
VDR
VPOR
Supply Voltage
2.5
3.0
—
—
—
5.5
5.5
—
V
V
V
V
Industrial temperature
Extended temperature
Supply Voltage
RAM Data Retention Voltage(3)
1.5
VSS
VDD Start Voltage (to ensure
—
—
internal Power-on Reset signal)
DC17
SVDD
VDD Rise Rate (to ensure
internal Power-on Reset signal)
0.05
V/ms 0-5V in 0.1 sec
0-3V in 60 ms
Note 1: “Typ” column data is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
2: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
3: This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered without losing RAM data.
DS70139E-page 146
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-5: DC CHARACTERISTICS: OPERATING CURRENT (IDD)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
Typical(1)
No.
Max
Units
Conditions
Operating Current (IDD)(2)
DC31a
DC31b
DC31c
DC31e
DC31f
DC31g
DC30a
DC30b
DC30c
DC30e
DC30f
DC30g
DC23a
DC23b
DC23c
DC23e
DC23f
DC23g
DC24a
DC24b
DC24c
DC24e
DC24f
DC24g
DC27a
DC27b
DC27d
DC27e
DC27f
DC29a
DC29b
1.6
1.6
3.0
3.0
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
3.3V
5V
1.6
3.0
0.128 MIPS
LPRC ( 512 kHz)
3.6
6.0
3.3
6.0
3.2
6.0
3.0
5.0
3.0
5.0
3.3V
5V
3.1
5.0
(1.8 MIPS)
FRC (7.37 MHz)
6.0
9.0
5.8
9.0
5.7
9.0
9.0
15.0
15.0
15.0
24.0
24.0
24.0
33.0
33.0
33.0
56.0
56.0
56.0
60.0
60.0
90.0
90.0
90.0
140.0
140.0
10.0
10.0
16.0
16.0
16.0
22.0
22.0
22.0
37.0
37.0
37.0
41.0
40.0
68.0
67.0
66.0
96.0
94.0
3.3V
5V
4 MIPS
3.3V
10 MIPS
5V
3.3V
5V
20 MIPS
30 MIPS
5V
Note 1: Data in “Typical” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only
and are not tested.
2: The supply current is mainly a function of the operating voltage and frequency. Other factors such as I/O
pin loading and switching rate, oscillator type, internal code execution pattern and temperature also have
an impact on the current consumption. The test conditions for all IDD measurements are as follows: OSC1
driven with external square wave from rail to rail. All I/O pins are configured as Inputs and pulled to VDD.
MCLR = VDD, WDT, FSCM, LVD and BOR are disabled. CPU, SRAM, Program Memory and Data
Memory are operational. No peripheral modules are operating.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 147
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-6: DC CHARACTERISTICS: IDLE CURRENT (IIDLE)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
Typical(1)
No.
Max
Units
Conditions
Operating Current (IDD)(2)
DC51a
DC51b
DC51c
DC51e
DC51f
DC51g
DC50a
DC50b
DC50c
DC50e
DC50f
DC50g
DC43a
DC43b
DC43c
DC43e
DC43f
DC43g
DC44a
DC44b
DC44c
DC44e
DC44f
DC44g
DC47a
DC47b
DC47d
DC47e
DC47f
DC49a
DC49b
1.3
1.3
2.5
2.5
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
3.3V
5V
1.2
2.5
0.128 MIPS
LPRC ( 512 kHz)
3.2
5.0
2.9
5.0
2.8
5.0
3.0
5.0
3.0
5.0
3.3V
5V
3.0
5.0
(1.8 MIPS)
FRC (7.37 MHz)
6.0
9.0
5.8
9.0
5.7
9.0
5.2
8.0
5.3
8.0
3.3V
5V
5.4
8.0
4 MIPS
9.7
15.0
15.0
15.0
17.0
17.0
17.0
29.0
29.0
30.0
35.0
35.0
50.0
50.0
50.0
70.0
70.0
9.6
9.5
11.0
11.0
11.0
19.0
19.0
20.0
20.0
21.0
35.0
36.0
36.0
51.0
51.0
3.3V
10 MIPS
5V
3.3V
5V
20 MIPS
30 MIPS
5V
Note 1: Data in “Typical” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only
and are not tested.
2: Base IIDLE current is measured with Core off, Clock on and all modules turned off.
DS70139E-page 148
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-7: DC CHARACTERISTICS: POWER-DOWN CURRENT (IPD)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
Typical(1)
No.
Max
Units
Conditions
Power-Down Current (IPD)(2)
DC60a
DC60b
DC60c
DC60e
DC60f
DC60g
DC61a
DC61b
DC61c
DC61e
DC61f
DC61g
DC62a
DC62b
DC62c
DC62e
DC62f
DC62g
DC63a
DC63b
DC63c
DC63e
DC63f
DC63g
DC66a
DC66b
DC66c
DC66e
DC66f
DC66g
0.3
1.3
—
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
30.0
60.0
—
3.3V
5V
16.0
0.5
Base Power-Down Current(3)
3.7
45.0
90.0
9.0
25.0
6.0
6.0
9.0
3.3V
5V
6.0
9.0
(3)
Watchdog Timer Current: ΔIWDT
13.0
12.0
12.0
4.0
20.0
20.0
20.0
10.0
10.0
10.0
15.0
15.0
15.0
53.0
53.0
53.0
62.0
62.0
62.0
40.0
40.0
40.0
44.0
44.0
44.0
5.0
3.3V
5V
4.0
Timer1 w/32 kHz Crystal: ΔITI32(3)
4.0
6.0
5.0
33.0
35.0
19.0
38.0
41.0
41.0
21.0
26.0
27.0
25.0
27.0
29.0
3.3V
5V
(3)
BOR On: ΔIBOR
3.3V
5V
(3)
Low-Voltage Detect: ΔILVD
Note 1: Data in the Typical column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
2: Base IPD is measured with all peripherals and clocks shut down. All I/Os are configured as inputs and
pulled high. LVD, BOR, WDT, etc. are all switched off.
3: The Δ current is the additional current consumed when the module is enabled. This current should be
added to the base IPD current.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 149
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-8: DC CHARACTERISTICS: I/O PIN INPUT SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
Input Low Voltage(2)
VIL
DI10
I/O pins:
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
—
—
—
—
—
—
0.2 VDD
0.2 VDD
0.2 VDD
0.3 VDD
0.3 VDD
0.2 VDD
V
V
V
V
V
V
DI15
DI16
DI17
DI18
DI19
MCLR
OSC1 (in XT, HS and LP modes)
OSC1 (in RC mode)(3)
SDA, SCL
SM bus disabled
SM bus enabled
SDA, SCL
VIH
Input High Voltage(2)
DI20
I/O pins:
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
0.8 VDD
0.8 VDD
—
—
—
—
—
—
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
V
V
V
V
V
V
DI25
DI26
DI27
DI28
DI29
MCLR
OSC1 (in XT, HS and LP modes) 0.7 VDD
OSC1 (in RC mode)(3)
0.9 VDD
0.7 VDD
0.8 VDD
SDA, SCL
SM bus disabled
SM bus enabled
SDA, SCL
ICNPU
IIL
CNXX Pull-up Current(2)
DI30
50
250
400
μA VDD = 5V, VPIN = VSS
Input Leakage Current(2)(4)(5)
DI50
DI51
I/O ports
—
—
0.01
0.50
±1
—
μA VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD,
Pin at high impedance
Analog input pins
μA VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD,
Pin at high impedance
DI55
DI56
MCLR
OSC1
—
—
0.05
0.05
±5
±5
μA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD
μA VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD, XT, HS
and LP Osc mode
Note 1: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
2: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
3: In RC oscillator configuration, the OSC1/CLKl pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended that
the dsPIC30F device be driven with an external clock while in RC mode.
4: The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified
levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input
voltages.
5: Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin.
DS70139E-page 150
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-9: DC CHARACTERISTICS: I/O PIN OUTPUT SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min
Typ(1) Max Units
Conditions
VOL
Output Low Voltage(2)
DO10
DO16
I/O ports
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0.6
TBD
0.6
V
V
V
V
IOL = 8.5 mA, VDD = 5V
IOL = 2.0 mA, VDD = 3V
IOL = 1.6 mA, VDD = 5V
IOL = 2.0 mA, VDD = 3V
OSC2/CLKO
(RC or EC Osc mode)
Output High Voltage(2)
I/O ports
TBD
VOH
DO20
DO26
VDD – 0.7
TBD
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
V
V
V
V
IOH = -3.0 mA, VDD = 5V
IOH = -2.0 mA, VDD = 3V
IOH = -1.3 mA, VDD = 5V
IOH = -2.0 mA, VDD = 3V
OSC2/CLKO
VDD – 0.7
TBD
(RC or EC Osc mode)
Capacitive Loading Specs
on Output Pins(2)
DO50 COSC2
OSC2/SOSC2 pin
—
—
15
pF In XTL, XT, HS and LP modes
when external clock is used to
drive OSC1.
DO56 CIO
DO58 CB
All I/O pins and OSC2
SCL, SDA
—
—
—
—
50
pF RC or EC Osc mode
pF In I2C mode
400
Note 1: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
2: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 151
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-1:
LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT CHARACTERISTICS
VDD
LV10
LVDIF
(LVDIF set by hardware)
TABLE 20-10: ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS: LVDL
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ
Max Units Conditions
LV10
VPLVD
LVDL Voltage on VDD transition LVDL = 0000(2)
—
—
—
V
high-to-low
LVDL = 0001(2)
LVDL = 0010(2)
LVDL = 0011(2)
LVDL = 0100
LVDL = 0101
LVDL = 0110
LVDL = 0111
LVDL = 1000
LVDL = 1001
LVDL = 1010
LVDL = 1011
LVDL = 1100
LVDL = 1101
LVDL = 1110
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
—
—
—
—
2.50
2.70
2.80
3.00
3.30
3.50
3.60
3.80
4.00
4.20
4.50
—
2.65
2.86
2.97
3.18
3.50
3.71
3.82
4.03
4.24
4.45
4.77
—
LV15
VLVDIN
External LVD input pin
threshold voltage
LVDL = 1111
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
2: These values not in usable operating range.
DS70139E-page 152
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-2:
BROWN-OUT RESET CHARACTERISTICS
VDD
(Device not in Brown-out Reset)
BO15
BO10
(Device in Brown-out Reset)
RESET (due to BOR)
Power-Up Time-out
TABLE 20-11: ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS: BOR
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min Typ(1) Max Units
Conditions
BO10
VBOR
BOR Voltage(2) on
VDD transition high to
low
BORV = 11(3)
—
—
—
V
Not in operating
range
BORV = 10
BORV = 01
BORV = 00
2.6
4.1
4.58
—
—
—
—
5
2.71
4.4
V
V
4.73
—
V
BO15
VBHYS
mV
Note 1: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
2: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
3: 11values not in usable operating range.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 153
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-12: DC CHARACTERISTICS: PROGRAM AND EEPROM
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
Data EEPROM Memory(2)
Byte Endurance
D120
D121
ED
100K
VMIN
1M
—
—
E/W -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDRW
VDD for Read/Write
5.5
V
Using EECON to Read/Write
VMIN = Minimum operating
voltage
D122
D123
TDEW
Erase/Write Cycle Time
Characteristic Retention
—
2
—
—
ms
TRETD
40
100
Year Provided no other specifications
are violated
D124
IDEW
IDD During Programming
Program Flash Memory(2)
Cell Endurance
—
10
30
mA Row Erase
D130
D131
EP
10K
100K
—
—
E/W -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VPR
VDD for Read
VMIN
5.5
V
VMIN = Minimum operating
voltage
D132
D133
D134
D135
VEB
VDD for Bulk Erase
4.5
3.0
—
—
—
5.5
5.5
—
V
V
VPEW
TPEW
TRETD
VDD for Erase/Write
Erase/Write Cycle Time
Characteristic Retention
2
ms
40
100
—
Year Provided no other specifications
are violated
D136
D137
D138
TEB
IPEW
IEB
ICSP™ Block Erase Time
IDD During Programming
IDD During Programming
—
—
—
4
—
30
30
ms
10
10
mA Row Erase
mA Bulk Erase
Note 1: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
2: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
DS70139E-page 154
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
20.2 AC Characteristics and Timing Parameters
The information contained in this section defines dsPIC30F AC characteristics and timing parameters.
TABLE 20-13: TEMPERATURE AND VOLTAGE SPECIFICATIONS – AC
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
AC CHARACTERISTICS
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Operating voltage VDD range as described in Section 20.0 “Electrical
Characteristics”.
FIGURE 20-3:
Load Condition 1 — for all pins except OSC2
VDD/2
LOAD CONDITIONS FOR DEVICE TIMING SPECIFICATIONS
Load Condition 2 — for OSC2
CL
RL
Pin
VSS
CL
Legend:
Pin
RL = 464 Ω
CL = 50 pF for all pins except OSC2
VSS
5 pF for OSC2 output
FIGURE 20-4:
EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
OSC1
CLKO
OS20
OS30 OS30
OS25
OS31 OS31
OS40
OS41
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 155
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-14: EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
OS10 FOSC
External CLKN Frequency(2)
(External clocks allowed only
in EC mode)
DC
4
4
—
—
—
—
40
10
10
7.5
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
EC
EC with 4x PLL
EC with 8x PLL
EC with 16x PLL
4
Oscillator Frequency(2)
DC
0.4
4
4
4
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
4
4
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
kHz
RC
XTL
XT
10
10
10
7.5
25
20
20
15
25
25
22.5
33
—
XT with 4x PLL
XT with 8x PLL
XT with 16x PLL
HS
HS/2 with 4x PLL
HS/2 with 8x PLL
HS/2 with 16x PLL
HS/3 with 4x PLL
HS/3 with 8x PLL
HS/3 with 16x PLL
LP
4
10
10
10
10
12
12
12
31
—
—
—
—
—
—
7.37
7.37
7.37
7.37
512
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
kHz
FRC internal
—
—
—
—
FRC internal w/4x PLL
FRC internal w/8x PLL
FRC internal w/16x PLL
LPRC internal
OS20 TOSC
OS25 TCY
TOSC = 1/FOSC
—
—
—
—
See parameter OS10
for FOSC value
Instruction Cycle Time(2)(3)
External Clock(2) in (OSC1)
High or Low Time
33
—
—
DC
—
ns
ns
See Table 20-17
EC
OS30 TosL,
TosH
.45 x
TOSC
OS31 TosR,
TosF
External Clock(2) in (OSC1)
Rise or Fall Time
—
—
20
ns
EC
OS40 TckR
OS41 TckF
CLKO Rise Time(2)(4)
CLKO Fall Time(2)(4)
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
See parameter DO31
See parameter DO32
Note 1: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
2: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
3: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time-base period. All specified values
are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions
with the device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator
operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at “min.”
values with an external clock applied to the OSC1/CLKI pin. When an external clock input is used, the
“Max.” cycle time limit is “DC” (no clock) for all devices.
4: Measurements are taken in EC or ERC modes. The CLKO signal is measured on the OSC2 pin. CLKO is
low for the Q1-Q2 period (1/2 TCY) and high for the Q3-Q4 period (1/2 TCY).
DS70139E-page 156
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-15: PLL CLOCK TIMING SPECIFICATIONS (VDD = 2.5 TO 5.5 V)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
OS50
FPLLI
PLL Input Frequency Range(2)
4
4
4
4
4
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
10
10
MHz EC with 4x PLL
MHz EC with 8x PLL
MHz EC with 16x PLL
MHz XT with 4x PLL
MHz XT with 8x PLL
MHz XT with 16x PLL
MHz HS/2 with 4x PLL
MHz HS/2 with 8x PLL
MHz HS/2 with 16x PLL
7.5(4)
10
10
4
7.5(4)
10
5(3)
5(3)
5(3)
4
10
7.5(4)
8.33(3) MHz HS/3 with 4x PLL
8.33(3) MHz HS/3 with 8x PLL
4
4
7.5(4)
120
MHz HS/3 with 16x PLL
OS51
OS52
FSYS
TLOC
On-Chip PLL Output(2)
16
—
MHz EC, XT, HS/2, HS/3
modes with PLL
PLL Start-up Time (Lock Time)
—
20
50
μs
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
2: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
3: Limited by oscillator frequency range.
4: Limited by device operating frequency range.
TABLE 20-16: PLL JITTER
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
AC CHARACTERISTICS
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
No.
Characteristic
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
OS61
x4 PLL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0.251 0.413
0.251 0.413
%
%
%
%
%
%
%
%
%
%
%
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
0.256
0.256
0.47
0.47
x8 PLL
0.355 0.584
0.355 0.584
0.362 0.664
0.362 0.664
x16 PLL
0.67
0.92
0.632 0.956
0.632 0.956
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 157
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-17: INTERNAL CLOCK TIMING EXAMPLES
Clock
FOSC
MIPS(3)
MIPS(3)
w PLL x4
MIPS(3)
w PLL x8
MIPS(3)
w PLL x16
Oscillator
Mode
TCY (μsec)(2)
(MHz)(1)
w/o PLL
EC
XT
0.200
4
20.0
1.0
0.05
1.0
—
4.0
10.0
—
—
8.0
20.0
—
—
16.0
—
10
25
4
0.4
2.5
0.16
1.0
6.25
1.0
—
4.0
10.0
8.0
20.0
16.0
—
10
0.4
2.5
Note 1: Assumption: Oscillator Postscaler is divide by 1.
2: Instruction Execution Cycle Time: TCY = 1/MIPS.
3: Instruction Execution Frequency: MIPS = (FOSC * PLLx)/4 [since there are 4 Q clocks per instruction
cycle].
DS70139E-page 158
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-18: AC CHARACTERISTICS: INTERNAL RC ACCURACY(2)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
No.
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
Internal FRC Jitter @ FRC Freq. = 7.37 MHz(1)
OS62
FRC
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
+0.04 +0.16
+0.07 +0.23
+0.31 +0.62
+0.34 +0.77
+0.44 +0.87
+0.48 +1.08
+0.71 +1.23
%
%
%
%
%
%
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
FRC with 4x PLL
FRC with 8x PLL
FRC with 16x PLL
Internal FRC Accuracy @ FRC Freq. = 7.37 MHz(1)
FRC +1.50
Internal FRC Drift @ FRC Freq. = 7.37 MHz(1)
OS63
OS64
—
—
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 3.0-5.5V
-0.7
-0.7
-0.7
-0.7
—
—
—
—
0.5
0.7
0.5
0.7
%
%
%
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
Note 1: Frequency calibrated at 7.372 MHz ±2%, 25°C and 5V. TUN bits (OSCCON<3:0>) can be used to
compensate for temperature drift.
2: Overall FRC variation can be calculated by adding the absolute values of jitter, accuracy and drift
percentages.
TABLE 20-19: INTERNAL RC ACCURACY
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
No.
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
LPRC @ Freq. = 512 kHz(1)
OS65
-35
—
+35
%
—
Note 1: Change of LPRC frequency as VDD changes.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 159
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-5:
CLKO AND I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
I/O Pin
(Input)
DI35
DI40
I/O Pin
(Output)
New Value
Old Value
DO31
DO32
Note: Refer to Figure 20-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 20-20: CLKO AND I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)(2)(3)
Min
Typ(4)
Max
Units
Conditions
DO31
DO32
DI35
TIOR
TIOF
TINP
TRBP
Port output rise time
—
—
7
7
20
20
—
—
ns
ns
ns
ns
—
—
—
—
Port output fall time
INTx pin high or low time (output)
CNx high or low time (input)
20
—
—
DI40
2 TCY
Note 1: These parameters are asynchronous events not related to any internal clock edges
2: Measurements are taken in RC mode and EC mode where CLKO output is 4 x TOSC.
3: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
4: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
DS70139E-page 160
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-6:
RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER AND POWER-UP
TIMER TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
VDD
SY12
MCLR
SY10
Internal
POR
SY11
PWRT
Time-out
SY30
OSC
Time-out
Internal
RESET
Watchdog
Timer
RESET
SY20
SY13
SY13
I/O Pins
SY35
FSCM
Delay
Note: Refer to Figure 20-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 20-21: RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER, POWER-UP TIMER
AND BROWN-OUT RESET TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max Units
Conditions
SY10
SY11
TmcL
MCLR Pulse Width (low)
Power-up Timer Period
2
—
—
μs
ms
-40°C to +85°C
TPWRT
3
4
6
-40°C to +85°C
12
50
16
64
22
90
User programmable
SY12
SY13
TPOR
TIOZ
Power On Reset Delay
3
10
30
μs
μs
-40°C to +85°C
I/O high impedance from MCLR
Low or Watchdog Timer Reset
—
0.8
1.0
SY20
TWDT1
WatchdogTimerTime-outPeriod
(No Prescaler)
1.4
2.1
2.8
ms
VDD = 5V, -40°C to +85°C
TWDT2
TBOR
TOST
1.4
100
—
2.1
—
2.8
—
ms
μs
—
VDD = 3V, -40°C to +85°C
VDD ≤ VBOR (D034)
TOSC = OSC1 period
-40°C to +85°C
SY25
SY30
SY35
Brown-out Reset Pulse Width(3)
Oscillation Start-up Timer Period
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Delay
1024 TOSC
500
—
TFSCM
—
900
μs
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
2: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
3: Refer to Figure 20-2 and Table 20-11 for BOR.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 161
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-7:
BAND GAP START-UP TIME CHARACTERISTICS
VBGAP
0V
Enable Band Gap
(see Note)
Band Gap
Stable
SY40
Note: Set LVDEN bit (RCON<12>) or FBORPOR<7>set.
TABLE 20-22: BAND GAP START-UP TIME REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Band Gap Start-up Time
Min Typ(2) Max Units
Conditions
SY40
TBGAP
—
40 65
µs Defined as the time between the
instant that the band gap is enabled
and the moment that the band gap
reference voltage is stable.
RCON<13> bit
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
2: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
DS70139E-page 162
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-8:
TYPE A, B AND C TIMER EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
TxCK
Tx11
Tx10
Tx15
OS60
Tx20
TMRX
Note: Refer to Figure 20-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 20-23: TYPE A TIMER (TIMER1) EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
No.
Symbol
TTXH
Characteristic
Synchronous,
Min
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
TA10
TxCK High Time
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
—
ns
ns
Must also meet
parameter TA15
no prescaler
Synchronous,
with prescaler
10
—
Asynchronous
10
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
TA11
TA15
TTXL
TTXP
TxCK Low Time
Synchronous,
no prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
Must also meet
parameter TA15
Synchronous,
with prescaler
10
—
—
ns
Asynchronous
10
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
TxCK Input Period Synchronous,
no prescaler
TCY + 10
Synchronous,
with prescaler
Greater of:
20 ns or
—
—
—
N = prescale
value
(TCY + 40)/N
(1, 8, 64, 256)
Asynchronous
20
—
—
—
ns
OS60
Ft1
SOSC1/T1CK oscillator input
DC
50
kHz
frequency range (oscillator enabled
by setting bit TCS (T1CON, bit 1))
TA20
TCKEXTMRL Delay from External TxCK Clock
Edge to Timer Increment
0.5 TCY
—
1.5 TCY
—
Note:
Timer1 is a Type A.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 163
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-24: TYPE B TIMER (TIMER2 AND TIMER4) EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
No.
Symbol
TtxH
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
TB10
TxCK High Time Synchronous, 0.5 TCY + 20
no prescaler
—
—
ns
Must also meet
parameter TB15
Synchronous,
with prescaler
10
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
ns
ns
TB11
TB15
TtxL
TtxP
TxCK Low Time
Synchronous, 0.5 TCY + 20
no prescaler
Must also meet
parameter TB15
Synchronous,
with prescaler
10
TxCK Input Period Synchronous,
no prescaler
TCY + 10
N = prescale
value
(1, 8, 64, 256)
Synchronous,
with prescaler
Greater of:
20 ns or
(TCY + 40)/N
TB20
TCKEXTMRL Delay from External TxCK Clock
Edge to Timer Increment
0.5 TCY
—
1.5 TCY
—
Note:
Timer2 and Timer4 are Type B.
TABLE 20-25: TYPE C TIMER (TIMER3 AND TIMER5) EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
No.
Symbol
TtxH
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
TC10
TxCK High Time
TxCK Low Time
Synchronous
Synchronous
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
ns
Must also meet
parameter TC15
TC11
TC15
TtxL
TtxP
0.5 TCY + 20
TCY + 10
—
—
Must also meet
parameter TC15
TxCK Input Period Synchronous,
no prescaler
N = prescale
value
(1, 8, 64, 256)
Synchronous,
with prescaler
Greater of:
20 ns or
(TCY + 40)/N
TC20
TCKEXTMRL Delay from External TxCK Clock
Edge to Timer Increment
0.5 TCY
—
1.5
TCY
—
Note:
Timer3 and Timer5 are Type C.
DS70139E-page 164
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-9:
INPUT CAPTURE (CAPx) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
ICX
IC10
IC11
IC15
Note: Refer to Figure 20-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 20-26: INPUT CAPTURE TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
IC10
IC11
IC15
TccL
TccH
TccP
ICx Input Low Time No Prescaler
With Prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
10
—
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ICx Input High Time No Prescaler
With Prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
10
ICx Input Period
(2 TCY + 40)/N
N = prescale
value (1, 4, 16)
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 165
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-10:
OUTPUT COMPARE MODULE (OCx) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
OCx
(Output Compare
or PWM Mode)
OC10
OC11
Note: Refer to Figure 20-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 20-27: OUTPUT COMPARE MODULE TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
OC10 TccF
OC11 TccR
OCx Output Fall Time
OCx Output Rise Time
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
See Parameter DO32
See Parameter DO31
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
2: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
DS70139E-page 166
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-11:
OCFA/OCFB
OCx
OC/PWM MODULE TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
OC20
OC15
TABLE 20-28: SIMPLE OC/PWM MODE TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
OC15
OC20
OC15 TFD
Fault Input to PWM I/O
Change
—
—
50
ns
—
—
OC20 TFLT
Fault Input Pulse Width
50
—
—
ns
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
2: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 167
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-12:
SPI MODULE MASTER MODE (CKE = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SCKx
(CKP = 0)
SP11
SP10
SP21
SP20
SCKx
(CKP = 1)
SP35
SP31
SP21
LSb
SP20
BIT 14 - - - - - -1
MSb
SDOx
SDIx
SP30
MSb IN
SP40
LSb IN
BIT 14 - - - -1
SP41
Note: Refer to Figure 20-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 20-29: SPI MASTER MODE (CKE = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
SP10
SP11
SP20
TscL
TscH
TscF
SCKX Output Low Time(3)
SCKX Output High Time(3)
SCKX Output Fall Time(4
TCY/2
TCY/2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
ns
—
—
See parameter
DO32
SP21
SP30
SP31
SP35
SP40
SP41
TscR
TdoF
TdoR
SCKX Output Rise Time(4)
—
—
—
—
20
20
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
30
—
—
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
See parameter
DO31
SDOX Data Output Fall Time(4)
SDOX Data Output Rise Time(4)
See parameter
DO32
See parameter
DO31
TscH2doV, SDOX Data Output Valid after
TscL2doV SCKX Edge
—
—
—
TdiV2scH, Setup Time of SDIX Data Input
TdiV2scL
TscH2diL, Hold Time of SDIX Data Input
TscL2diL to SCKX Edge
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
to SCKX Edge
2: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
3: The minimum clock period for SCK is 100 ns. Therefore, the clock generated in Master mode must not
violate this specification.
4: Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI pins.
DS70139E-page 168
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-13:
SPI MODULE MASTER MODE (CKE =1) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SP36
SCKX
(CKP = 0)
SP11
SP10
SP21
SP20
SP21
SCKX
(CKP = 1)
SP35
SP20
LSb
MSb
SP40
BIT 14 - - - - - -1
SDOX
SDIX
SP30,SP31
BIT 14 - - - -1
MSb IN
SP41
LSb IN
Note: Refer to Figure 20-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 20-30: SPI MODULE MASTER MODE (CKE = 1) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
No.
Symbol
TscL
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
SP10
SP11
SP20
SCKX output low time(3)
SCKX output high time(3)
SCKX output fall time(4)
TCY/2
TCY/2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
ns
—
—
TscH
TscF
See parameter
DO32
SP21
SP30
SP31
SP35
SP36
SP40
SP41
TscR
TdoF
TdoR
SCKX output rise time(4)
—
—
—
—
30
20
20
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
30
—
—
—
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
See parameter
DO31
SDOX data output fall time(4)
SDOX data output rise time(4)
See parameter
DO32
See parameter
DO31
TscH2doV, SDOX data output valid after
TscL2doV SCKX edge
—
—
—
—
TdoV2sc, SDOX data output setup to
TdoV2scL first SCKX edge
TdiV2scH, Setup time of SDIX data input
TdiV2scL to SCKX edge
TscH2diL, Hold time of SDIX data input
TscL2diL
to SCKX edge
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
2: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
3: The minimum clock period for SCK is 100 ns. Therefore, the clock generated in master mode must not
violate this specification.
4: Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI pins.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 169
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-14:
SPI MODULE SLAVE MODE (CKE = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SSX
SP52
SP50
SCK
(CKP =
X
0
)
)
SP71
SP70
SP72
SP73
SCK
(CKP =
X
1
SP73
LSb
SP72
SP35
MSb
BIT 14 - - - - - -1
SDOX
SP51
SP30,SP31
BIT 14 - - - -1
SDIX
MSb IN
SP41
LSb IN
SP40
Note: Refer to Figure 20-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 20-31: SPI MODULE SLAVE MODE (CKE = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature
-40°C
≤
≤
T
TA
A
≤
≤
+85°C for Industrial
+125°C for Extended
-40°C
Param
No.
Symbol
TscL
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
SP70
SP71
SP72
SP73
SP30
SP31
SP35
SCKX Input Low Time
30
30
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
10
10
—
—
—
—
—
25
25
—
—
30
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
—
TscH
TscF
TscR
TdoF
TdoR
SCKX Input High Time
—
SCKX Input Fall Time(3)
SCKX Input Rise Time(3)
SDOX Data Output Fall Time(3)
SDOX Data Output Rise Time(3)
—
—
See DO32
See DO31
—
TscH2doV,
TscL2doV
SDOX Data Output Valid after
SCKX Edge
SP40
SP41
SP50
SP51
SP52
TdiV2scH,
TdiV2scL
Setup Time of SDIX Data Input
to SCKX Edge
20
20
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
50
—
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
—
—
—
—
—
TscH2diL,
TscL2diL
Hold Time of SDIX Data Input
to SCKX Edge
TssL2scH,
TssL2scL
SSX↓ to SCKX↑ or SCKX↓ Input
120
10
TssH2doZ
SSX↑ to SDOX Output
high impedance(3)
TscH2ssH SSX after SCK Edge
TscL2ssH
1.5 TCY
+40
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
2: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
3: Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI pins.
DS70139E-page 170
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-15:
SPI MODULE SLAVE MODE (CKE = 1) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SP60
SSX
SP52
SP50
SCKX
(CKP = 0)
SP71
SP70
SP72
SP73
SP73
SCKX
(CKP = 1)
SP35
SP72
LSb
SP52
BIT 14 - - - - - -1
MSb
SDOX
SDIX
SP30,SP31
BIT 14 - - - -1
SP51
MSb IN
SP41
LSb IN
SP40
Note: Refer to Figure 20-3 for load conditions.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 171
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-32: SPI MODULE SLAVE MODE (CKE = 1) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
No.
Symbol
TscL
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
SP70
SP71
SP72
SP73
SP30
SCKX Input Low Time
30
30
—
—
—
—
—
10
10
—
—
—
25
25
—
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
—
—
—
—
TscH
TscF
TscR
TdoF
SCKX Input High Time
SCKX Input Fall Time(3)
SCKX Input Rise Time(3)
SDOX Data Output Fall Time(3)
Seeparameter
DO32
SP31
SP35
SP40
SP41
SP50
SP51
SP52
SP60
TdoR
SDOX Data Output Rise Time(3)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
30
—
—
—
50
—
50
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Seeparameter
DO31
TscH2doV, SDOX Data Output Valid after
TscL2doV SCKX Edge
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TdiV2scH, Setup Time of SDIX Data Input
20
TdiV2scL
TscH2diL, Hold Time of SDIX Data Input
TscL2diL to SCKX Edge
to SCKX Edge
20
TssL2scH, SSX↓ to SCKX↓ or SCKX↑ input
TssL2scL
120
TssH2doZ SS↑ to SDOX Output
10
1.5 TCY + 40
—
high impedance(4)
TscH2ssH SSX↑ after SCKX Edge
TscL2ssH
TssL2doV SDOX Data Output Valid after
SCKX Edge
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
2: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
3: The minimum clock period for SCK is 100 ns. Therefore, the clock generated in Master mode must not
violate this specification.
4: Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI pins.
DS70139E-page 172
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-16:
I2C™ BUS START/STOP BITS TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (MASTER MODE)
SCL
SDA
IM31
IM34
IM30
IM33
Stop
Condition
Start
Condition
Note: Refer to Figure 20-3 for load conditions.
FIGURE 20-17:
I2C™ BUS DATA TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (MASTER MODE)
IM20
IM21
IM11
IM10
SCL
IM11
IM26
IM10
IM33
IM25
SDA
In
IM45
IM40
IM40
SDA
Out
Note: Refer to Figure 20-3 for load conditions.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 173
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
I
TABLE 20-33: I2C™ BUS DATA TIMING REQUIREMENTS (MASTER MODE)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
IM10
IM11
IM20
IM21
IM25
IM26
IM30
IM31
IM33
IM34
IM40
IM45
IM50
TLO:SCL Clock Low Time 100 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
400 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
—
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
μs
ns
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
μs
μs
μs
pF
—
—
—
—
—
—
1 MHz mode(2) TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
THI:SCL Clock High Time 100 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
400 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
1 MHz mode(2) TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
—
TF:SCL
TR:SCL
SDA and SCL
Fall Time
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(2)
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(2)
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(2)
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(2)
—
300
300
100
1000
300
300
—
CB is specified to be
from 10 to 400 pF
20 + 0.1 CB
—
SDA and SCL
Rise Time
—
CB is specified to be
from 10 to 400 pF
20 + 0.1 CB
—
250
100
TBD
0
TSU:DAT Data Input
Setup Time
—
—
—
—
THD:DAT Data Input
Hold Time
—
0
0.9
—
TBD
TSU:STA Start Condition 100 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
Only relevant for
Repeated Start
condition
Setup Time
400 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
1 MHz mode(2) TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
THD:STA Start Condition 100 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
After this period the
first clock pulse is
generated
Hold Time
400 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
1 MHz mode(2) TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
TSU:STO Stop Condition 100 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
—
Setup Time
400 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
1 MHz mode(2) TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
THD:STO Stop Condition
Hold Time
100 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
400 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
1 MHz mode(2) TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
—
—
—
TAA:SCL Output Valid
From Clock
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(2)
—
—
3500
1000
—
—
—
—
—
TBF:SDA Bus Free Time 100 kHz mode
4.7
1.3
TBD
—
—
Time the bus must be
free before a new
transmission can start
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(2)
—
—
CB
Bus Capacitive Loading
400
Note 1: BRG is the value of the I2C Baud Rate Generator. Refer to Section 21 “Inter-Integrated Circuit™ (I2C)”
in the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046).
2: Maximum pin capacitance = 10 pF for all I2C™ pins (for 1 MHz mode only).
DS70139E-page 174
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-18:
I2C™ BUS START/STOP BITS TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (SLAVE MODE)
SCL
SDA
IS34
IS31
IS30
IS33
Stop
Condition
Start
Condition
FIGURE 20-19:
I2C™ BUS DATA TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (SLAVE MODE)
IS20
IS21
IS11
IS10
SCL
IS30
IS26
IS31
IS33
IS25
SDA
In
IS45
IS40
IS40
SDA
Out
2
TABLE 20-34: I C™ BUS DATA TIMING REQUIREMENTS (SLAVE MODE)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Max Units
Conditions
IS10
TLO:SCL Clock Low Time 100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
4.7
—
—
μs
μs
Device must operate at a
minimum of 1.5 MHz
1.3
Device must operate at a
minimum of 10 MHz.
1 MHz mode(1)
0.5
4.0
—
—
μs
μs
—
IS11
THI:SCL
Clock High Time 100 kHz mode
Device must operate at a
minimum of 1.5 MHz
400 kHz mode
0.6
—
μs
Device must operate at a
minimum of 10 MHz
1 MHz mode(1)
0.5
—
300
300
100
1000
300
300
μs
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
—
IS20
IS21
TF:SCL
TR:SCL
SDA and SCL
Fall Time
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
—
CB is specified to be from
10 to 400 pF
20 + 0.1 CB
—
SDA and SCL
Rise Time
—
20 + 0.1 CB
—
CB is specified to be from
10 to 400 pF
Note 1: Maximum pin capacitance = 10 pF for all I2C™ pins (for 1 MHz mode only).
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 175
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
2
TABLE 20-34: I C™ BUS DATA TIMING REQUIREMENTS (SLAVE MODE) (CONTINUED)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Max Units
Conditions
IS25
TSU:DAT Data Input
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
250
100
100
0
—
—
—
—
0.9
0.3
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
ns
ns
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
μs
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
μs
μs
μs
pF
—
Setup Time
IS26
IS30
IS31
IS33
IS34
IS40
IS45
IS50
THD:DAT Data Input
Hold Time
—
0
0
TSU:STA Start Condition
Setup Time
4.7
0.6
0.25
4.0
0.6
0.25
4.7
0.6
0.6
4000
600
250
0
Only relevant for Repeated
Start condition
THD:STA Start Condition
Hold Time
After this period the first
clock pulse is generated
TSU:STO Stop Condition
Setup Time
—
—
—
THD:STO Stop Condition
Hold Time
TAA:SCL
Output Valid
From Clock
3500
1000
350
—
0
0
TBF:SDA Bus Free Time
4.7
1.3
0.5
—
Time the bus must be free
before a new transmission
can start
—
—
CB
Bus Capacitive
Loading
400
—
Note 1: Maximum pin capacitance = 10 pF for all I2C™ pins (for 1 MHz mode only).
DS70139E-page 176
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-20:
CAN MODULE I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
CXTX Pin
(output)
New Value
Old Value
CA10 CA11
CA20
CXRX Pin
(input)
TABLE 20-35: CAN MODULE I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
TioF
TioR
Tcwf
CA10
CA11
CA20
Port Output Fall Time
Port Output Rise Time
—
—
10
10
—
25
25
—
ns
ns
ns
—
—
—
Pulse Width to Trigger
CAN Wake-up Filter
500
Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
2: Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 177
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-36: 12-BIT ADC MODULE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min.
Typ
Max.
Units
Conditions
Device Supply
AD01 AVDD
AD02 AVSS
Module VDD Supply
Module VSS Supply
Greater of
VDD - 0.3
or 2.7
—
—
Lesser of
VDD + 0.3
or 5.5
V
V
—
—
VSS - 0.3
VSS + 0.3
Reference Inputs
AD05
AD06
AD07
VREFH
VREFL
VREF
Reference Voltage High
Reference Voltage Low
AVSS + 2.7
AVSS
—
—
—
AVDD
V
V
V
—
—
—
AVDD - 2.7
AVDD + 0.3
Absolute Reference
Voltage
AVSS - 0.3
AD08
IREF
Current Drain
—
200
.001
300
2
μA
μA
A/D operating
A/D off
Analog Input
AD10 VINH-VINL Full-Scale Input Span
VREFL
AVSS - 0.3
—
—
VREFH
AVDD + 0.3
±0.610
V
V
See Note 1
AD11
AD12
VIN
—
Absolute Input Voltage
Leakage Current
—
—
±0.001
μA
VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 5V
Source Impedance =
2.5 kΩ
AD13
—
Leakage Current
Switch Resistance
—
±0.001
±0.610
μA
VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 3V
Source Impedance =
2.5 kΩ
AD15 RSS
—
—
—
3.2K
18
—
Ω
pF
Ω
—
—
—
AD16 CSAMPLE Sample Capacitor
AD17 RIN
Recommended Impedance
of Analog Voltage Source
—
2.5K
DC Accuracy(2)
12 data bits
AD20 Nr
Resolution
bits
AD21 INL
Integral Nonlinearity
—
—
<±1
<±1
<±1
<±1
+3
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 5V
AD21A INL
AD22 DNL
AD22A DNL
Integral Nonlinearity
Differential Nonlinearity
Differential Nonlinearity
Gain Error
—
—
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 3V
—
—
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 5V
—
—
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 3V
AD23
GERR
+1.25
+1.25
+1.5
+1.5
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 5V
AD23A GERR
Gain Error
+3
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 3V
Note 1: The A/D conversion result never decreases with an increase in the input voltage, and has no missing
codes.
2: Measurements taken with external VREF+ and VREF- used as the ADC voltage references.
DS70139E-page 178
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-36: 12-BIT ADC MODULE SPECIFICATIONS (CONTINUED)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Offset Error
Min.
Typ
Max.
Units
Conditions
AD24
AD24A EOFF
AD25
EOFF
-2
-1.5
-1.25
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 5V
Offset Error
-2
-1.5
—
-1.25
—
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 3V
—
Monotonicity(1)
—
—
Guaranteed
Dynamic Performance
AD30 THD
Total Harmonic Distortion
—
—
-71
68
—
—
dB
dB
—
AD31 SINAD
Signal to Noise and
Distortion
—
AD32 SFDR
Spurious Free Dynamic
Range
—
83
—
dB
—
AD33
FNYQ
Input Signal Bandwidth
Effective Number of Bits
—
—
100
—
kHz
bits
—
—
AD34 ENOB
10.95
11.1
Note 1: The A/D conversion result never decreases with an increase in the input voltage, and has no missing
codes.
2: Measurements taken with external VREF+ and VREF- used as the ADC voltage references.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 179
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
FIGURE 20-21:
12-BIT A/D CONVERSION TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
(ASAM = 0, SSRC = 000)
AD50
ADCLK
Instruction
Execution
Set SAMP
Clear SAMP
SAMP
ch0_dischrg
ch0_samp
eoc
AD61
AD60
TSAMP
AD55
DONE
ADIF
ADRES(0)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
- Software sets ADCON. SAMP to start sampling.
- Sampling starts after discharge period.
1
2
TSAMP is described in the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual”, (DS70046), Section 18.
- Software clears ADCON. SAMP to Start conversion.
- Sampling ends, conversion sequence starts.
- Convert bit 11.
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
- Convert bit 10.
- Convert bit 1.
- Convert bit 0.
- One TAD for end of conversion.
DS70139E-page 180
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
TABLE 20-37: 12-BIT A/D CONVERSION TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.7V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
TABLE 20-38: OPERATING TEMPERATURE-40°C ≤
TA ≤ +85°C FOR INDUSTRIAL
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C FOR EXTENDED
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min.
Typ
Max.
Units
Conditions
Clock Parameters
AD50
AD51
TAD
tRC
A/D Clock Period
A/D Internal RC Oscillator Period
—
334
1.5
—
ns
VDD = 3-5.5V (Note 1)
1.2
1.8
μs
—
Conversion Rate
AD55
AD56
AD57
tCONV
FCNV
Conversion Time
Throughput Rate
Sampling Time
—
—
—
14 TAD
200
ns
ksps
ns
—
—
—
VDD = VREF = 5V
TSAMP
1 TAD
VDD = 3-5.5V source
resistance
RS = 0-2.5 kΩ
Timing Parameters
AD60
AD61
AD62
AD63
tPCS
tPSS
tCSS
tDPU
Conversion Start from Sample
Trigger
—
0.5 TAD
—
1 TAD
—
ns
ns
ns
μs
—
—
—
—
Sample Start from Setting
Sample (SAMP) Bit
—
1.5
TAD
Conversion Completion to
Sample Start (ASAM = 1)
0.5 TAD
20
—
—
Time to Stabilize Analog Stage
from A/D Off to A/D On
—
Note 1: Because the sample caps will eventually lose charge, clock rates below 10 kHz can affect linearity
performance, especially at elevated temperatures.
2: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 181
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 182
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
21.0 PACKAGING INFORMATION
21.1 Package Marking Information
18-Lead PDIP
Example
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
dsPIC30F3012
30I/P
0610017
e
3
18-Lead SOIC
Example
XXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXX
dsPIC30F2011
30I/SO
e
3
YYWWNNN
0610017
28-Lead SPDIP
Example
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
dsPIC30F2012
30I/SP
0610017
e
3
Legend: XX...X Customer-specific information
Y
YY
WW
NNN
Year code (last digit of calendar year)
Year code (last 2 digits of calendar year)
Week code (week of January 1 is week ‘01’)
Alphanumeric traceability code
e
3
Pb-free JEDEC designator for Matte Tin (Sn)
*
This package is Pb-free. The Pb-free JEDEC designator (
can be found on the outer packaging for this package.
)
e3
Note: In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one line, it will
be carried over to the next line, thus limiting the number of available
characters for customer-specific information.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 183
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
21.2 Package Marking Information (Continued)
28-Lead SOIC (.300”)
Example
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
dsPIC30F3013
30I/SO
e
3
YYWWNNN
0610017
28-Lead QFN
Example
XXXXXXX
XXXXXXX
30F2011
30I/MM
e
3
YYWWNNN
0610017
44-Lead QFN
Example
dsPIC
XXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
30F3013
30I/ML
e
3
0610017
DS70139E-page 184
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
18-Lead Plastic Dual In-line (P) – 300 mil Body (PDIP)
Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
E1
D
2
α
n
1
E
A2
L
A
c
A1
B1
β
p
B
eB
Units
INCHES*
NOM
18
MILLIMETERS
Dimension Limits
MIN
MAX
MIN
NOM
18
MAX
n
p
Number of Pins
Pitch
.100
.155
.130
2.54
Top to Seating Plane
A
.140
.170
3.56
2.92
3.94
3.30
4.32
Molded Package Thickness
Base to Seating Plane
Shoulder to Shoulder Width
Molded Package Width
Overall Length
A2
A1
E
.115
.015
.300
.240
.890
.125
.008
.045
.014
.310
5
.145
3.68
0.38
7.62
6.10
22.61
3.18
0.20
1.14
0.36
7.87
5
.313
.250
.898
.130
.012
.058
.018
.370
10
.325
.260
.905
.135
.015
.070
.022
.430
15
7.94
6.35
22.80
3.30
0.29
1.46
0.46
9.40
10
8.26
6.60
22.99
3.43
0.38
1.78
0.56
10.92
15
E1
D
Tip to Seating Plane
Lead Thickness
L
c
Upper Lead Width
B1
B
Lower Lead Width
Overall Row Spacing
Mold Draft Angle Top
Mold Draft Angle Bottom
§
eB
α
β
5
10
15
5
10
15
* Controlling Parameter
§ Significant Characteristic
Notes:
Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed .010” (0.254mm) per side.
JEDEC Equivalent: MS-001
Drawing No. C04-007
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 185
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
18-Lead Plastic Small Outline (SO) – Wide, 300 mil Body (SOIC)
Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
E
p
E1
D
2
B
n
1
h
α
45°
c
A2
A
φ
β
L
A1
Units
INCHES*
NOM
18
MILLIMETERS
Dimension Limits
MIN
MAX
MIN
NOM
18
MAX
n
p
Number of Pins
Pitch
.050
.099
.091
.008
.407
.295
.454
.020
.033
4
1.27
Overall Height
A
.093
.104
2.36
2.24
2.50
2.31
0.20
10.34
7.49
11.53
0.50
0.84
4
2.64
2.39
0.30
10.67
7.59
11.73
0.74
1.27
8
Molded Package Thickness
A2
A1
E
.088
.004
.394
.291
.446
.010
.016
0
.094
.012
.420
.299
.462
.029
.050
8
Standoff
§
0.10
10.01
7.39
11.33
0.25
0.41
0
Overall Width
Molded Package Width
Overall Length
Chamfer Distance
Foot Length
E1
D
h
L
φ
Foot Angle
c
Lead Thickness
Lead Width
.009
.014
0
.011
.017
12
.012
.020
15
0.23
0.36
0
0.27
0.42
12
0.30
0.51
15
B
α
β
Mold Draft Angle Top
Mold Draft Angle Bottom
0
12
15
0
12
15
* Controlling Parameter
§ Significant Characteristic
Notes:
Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed 010” (0.254mm) per side.
JEDEC Equivalent: MS-013
Drawing No. C04-051
DS70139E-page 186
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
28-Lead Skinny Plastic Dual In-line (SP) – 300 mil Body (PDIP)
Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
E1
D
2
n
1
α
E
A2
L
A
c
B1
β
A1
eB
B
p
Units
INCHES
*
MILLIMETERS
Dimension Limits
MIN
NOM
28
MAX
MIN
NOM
28
MAX
n
p
Number of Pins
Pitch
.100
2.54
Top to Seating Plane
A
.140
.150
.130
.160
3.56
3.18
3.81
3.30
4.06
Molded Package Thickness
Base to Seating Plane
Shoulder to Shoulder Width
Molded Package Width
Overall Length
A2
A1
E
.125
.015
.300
.275
1.345
.125
.008
.040
.016
.320
.135
3.43
0.38
7.62
6.99
34.16
3.18
0.20
1.02
0.41
8.13
5
.310
.285
1.365
.130
.012
.053
.019
.350
10
.325
.295
1.385
.135
.015
.065
.022
.430
15
7.87
7.24
34.67
3.30
0.29
1.33
0.48
8.89
10
8.26
7.49
35.18
3.43
0.38
1.65
0.56
10.92
15
E1
D
Tip to Seating Plane
Lead Thickness
L
c
Upper Lead Width
B1
B
Lower Lead Width
Overall Row Spacing
Mold Draft Angle Top
Mold Draft Angle Bottom
§
eB
α
5
β
5
10
15
5
10
15
*
Controlling Parameter
§
Significant Characteristic
Notes:
Dimension D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed .010” (0.254mm) per side.
JEDEC Equivalent: MO-095
Drawing No. C04-070
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 187
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
28-Lead Plastic Small Outline (SO) – Wide, 300 mil Body (SOIC)
Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
E
E1
p
D
B
2
n
1
h
α
45°
c
A2
A
φ
β
L
A1
Units
INCHES*
MILLIMETERS
Dimension Limits
MIN
NOM
28
MAX
MIN
NOM
28
MAX
n
p
Number of Pins
Pitch
.050
1.27
Overall Height
A
.093
.099
.091
.008
.407
.295
.704
.020
.033
4
.104
2.36
2.50
2.31
0.20
10.34
7.49
17.87
0.50
0.84
4
2.64
Molded Package Thickness
A2
A1
E
.088
.004
.394
.288
.695
.010
.016
0
.094
.012
.420
.299
.712
.029
.050
8
2.24
0.10
10.01
7.32
17.65
0.25
0.41
0
2.39
0.30
10.67
7.59
18.08
0.74
1.27
8
Standoff
§
Overall Width
Molded Package Width
Overall Length
E1
D
Chamfer Distance
Foot Length
h
L
φ
c
Foot Angle Top
Lead Thickness
Lead Width
.009
.014
0
.011
.017
12
.013
.020
15
0.23
0.36
0
0.28
0.42
12
0.33
0.51
15
B
α
β
Mold Draft Angle Top
Mold Draft Angle Bottom
0
12
15
0
12
15
* Controlling Parameter
§ Significant Characteristic
Notes:
Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed .010” (0.254mm) per side.
JEDEC Equivalent: MS-013
Drawing No. C04-052
DS70139E-page 188
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
28-Lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (MM) - 6x6x0.9 mm Body [QFN-S]
With 0.40 mm Contact Length
Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
D2
D
EXPOSED
PAD
e
E2
E
b
2
1
2
1
K
N
N
L
NOTE 1
TOP VIEW
BOTTOM VIEW
A
A3
A1
Units
MILLIMETERS
NOM
Dimension Limits
MAX
MIN
28
Number of Pins
Pitch
N
e
0.65 BSC
0.90
0.80
0.00
Overall Height
Standoff
A
1.00
0.05
0.02
A1
A3
E
0.20 REF
6.00 BSC
3.70
Contact Thickness
Overall Width
3.65
Exposed Pad Width
Overall Length
E2
D
4.70
6.00 BSC
3.70
3.65
0.23
0.30
0.20
Exposed Pad Length
Contact Width
D2
b
4.70
0.43
0.50
—
0.38
0.40
Contact Length §
Contact-to-Exposed Pad §
L
—
K
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. § Significant Characteristic
3. Package is saw singulated
4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only.
Microchip Technology Drawing No. C04–124, Sept. 8, 2006
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 189
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
44-Lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (ML) - 8x8 mm Body [QFN]
Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
D2
D
EXPOSED
PAD
e
E
E2
b
2
1
2
1
N
N
K
NOTE 1
L
BOTTOM VIEW
TOP VIEW
A
A3
A1
Units
MILLIMETERS
Dimension Limits
NOM
44
MAX
MIN
Number of Pins
Pitch
N
e
0.65 BSC
0.90
0.80
0.00
Overall Height
Standoff
A
1.00
0.05
0.02
A1
A3
E
0.20 REF
8.00 BSC
6.45
Contact Thickness
Overall Width
6.30
Exposed Pad Width
Overall Length
E2
D
6.80
8.00 BSC
6.45
6.30
0.25
0.30
0.20
Exposed Pad Length
Contact Width
D2
b
6.80
0.38
0.50
—
0.30
0.40
Contact Length §
Contact-to-Exposed Pad §
L
—
K
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. § Significant Characteristic
3. Package is saw singulated
4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only.
Microchip Technology Drawing No. C04–103, Sept. 8, 2006
DS70139E-page 190
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
APPENDIX A: REVISION HISTORY
Revision D (August 2006)
Previous versions of this data sheet contained
Advance or Preliminary Information. They were distrib-
uted with incomplete characterization data.
This revision reflects these updates:
• Supported I2C Slave Addresses
(see Table 14-1)
• ADC Conversion Clock selection to allow
200 kHz sampling rate (see Section 16.0 “12-bit
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module”)
• Operating Current (IDD) Specifications
(see Table 20-5)
• Idle Current (IIDLE) Specifications
(see Table 20-6)
• Power-Down Current (IPD) Specifications
(see Table 20-7)
• I/O pin Input Specifications
(see Table 20-8)
• BOR voltage limits
(see Table 20-11)
• Watchdog Timer time-out limits
(see Table 20-21)
Revision E (December 2006)
This revision includes updates to the packaging
diagrams.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 191
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
NOTES:
DS70139E-page 192
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
2
I C .............................................................................. 94
INDEX
Input Capture Mode.................................................... 81
Oscillator System...................................................... 121
Output Compare Mode............................................... 85
Numerics
12-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (A/D) Module .............. 109
Reset System ........................................................... 125
Shared Port Structure................................................. 57
SPI.............................................................................. 89
SPI Master/Slave Connection..................................... 90
UART Receiver......................................................... 102
UART Transmitter..................................................... 101
BOR Characteristics ......................................................... 153
BOR. See Brown-out Reset.
A
A/D.................................................................................... 109
Aborting a Conversion .............................................. 111
ADCHS Register....................................................... 109
ADCON1 Register..................................................... 109
ADCON2 Register..................................................... 109
ADCON3 Register..................................................... 109
ADCSSL Register ..................................................... 109
ADPCFG Register..................................................... 109
Configuring Analog Port Pins.............................. 58, 115
Connection Considerations....................................... 115
Conversion Operation............................................... 110
Effects of a Reset...................................................... 114
Operation During CPU Idle Mode ............................. 114
Operation During CPU Sleep Mode.......................... 114
Output Formats......................................................... 114
Power-Down Modes.................................................. 114
Programming the Sample Trigger............................. 111
Register Map............................................................. 117
Result Buffer ............................................................. 110
Sampling Requirements............................................ 113
Selecting the Conversion Sequence......................... 110
AC Characteristics ............................................................ 155
Load Conditions........................................................ 155
AC Temperature and Voltage Specifications.................... 155
ADC
Brown-out Reset
Characteristics.......................................................... 153
Timing Requirements ............................................... 161
C
C Compilers
MPLAB C18.............................................................. 142
MPLAB C30.............................................................. 142
CAN Module
I/O Timing Characteristics ........................................ 177
I/O Timing Requirements.......................................... 177
CLKOUT and I/O Timing
Characteristics.......................................................... 160
Requirements ........................................................... 160
Code Examples
Data EEPROM Block Erase ....................................... 54
Data EEPROM Block Write ........................................ 56
Data EEPROM Read.................................................. 53
Data EEPROM Word Erase ....................................... 54
Data EEPROM Word Write ........................................ 55
Erasing a Row of Program Memory ........................... 49
Initiating a Programming Sequence ........................... 50
Loading Write Latches................................................ 50
Code Protection................................................................ 119
Control Registers................................................................ 48
NVMADR.................................................................... 48
NVMADRU ................................................................. 48
NVMCON.................................................................... 48
NVMKEY .................................................................... 48
Core Architecture
Selecting the Conversion Clock................................ 111
ADC Conversion Speeds.................................................. 112
Address Generator Units .................................................... 41
Alternate Vector Table ........................................................ 67
Analog-to-Digital Converter. See ADC.
Assembler
MPASM Assembler................................................... 142
Automatic Clock Stretch...................................................... 96
During 10-bit Addressing (STREN = 1)....................... 96
During 7-bit Addressing (STREN = 1)......................... 96
Receive Mode............................................................. 96
Transmit Mode............................................................ 96
Overview..................................................................... 17
CPU Architecture Overview................................................ 17
Customer Change Notification Service............................. 199
Customer Notification Service .......................................... 199
Customer Support............................................................. 199
B
Bandgap Start-up Time
Requirements............................................................ 162
Timing Characteristics .............................................. 162
Barrel Shifter ....................................................................... 25
Bit-Reversed Addressing .................................................... 44
Example...................................................................... 45
Implementation ........................................................... 44
Modifier Values Table ................................................. 45
Sequence Table (16-Entry)......................................... 45
Block Diagrams
D
Data Accumulators and Adder/Subtractor .......................... 23
Data Space Write Saturation...................................... 25
Overflow and Saturation............................................. 23
Round Logic ............................................................... 24
Write-Back.................................................................. 24
Data Address Space........................................................... 33
Alignment.................................................................... 36
Alignment (Figure)...................................................... 36
Effect of Invalid Memory Accesses (Table) ................ 36
MCU and DSP (MAC Class) Instructions Example .... 35
Memory Map......................................................... 33, 34
Near Data Space........................................................ 37
Software Stack ........................................................... 37
Spaces........................................................................ 36
Width .......................................................................... 36
Data EEPROM Memory...................................................... 53
Erasing ....................................................................... 54
12-bit ADC Functional............................................... 109
16-bit Timer1 Module.................................................. 71
16-bit Timer2............................................................... 77
16-bit Timer3............................................................... 77
32-bit Timer2/3............................................................ 76
DSP Engine ................................................................ 22
dsPIC30F2011............................................................ 10
dsPIC30F2012............................................................ 11
dsPIC30F3013............................................................ 13
External Power-on Reset Circuit............................... 127
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 193
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Erasing, Block.............................................................54
Erasing, Word .............................................................54
I
I/O Pin Specifications
Protection Against Spurious Write ..............................56
Input.......................................................................... 151
Reading.......................................................................53
Write Verify .................................................................56
Writing.........................................................................55
Writing, Block..............................................................55
Writing, Word ..............................................................55
DC Characteristics ............................................................145
BOR ..........................................................................153
Brown-out Reset .......................................................153
I/O Pin Input Specifications.......................................151
I/O Pin Output Specifications ....................................151
Idle Current (IIDLE) ....................................................148
Low-Voltage Detect...................................................152
LVDL .........................................................................152
Operating Current (IDD).............................................147
Power-Down Current (IPD) ........................................149
Program and EEPROM.............................................154
Temperature and Voltage Specifications..................145
Development Support .......................................................141
Device Configuration
Output....................................................................... 151
I/O Ports.............................................................................. 57
Parallel (PIO) .............................................................. 57
2
I C 10-bit Slave Mode Operation........................................ 95
Reception ................................................................... 96
Transmission .............................................................. 96
I C 7-bit Slave Mode Operation.......................................... 95
2
Reception ................................................................... 95
Transmission .............................................................. 95
I C Master Mode Operation................................................ 97
2
Baud Rate Generator ................................................. 98
Clock Arbitration ......................................................... 98
Multi-Master Communication, Bus Collision and
Bus Arbitration.................................................... 98
Reception ................................................................... 98
Transmission .............................................................. 97
2
I C Master Mode Support................................................... 97
I C Module
2
Addresses................................................................... 95
Bus Data Timing Characteristics
Master Mode..................................................... 173
Slave Mode....................................................... 175
Bus Data Timing Requirements
Master Mode..................................................... 174
Slave Mode....................................................... 175
Bus Start/Stop Bits Timing Characteristics
Register Map.............................................................132
Device Configuration Registers
FBORPOR ................................................................130
FGS...........................................................................130
FOSC ........................................................................130
FWDT........................................................................130
Device Overview .............................................................9, 17
Disabling the UART...........................................................103
Divide Support.....................................................................20
Instructions (Table) .....................................................20
DSP Engine.........................................................................21
Multiplier......................................................................23
Dual Output Compare Match Mode ....................................86
Continuous Pulse Mode..............................................86
Single Pulse Mode ......................................................86
Master Mode..................................................... 173
Slave Mode....................................................... 175
General Call Address Support.................................... 97
Interrupts .................................................................... 97
IPMI Support............................................................... 97
Operating Function Description .................................. 93
Operation During CPU Sleep and Idle Modes............ 98
Pin Configuration ........................................................ 93
Programmer’s Model .................................................. 93
Register Map .............................................................. 99
Registers .................................................................... 93
Slope Control.............................................................. 97
Software Controlled Clock Stretching (STREN = 1) ... 96
Various Modes............................................................ 93
Idle Current (IIDLE) ............................................................ 148
In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP)......................... 47, 119
Input Capture (CAPX) Timing Characteristics .................. 165
Input Capture Module ......................................................... 81
Interrupts .................................................................... 82
Register Map .............................................................. 83
Input Capture Operation During Sleep and Idle Modes...... 82
CPU Idle Mode ........................................................... 82
CPU Sleep Mode........................................................ 82
Input Capture Timing Requirements................................. 165
Input Change Notification Module....................................... 61
dsPIC30F2012/3013 Register Map (Bits 7-0)............. 61
Instruction Addressing Modes ............................................ 41
File Register Instructions............................................ 41
Fundamental Modes Supported ................................. 41
MAC Instructions ........................................................ 42
MCU Instructions ........................................................ 41
Move and Accumulator Instructions............................ 42
Other Instructions ....................................................... 42
Instruction Set
E
Electrical Characteristics
AC .............................................................................155
DC.............................................................................145
Enabling and Setting Up UART
Alternate I/O..............................................................103
Setting Up Data, Parity and Stop Bit Selections .......103
Enabling the UART ...........................................................103
Equations
ADC Conversion Clock .............................................111
Baud Rate.................................................................105
Serial Clock Rate ........................................................98
Errata ....................................................................................7
Exception Sequence
Trap Sources ..............................................................65
External Clock Timing Characteristics
Type A, B and C Timer .............................................163
External Clock Timing Requirements................................156
Type A Timer ............................................................163
Type B Timer ............................................................164
Type C Timer ............................................................164
External Interrupt Requests ................................................68
F
Fast Context Saving............................................................68
Flash Program Memory.......................................................47
Overview................................................................... 136
Summary .................................................................. 133
DS70139E-page 194
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Internal Clock Timing Examples ....................................... 158
Internet Address................................................................ 199
Interrupt Controller
P
Packaging Information...................................................... 183
Marking............................................................. 183, 184
Peripheral Module Disable (PMD) Registers.................... 131
PICSTART Plus Development Programmer..................... 144
Pinout Descriptions............................................................. 14
PLL Clock Timing Specifications ...................................... 157
POR. See Power-on Reset.
Port Write/Read Example ................................................... 58
PORTB
Register Map for dsPIC30F2011/3012....................... 59
Register Map for dsPIC30F2012/3013....................... 59
PORTC
Register Map......................................................... 69, 70
Interrupt Priority .................................................................. 64
Traps........................................................................... 65
Interrupt Sequence ............................................................. 67
Interrupt Stack Frame ................................................. 67
Interrupts............................................................................. 63
L
Load Conditions................................................................ 155
Low Voltage Detect (LVD) ................................................ 129
Low-Voltage Detect Characteristics.................................. 152
LVDL Characteristics ........................................................ 152
Register Map for dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013..... 59
PORTD
Register Map for dsPIC30F2011/3012....................... 59
Register Map for dsPIC30F2012/3013....................... 60
PORTF
Register Map for dsPIC30F2012/3013....................... 60
Power Saving Modes........................................................ 129
Idle............................................................................ 130
Sleep ........................................................................ 129
Sleep and Idle........................................................... 119
Power-Down Current (IPD)................................................ 149
Power-up Timer
Timing Characteristics.............................................. 161
Timing Requirements ............................................... 161
Program Address Space..................................................... 27
Construction ............................................................... 29
Data Access from Program Memory Using
M
Memory Organization.......................................................... 27
Core Register Map...................................................... 37
Microchip Internet Web Site.............................................. 199
Modulo Addressing ............................................................. 42
Applicability................................................................. 44
Incrementing Buffer Operation Example..................... 43
Start and End Address................................................ 43
W Address Register Selection .................................... 43
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker, Librarian ................... 142
MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger ................................... 143
MPLAB ICE 2000 High-Performance Universal
In-Circuit Emulator .................................................... 143
MPLAB ICE 4000 High-Performance Universal
In-Circuit Emulator .................................................... 143
MPLAB Integrated Development Environment Software .. 141
MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer .................................... 143
MPLINK Object Linker/MPLIB Object Librarian ................ 142
Program Space Visibility..................................... 31
Data Access From Program Memory Using
Table Instructions ............................................... 30
Data Access from, Address Generation ..................... 29
Data Space Window into Operation ........................... 32
Data Table Access (LS Word).................................... 30
Data Table Access (MS Byte) .................................... 31
Memory Map............................................................... 28
Table Instructions
N
NVM
Register Map............................................................... 51
O
TBLRDH ............................................................. 30
TBLRDL.............................................................. 30
TBLWTH............................................................. 30
TBLWTL ............................................................. 30
Program and EEPROM Characteristics............................ 154
Program Counter................................................................ 18
Programmable .................................................................. 119
Programmer’s Model .......................................................... 18
Diagram...................................................................... 19
Programming Operations.................................................... 49
Algorithm for Program Flash....................................... 49
Erasing a Row of Program Memory ........................... 49
Initiating the Programming Sequence ........................ 50
Loading Write Latches................................................ 50
Protection Against Accidental Writes to OSCCON........... 124
OC/PWM Module Timing Characteristics.......................... 167
Operating Current (IDD)..................................................... 147
Operating Frequency vs Voltage
dsPIC30FXXXX-20 (Extended)................................. 145
Oscillator
Configurations........................................................... 122
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor .................................... 124
Fast RC (FRC).................................................. 123
Initial Clock Source Selection ........................... 122
Low-Power RC (LPRC)..................................... 123
LP Oscillator Control......................................... 123
Phase Locked Loop (PLL) ................................ 123
Start-up Timer (OST) ........................................ 122
Operating Modes (Table).......................................... 120
System Overview...................................................... 119
Oscillator Selection ........................................................... 119
Oscillator Start-up Timer
R
Reader Response............................................................. 200
Reset ........................................................................ 119, 125
BOR, Programmable ................................................ 127
Brown-out Reset (BOR)............................................ 119
Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)................................ 119
POR
Timing Characteristics .............................................. 161
Timing Requirements................................................ 161
Output Compare Interrupts ................................................. 87
Output Compare Module..................................................... 85
Register Map............................................................... 88
Timing Characteristics .............................................. 166
Timing Requirements................................................ 166
Output Compare Operation During CPU Idle Mode............ 87
Output Compare Sleep Mode Operation ............................ 87
Operating without FSCM and PWRT................ 127
With Long Crystal Start-up Time ...................... 127
POR (Power-on Reset)............................................. 125
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 195
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Power-on Reset (POR).............................................119
Power-up Timer (PWRT) ..........................................119
Reset Sequence..................................................................65
Reset Sources ............................................................65
Reset Sources
Brown-out Reset (BOR)..............................................65
Illegal Instruction Trap.................................................65
Trap Lockout...............................................................65
Uninitialized W Register Trap .....................................65
Watchdog Time-out.....................................................65
Reset Timing Characteristics ............................................161
Reset Timing Requirements..............................................161
Run-Time Self-Programming (RTSP) .................................47
Interrupt ...................................................................... 72
Operation During Sleep Mode .................................... 72
Prescaler .................................................................... 72
Real-Time Clock ......................................................... 72
Interrupts ............................................................ 73
Oscillator Operation............................................ 73
Register Map .............................................................. 74
Timer2 and Timer3 Selection Mode.................................... 86
Timer2/3 Module
16-bit Timer Mode....................................................... 75
32-bit Synchronous Counter Mode............................. 75
32-bit Timer Mode....................................................... 75
ADC Event Trigger...................................................... 78
Gate Operation ........................................................... 78
Interrupt ...................................................................... 78
Operation During Sleep Mode .................................... 78
Register Map .............................................................. 79
Timer Prescaler .......................................................... 78
Timing Characteristics
S
Simple Capture Event Mode ...............................................81
Buffer Operation..........................................................82
Hall Sensor Mode .......................................................82
Prescaler.....................................................................81
Timer2 and Timer3 Selection Mode............................82
Simple OC/PWM Mode Timing Requirements..................167
Simple Output Compare Match Mode.................................86
Simple PWM Mode .............................................................86
Input Pin Fault Protection............................................86
Period..........................................................................87
Software Simulator (MPLAB SIM).....................................142
Software Stack Pointer, Frame Pointer...............................18
CALL Stack Frame......................................................37
SPI Module..........................................................................89
Framed SPI Support ...................................................90
Operating Function Description ..................................89
Operation During CPU Idle Mode ...............................91
Operation During CPU Sleep Mode............................91
SDOx Disable .............................................................90
Slave Select Synchronization .....................................91
SPI1 Register Map......................................................92
Timing Characteristics
A/D Conversion
Low-speed (ASAM = 0, SSRC = 000) .............. 180
Bandgap Start-up Time............................................. 162
CAN Module I/O........................................................ 177
CLKOUT and I/O ...................................................... 160
External Clock........................................................... 155
2
I C Bus Data
Master Mode..................................................... 173
Slave Mode....................................................... 175
I C Bus Start/Stop Bits
2
Master Mode..................................................... 173
Slave Mode....................................................... 175
Input Capture (CAPX)............................................... 165
OC/PWM Module...................................................... 167
Oscillator Start-up Timer........................................... 161
Output Compare Module .......................................... 166
Power-up Timer........................................................ 161
Reset ........................................................................ 161
SPI Module
Master Mode (CKE = 0) ....................................168
Master Mode (CKE = 1) ....................................169
Slave Mode (CKE = 1) .............................. 170, 171
Timing Requirements
Master Mode (CKE = 0).................................... 168
Master Mode (CKE = 1).................................... 169
Slave Mode (CKE = 0)...................................... 170
Slave Mode (CKE = 1)...................................... 171
Type A, B and C Timer External Clock..................... 163
Watchdog Timer ....................................................... 161
Timing Diagrams
Master Mode (CKE = 0) ....................................168
Master Mode (CKE = 1) ....................................169
Slave Mode (CKE = 0) ......................................170
Slave Mode (CKE = 1) ......................................172
Word and Byte Communication ..................................90
Status Bits, Their Significance and the Initialization
Condition for RCON Register, Case 1 ......................128
Status Bits, Their Significance and the Initialization
Condition for RCON Register, Case 2 ......................128
Status Register....................................................................18
Symbols Used in Opcode Descriptions.............................134
System Integration
PWM Output Timing ................................................... 87
Time-out Sequence on Power-up (MCLR Not
Tied to VDD), Case 1 ........................................ 126
Time-out Sequence on Power-up (MCLR Not
Tied to VDD), Case 2 ........................................ 126
Time-out Sequence on Power-up (MCLR
Tied to VDD)...................................................... 126
Timing Diagrams and Specifications
Register Map.............................................................132
DC Characteristics - Internal RC Accuracy............... 158
Timing Diagrams.See Timing Characteristics
Timing Requirements
T
Table Instruction Operation Summary ................................47
Temperature and Voltage Specifications
A/D Conversion
Low-speed........................................................ 181
Bandgap Start-up Time............................................. 162
Brown-out Reset....................................................... 161
CAN Module I/O........................................................ 177
CLKOUT and I/O ...................................................... 160
External Clock........................................................... 156
AC .............................................................................155
DC.............................................................................145
Timer 2/3 Module ................................................................75
Timer1 Module ....................................................................71
16-bit Asynchronous Counter Mode ...........................71
16-bit Synchronous Counter Mode .............................71
16-bit Timer Mode.......................................................71
Gate Operation ...........................................................72
2
I C Bus Data (Master Mode) .................................... 174
2
I C Bus Data (Slave Mode) ...................................... 175
DS70139E-page 196
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
Input Capture ............................................................ 165
Oscillator Start-up Timer........................................... 161
Output Compare Module........................................... 166
Power-up Timer ........................................................ 161
Reset......................................................................... 161
Simple OC/PWM Mode............................................. 167
SPI Module
Master Mode (CKE = 0).................................... 168
Master Mode (CKE = 1).................................... 169
Slave Mode (CKE = 0)...................................... 170
Slave Mode (CKE = 1)...................................... 172
Type A Timer External Clock .................................... 163
Type B Timer External Clock .................................... 164
Type C Timer External Clock.................................... 164
Watchdog Timer........................................................ 161
Timing Specifications
PLL Clock.................................................................. 157
Trap Vectors ....................................................................... 67
U
UART Module
Address Detect Mode ............................................... 105
Auto-Baud Support ................................................... 106
Baud Rate Generator................................................ 105
Enabling and Setting Up ........................................... 103
Framing Error (FERR)............................................... 105
Idle Status................................................................. 105
Loopback Mode ........................................................ 105
Operation During CPU Sleep and Idle Modes .......... 106
Overview................................................................... 101
Parity Error (PERR) .................................................. 105
Receive Break........................................................... 105
Receive Buffer (UxRXB) ........................................... 104
Receive Buffer Overrun Error (OERR Bit) ................ 104
Receive Interrupt....................................................... 104
Receiving Data.......................................................... 104
Receiving in 8-bit or 9-bit Data Mode........................ 104
Reception Error Handling.......................................... 104
Transmit Break.......................................................... 104
Transmit Buffer (UxTXB)........................................... 103
Transmit Interrupt...................................................... 104
Transmitting Data...................................................... 103
Transmitting in 8-bit Data Mode................................ 103
Transmitting in 9-bit Data Mode................................ 103
UART1 Register Map................................................ 107
UART2 Register Map................................................ 107
UART Operation
Idle Mode .................................................................. 106
Sleep Mode............................................................... 106
Unit ID Locations............................................................... 119
Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter
(UART) Module......................................................... 101
W
Wake-up from Sleep ......................................................... 119
Wake-up from Sleep and Idle ............................................. 68
Watchdog Timer
Timing Characteristics .............................................. 161
Timing Requirements................................................ 161
Watchdog Timer (WDT) ............................................ 119, 129
Enabling and Disabling ............................................. 129
Operation .................................................................. 129
WWW Address.................................................................. 199
WWW, On-Line Support ....................................................... 7
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 197
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
DS70139E-page 198
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
THE MICROCHIP WEB SITE
CUSTOMER SUPPORT
Microchip provides online support via our WWW site at
www.microchip.com. This web site is used as a means
to make files and information easily available to
customers. Accessible by using your favorite Internet
browser, the web site contains the following
information:
Users of Microchip products can receive assistance
through several channels:
• Distributor or Representative
• Local Sales Office
• Field Application Engineer (FAE)
• Technical Support
• Product Support – Data sheets and errata,
application notes and sample programs, design
resources, user’s guides and hardware support
documents, latest software releases and archived
software
• Development Systems Information Line
Customers
should
contact
their
distributor,
representative or field application engineer (FAE) for
support. Local sales offices are also available to help
customers. A listing of sales offices and locations is
included in the back of this document.
• General Technical Support – Frequently Asked
Questions (FAQ), technical support requests,
online discussion groups, Microchip consultant
program member listing
Technical support is available through the web site
at: http://support.microchip.com
• Business of Microchip – Product selector and
ordering guides, latest Microchip press releases,
listing of seminars and events, listings of
Microchip sales offices, distributors and factory
representatives
CUSTOMER CHANGE NOTIFICATION
SERVICE
Microchip’s customer notification service helps keep
customers current on Microchip products. Subscribers
will receive e-mail notification whenever there are
changes, updates, revisions or errata related to a
specified product family or development tool of interest.
To register, access the Microchip web site at
www.microchip.com, click on Customer Change
Notification and follow the registration instructions.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 199
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
READER RESPONSE
It is our intention to provide you with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip prod-
uct. If you wish to provide your comments on organization, clarity, subject matter, and ways in which our documentation
can better serve you, please FAX your comments to the Technical Publications Manager at (480) 792-4150.
Please list the following information, and use this outline to provide us with your comments about this document.
To:
Technical Publications Manager
Reader Response
Total Pages Sent ________
RE:
From:
Name
Company
Address
City / State / ZIP / Country
Telephone: (_______) _________ - _________
FAX: (______) _________ - _________
Application (optional):
Would you like a reply?
Y
N
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/
DS70139E
Literature Number:
Device:
Questions:
1. What are the best features of this document?
2. How does this document meet your hardware and software development needs?
3. Do you find the organization of this document easy to follow? If not, why?
4. What additions to the document do you think would enhance the structure and subject?
5. What deletions from the document could be made without affecting the overall usefulness?
6. Is there any incorrect or misleading information (what and where)?
7. How would you improve this document?
DS70139E-page 200
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION SYSTEM
To order or obtain information, e.g., on pricing or delivery, refer to the factory or the listed sales office.
dsPIC30F3013AT-30I/SP-ES
Custom ID (3 digits) or
Engineering Sample (ES)
Trademark
Architecture
Package
= DIP
SO = SOIC
P
Flash
SP = SPDIP
ML = QFN (8x8)
Memory Size in Bytes
0 = ROMless
1 = 1K to 6K
2 = 7K to 12K
3 = 13K to 24K
4 = 25K to 48K
5 = 49K to 96K
6 = 97K to 192K
7 = 193K to 384K
8 = 385K to 768K
9 = 769K and Up
Temperature
I = Industrial -40°C to +85°C
E = Extended High Temp -40°C to +125°C
Speed
20 = 20 MIPS
30 = 30 MIPS
Device ID
T = Tape and Reel
A,B,C… = Revision Level
Example:
dsPIC30F3013AT-30I/SP = 30 MIPS, Industrial temp., SPDIP package, Rev. A
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 201
WORLDWIDE SALES AND SERVICE
AMERICAS
ASIA/PACIFIC
ASIA/PACIFIC
EUROPE
Corporate Office
Asia Pacific Office
Suites 3707-14, 37th Floor
Tower 6, The Gateway
Habour City, Kowloon
Hong Kong
Tel: 852-2401-1200
Fax: 852-2401-3431
India - Bangalore
Tel: 91-80-4182-8400
Fax: 91-80-4182-8422
Austria - Wels
Tel: 43-7242-2244-3910
Fax: 43-7242-2244-393
2355 West Chandler Blvd.
Chandler, AZ 85224-6199
Tel: 480-792-7200
Fax: 480-792-7277
Technical Support:
http://support.microchip.com
Web Address:
www.microchip.com
Denmark - Copenhagen
Tel: 45-4450-2828
Fax: 45-4485-2829
India - New Delhi
Tel: 91-11-4160-8631
Fax: 91-11-4160-8632
France - Paris
Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20
Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79
India - Pune
Tel: 91-20-2566-1512
Fax: 91-20-2566-1513
Australia - Sydney
Tel: 61-2-9868-6733
Fax: 61-2-9868-6755
Atlanta
Germany - Munich
Tel: 49-89-627-144-0
Fax: 49-89-627-144-44
Japan - Yokohama
Tel: 81-45-471- 6166
Fax: 81-45-471-6122
Alpharetta, GA
Tel: 770-640-0034
Fax: 770-640-0307
China - Beijing
Tel: 86-10-8528-2100
Fax: 86-10-8528-2104
Italy - Milan
Tel: 39-0331-742611
Fax: 39-0331-466781
Korea - Gumi
Tel: 82-54-473-4301
Fax: 82-54-473-4302
Boston
China - Chengdu
Tel: 86-28-8665-5511
Fax: 86-28-8665-7889
Westborough, MA
Tel: 774-760-0087
Fax: 774-760-0088
Netherlands - Drunen
Tel: 31-416-690399
Fax: 31-416-690340
Korea - Seoul
China - Fuzhou
Tel: 86-591-8750-3506
Fax: 86-591-8750-3521
Tel: 82-2-554-7200
Fax: 82-2-558-5932 or
82-2-558-5934
Chicago
Itasca, IL
Tel: 630-285-0071
Fax: 630-285-0075
Spain - Madrid
Tel: 34-91-708-08-90
Fax: 34-91-708-08-91
China - Hong Kong SAR
Tel: 852-2401-1200
Fax: 852-2401-3431
Malaysia - Penang
Tel: 60-4-646-8870
Fax: 60-4-646-5086
Dallas
Addison, TX
Tel: 972-818-7423
Fax: 972-818-2924
UK - Wokingham
Tel: 44-118-921-5869
Fax: 44-118-921-5820
China - Qingdao
Tel: 86-532-8502-7355
Fax: 86-532-8502-7205
Philippines - Manila
Tel: 63-2-634-9065
Fax: 63-2-634-9069
Detroit
Farmington Hills, MI
Tel: 248-538-2250
Fax: 248-538-2260
China - Shanghai
Tel: 86-21-5407-5533
Fax: 86-21-5407-5066
Singapore
Tel: 65-6334-8870
Fax: 65-6334-8850
Kokomo
Kokomo, IN
Tel: 765-864-8360
Fax: 765-864-8387
China - Shenyang
Tel: 86-24-2334-2829
Fax: 86-24-2334-2393
Taiwan - Hsin Chu
Tel: 886-3-572-9526
Fax: 886-3-572-6459
China - Shenzhen
Tel: 86-755-8203-2660
Fax: 86-755-8203-1760
Taiwan - Kaohsiung
Tel: 886-7-536-4818
Fax: 886-7-536-4803
Los Angeles
Mission Viejo, CA
Tel: 949-462-9523
Fax: 949-462-9608
China - Shunde
Tel: 86-757-2839-5507
Fax: 86-757-2839-5571
Taiwan - Taipei
Tel: 886-2-2500-6610
Fax: 886-2-2508-0102
Santa Clara
Santa Clara, CA
Tel: 408-961-6444
Fax: 408-961-6445
China - Wuhan
Tel: 86-27-5980-5300
Fax: 86-27-5980-5118
Thailand - Bangkok
Tel: 66-2-694-1351
Fax: 66-2-694-1350
Toronto
Mississauga, Ontario,
Canada
Tel: 905-673-0699
Fax: 905-673-6509
China - Xian
Tel: 86-29-8833-7250
Fax: 86-29-8833-7256
08/29/06
DS70139E-page 202
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F2011/2012/3012/3013
1.0 Device Overview .......................................................................................................................................................................... 9
2.0 CPU Architecture Overview........................................................................................................................................................ 17
3.0 Memory Organization................................................................................................................................................................. 27
4.0 Address Generator Units............................................................................................................................................................ 41
5.0 Flash Program Memory.............................................................................................................................................................. 47
6.0 Data EEPROM Memory ............................................................................................................................................................. 53
7.0 I/O Ports ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 57
8.0 Interrupts .................................................................................................................................................................................... 63
9.0 Timer1 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................... 71
10.0 Timer2/3 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................ 75
11.0 Input Capture Module................................................................................................................................................................. 81
12.0 Output Compare Module............................................................................................................................................................ 85
13.0 SPI Module................................................................................................................................................................................. 89
14.0 I2C Module................................................................................................................................................................................. 93
15.0 Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART) Module .............................................................................................. 101
16.0 12-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module .................................................................................................................... 109
17.0 System Integration ................................................................................................................................................................... 119
18.0 Instruction Set Summary.......................................................................................................................................................... 133
19.0 Development Support............................................................................................................................................................... 141
20.0 Electrical Characteristics.......................................................................................................................................................... 145
21.0 Packaging Information.............................................................................................................................................................. 183
Index .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 193
The Microchip Web Site..................................................................................................................................................................... 199
Customer Change Notification Service .............................................................................................................................................. 199
Customer Support.............................................................................................................................................................................. 199
Reader Response.............................................................................................................................................................................. 200
Product Identification System ............................................................................................................................................................ 201
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70139E-page 1
相关型号:
DSPIC30F3013AT-20I/PF-ES
General Purpose and Sensor Families High-Performance Digital Signal Controllers
MICROCHIP
DSPIC30F3013AT-20I/PT-ES
General Purpose and Sensor Families High-Performance Digital Signal Controllers
MICROCHIP
DSPIC30F3013AT-20I/SP
16-BIT, FLASH, 20 MHz, MICROCONTROLLER, PDIP28, 0.300 INCH, PLASTIC, DIP-28
MICROCHIP
DSPIC30F3013AT-30E/PF-ES
General Purpose and Sensor Families High-Performance Digital Signal Controllers
MICROCHIP
©2020 ICPDF网 联系我们和版权申明